]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - gdb/doc/gdb.texinfo
gdb/doc/ChangeLog:
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
66 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
67 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
68 development.''
69 @end ifinfo
70
71 @titlepage
72 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
73 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
74 @sp 1
75 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
76 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
77 @page
78 @tex
79 {\parskip=0pt
80 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
81 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
82 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
83 }
84 @end tex
85
86 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
87 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
88 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
89 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
90 @sp 2
91 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
92 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
93 Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
94 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
95
96 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
97 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
98 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
99 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
100 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
101 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
102
103 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
104 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
105 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
106 development.''
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
118 @value{GDBVN}.
119
120 Copyright (C) 1988-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
121
122 @menu
123 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
124 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
125
126 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
127 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
128 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
129 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
130 * Stack:: Examining the stack
131 * Source:: Examining source files
132 * Data:: Examining data
133 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
134 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
135 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
136
137 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
138
139 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
140 * Altering:: Altering execution
141 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
142 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
143 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
144 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
145 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
146 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
147 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
148 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
149 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
151 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
152
153 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
159 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
160 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
161 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
162 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
163 how you can copy and share GDB
164 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
165 * Index:: Index
166 @end menu
167
168 @end ifnottex
169
170 @contents
171
172 @node Summary
173 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
174
175 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
176 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
177 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
178
179 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
180 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
181
182 @itemize @bullet
183 @item
184 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
185
186 @item
187 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
188
189 @item
190 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
191
192 @item
193 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
194 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
195 @end itemize
196
197 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
198 For more information, see @ref{Supported languages,,Supported languages}.
199 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
200
201 @cindex Modula-2
202 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
203 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
204
205 @cindex Pascal
206 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
207 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
208 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
209 syntax.
210
211 @cindex Fortran
212 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
213 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
214 underscore.
215
216 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
217 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
218
219 @menu
220 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
221 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
222 @end menu
223
224 @node Free Software
225 @unnumberedsec Free software
226
227 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
228 General Public License
229 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
230 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
231 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
232 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
233 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
234 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
235
236 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
237 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
238 from anyone else.
239
240 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
241
242 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
243 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
244 include with the free software. Many of our most important
245 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
246 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
247 when an important free software package does not come with a free
248 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
249 gaps today.
250
251 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
252 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
253 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
254 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
255 them from the free software world.
256
257 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
258 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
259 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
260 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
261 contract to make it non-free.
262
263 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
264 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
265 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
266 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
267 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
268 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
269 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
270
271 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
272 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
273 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
274 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
275
276 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
277 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
278 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
279 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
280 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
281 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
282 community.
283
284 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
285 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
286 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
287 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
288 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
289 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
290 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
291 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
292 of the manual.
293
294 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
295 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
296 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
297 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
298 manual to replace it.
299
300 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
301 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
302 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
303 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
304 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
305 the free software community.
306
307 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
308 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
309 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
310 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
311 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
312 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
313 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
314 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
315 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
316
317 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
318 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
319 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
320 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
321 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
322 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
323 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
324 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
325
326 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
327 published by other publishers, at
328 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
329
330 @node Contributors
331 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
332
333 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
334 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
335 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
336 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
337 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
338 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
339 blow-by-blow account.
340
341 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
342
343 @quotation
344 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
345 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
346 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
347 @end quotation
348
349 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
350 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
351 releases:
352 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
353 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
354 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
355 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
356 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
357 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
358 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
359 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
360 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
361
362 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
363 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
364
365 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
366 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
367 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
368 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
369 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
370
371 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
372 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
373 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
374
375 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
376 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
377
378 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
379
380 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
381 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
382 support.
383 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
384 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
385 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
386 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
387 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
388 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
389 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
390 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
391 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
392 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
393 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
394 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
395 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
396 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
397 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
398 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
399
400 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
401
402 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
403 libraries.
404
405 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
406 about several machine instruction sets.
407
408 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
409 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
410 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
411 and RDI targets, respectively.
412
413 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
414 command-line editing and command history.
415
416 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
417 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
418
419 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
420 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
421 symbols.
422
423 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
424 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
425
426 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
427
428 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
429 processors.
430
431 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
432
433 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
434
435 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
436
437 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
438 watchpoints.
439
440 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
441
442 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
443
444 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
445 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
446
447 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
448 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
449 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
450 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
451 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
452 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
453 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
454
455 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
456 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
457
458 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
459 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
460 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
461 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
462 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
463 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
464 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
465 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
466 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
467 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
468 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
469 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
470 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
471 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
472 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
473
474 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
475 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
476
477 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
478 Hat.
479
480 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
481 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
482 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
483 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
484 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
485 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
486
487 @node Sample Session
488 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
489
490 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
491 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
492 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
493
494 @iftex
495 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
496 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
497 @end iftex
498
499 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
500 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
501
502 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
503 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
504 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
505 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
506 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
507 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
508 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
509 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
510 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
511
512 @smallexample
513 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
514 $ @b{./m4}
515 @b{define(foo,0000)}
516
517 @b{foo}
518 0000
519 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
520
521 @b{bar}
522 0000
523 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
524
525 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
526 @b{baz}
527 @b{C-d}
528 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
529 @end smallexample
530
531 @noindent
532 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
533
534 @smallexample
535 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
536 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
537 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
538 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
539 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
540 the conditions.
541 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
542 for details.
543
544 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
545 (@value{GDBP})
546 @end smallexample
547
548 @noindent
549 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
550 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
551 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
552 that examples fit in this manual.
553
554 @smallexample
555 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
556 @end smallexample
557
558 @noindent
559 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
560 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
561 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
562 @code{break} command.
563
564 @smallexample
565 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
566 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
567 @end smallexample
568
569 @noindent
570 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
571 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
572 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
573
574 @smallexample
575 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
576 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
577 @b{define(foo,0000)}
578
579 @b{foo}
580 0000
581 @end smallexample
582
583 @noindent
584 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
585 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
586 context where it stops.
587
588 @smallexample
589 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
590
591 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
592 at builtin.c:879
593 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
594 @end smallexample
595
596 @noindent
597 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
598 the next line of the current function.
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
602 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
603 : nil,
604 @end smallexample
605
606 @noindent
607 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
608 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
609 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
610 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
611
612 @smallexample
613 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
614 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
615 at input.c:530
616 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
617 @end smallexample
618
619 @noindent
620 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
621 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
622 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
623 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
624 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
625 stack frame for each active subroutine.
626
627 @smallexample
628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
629 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
630 at input.c:530
631 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
632 at builtin.c:882
633 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
634 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
635 at macro.c:71
636 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
637 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
642 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
643 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
644
645 @smallexample
646 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
647 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
649 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
650 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
651 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
652 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
653 : xstrdup(rq);
654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
655 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
660 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
661 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
662 (@code{print}) to see their values.
663
664 @smallexample
665 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
666 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
667 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
668 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
669 @end smallexample
670
671 @noindent
672 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
673 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
674 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
675
676 @smallexample
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
678 533 xfree(rquote);
679 534
680 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
681 : xstrdup (lq);
682 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
683 : xstrdup (rq);
684 537
685 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
686 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
687 540 @}
688 541
689 542 void
690 @end smallexample
691
692 @noindent
693 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
694 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
695
696 @smallexample
697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
698 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
699 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
700 540 @}
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
702 $3 = 9
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
704 $4 = 7
705 @end smallexample
706
707 @noindent
708 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
709 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
710 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
711 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
712 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
713 assignments.
714
715 @smallexample
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
717 $5 = 7
718 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
719 $6 = 9
720 @end smallexample
721
722 @noindent
723 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
724 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
725 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
726 example that caused trouble initially:
727
728 @smallexample
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
730 Continuing.
731
732 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
733
734 baz
735 0000
736 @end smallexample
737
738 @noindent
739 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
740 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
741 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
742
743 @smallexample
744 @b{C-d}
745 Program exited normally.
746 @end smallexample
747
748 @noindent
749 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
750 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
751 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
755 @end smallexample
756
757 @node Invocation
758 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
759
760 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
761 The essentials are:
762 @itemize @bullet
763 @item
764 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
765 @item
766 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
767 @end itemize
768
769 @menu
770 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
771 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
772 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
773 * Logging output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
774 @end menu
775
776 @node Invoking GDB
777 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
778
779 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
780 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
781
782 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
783 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
784
785 The command-line options described here are designed
786 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
787 options may effectively be unavailable.
788
789 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
790 specifying an executable program:
791
792 @smallexample
793 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
794 @end smallexample
795
796 @noindent
797 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
798 specified:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
802 @end smallexample
803
804 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
805 to debug a running process:
806
807 @smallexample
808 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
809 @end smallexample
810
811 @noindent
812 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
813 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
814
815 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
816 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
817 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
818 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
819 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
820
821 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
822 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
823 option processing.
824 @smallexample
825 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
826 @end smallexample
827 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
828 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
829
830 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
831 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
832
833 @smallexample
834 @value{GDBP} -silent
835 @end smallexample
836
837 @noindent
838 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
839 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
840
841 @noindent
842 Type
843
844 @smallexample
845 @value{GDBP} -help
846 @end smallexample
847
848 @noindent
849 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
850 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
851
852 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
853 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
854 @samp{-x} option is used.
855
856
857 @menu
858 * File Options:: Choosing files
859 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
860 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
861 @end menu
862
863 @node File Options
864 @subsection Choosing files
865
866 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
867 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
868 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
869 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
870 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
871 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
872 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
873 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
874 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
875 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
876 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
877 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
878 prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
879
880 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
881 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
882 argument and ignore it.
883
884 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
885 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
886 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
887 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
888 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
889
890 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
891 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
892 @c it.
893
894 @table @code
895 @item -symbols @var{file}
896 @itemx -s @var{file}
897 @cindex @code{--symbols}
898 @cindex @code{-s}
899 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
900
901 @item -exec @var{file}
902 @itemx -e @var{file}
903 @cindex @code{--exec}
904 @cindex @code{-e}
905 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
906 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
907
908 @item -se @var{file}
909 @cindex @code{--se}
910 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
911 file.
912
913 @item -core @var{file}
914 @itemx -c @var{file}
915 @cindex @code{--core}
916 @cindex @code{-c}
917 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
918
919 @item -c @var{number}
920 @item -pid @var{number}
921 @itemx -p @var{number}
922 @cindex @code{--pid}
923 @cindex @code{-p}
924 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
925 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
926 file named @var{number}.
927
928 @item -command @var{file}
929 @itemx -x @var{file}
930 @cindex @code{--command}
931 @cindex @code{-x}
932 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
933 Files,, Command files}.
934
935 @item -eval-command @var{command}
936 @itemx -ex @var{command}
937 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
938 @cindex @code{-ex}
939 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
940
941 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
942 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
943
944 @smallexample
945 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
946 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
947 @end smallexample
948
949 @item -directory @var{directory}
950 @itemx -d @var{directory}
951 @cindex @code{--directory}
952 @cindex @code{-d}
953 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
954
955 @item -r
956 @itemx -readnow
957 @cindex @code{--readnow}
958 @cindex @code{-r}
959 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
960 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
961 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
962
963 @end table
964
965 @node Mode Options
966 @subsection Choosing modes
967
968 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
969 batch mode or quiet mode.
970
971 @table @code
972 @item -nx
973 @itemx -n
974 @cindex @code{--nx}
975 @cindex @code{-n}
976 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
977 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
978 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
979 files}.
980
981 @item -quiet
982 @itemx -silent
983 @itemx -q
984 @cindex @code{--quiet}
985 @cindex @code{--silent}
986 @cindex @code{-q}
987 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
988 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
989
990 @item -batch
991 @cindex @code{--batch}
992 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
993 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
994 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
995 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
996 in the command files.
997
998 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
999 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1000 make this more useful, the message
1001
1002 @smallexample
1003 Program exited normally.
1004 @end smallexample
1005
1006 @noindent
1007 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1008 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1009 mode.
1010
1011 @item -batch-silent
1012 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1013 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1014 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1015 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1016 for an interactive session.
1017
1018 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1019 messages, for example.
1020
1021 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1022 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1023
1024 @item -return-child-result
1025 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1026 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1027 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1028
1029 @itemize @bullet
1030 @item
1031 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1032 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1033 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1034 @item
1035 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1036 @item
1037 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1038 the exit code will be -1.
1039 @end itemize
1040
1041 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1042 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1043 interface.
1044
1045 @item -nowindows
1046 @itemx -nw
1047 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1048 @cindex @code{-nw}
1049 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1050 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1051 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1052
1053 @item -windows
1054 @itemx -w
1055 @cindex @code{--windows}
1056 @cindex @code{-w}
1057 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1058 used if possible.
1059
1060 @item -cd @var{directory}
1061 @cindex @code{--cd}
1062 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1063 instead of the current directory.
1064
1065 @item -fullname
1066 @itemx -f
1067 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1068 @cindex @code{-f}
1069 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1070 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1071 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1072 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1073 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1074 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1075 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1076 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1077 frame.
1078
1079 @item -epoch
1080 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1081 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1082 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1083 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1084 separate window.
1085
1086 @item -annotate @var{level}
1087 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1088 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1089 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1090 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1091 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1092 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1093 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1094 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1095 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1096
1097 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1098 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1099
1100 @item --args
1101 @cindex @code{--args}
1102 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1103 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1104 This option stops option processing.
1105
1106 @item -baud @var{bps}
1107 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1108 @cindex @code{--baud}
1109 @cindex @code{-b}
1110 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1111 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1112
1113 @item -l @var{timeout}
1114 @cindex @code{-l}
1115 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1116 for remote debugging.
1117
1118 @item -tty @var{device}
1119 @itemx -t @var{device}
1120 @cindex @code{--tty}
1121 @cindex @code{-t}
1122 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1123 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1124
1125 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1126 @item -tui
1127 @cindex @code{--tui}
1128 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1129 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1130 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1131 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1132 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1133 @samp{gdbtui}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1134 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1135
1136 @c @item -xdb
1137 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1138 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1139 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1140 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1141 @c systems.
1142
1143 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1144 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1145 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1146 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1147 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1148 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1149
1150 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1151 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1152 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1153 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1154 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1155 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1156
1157 @item -write
1158 @cindex @code{--write}
1159 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1160 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1161 (@pxref{Patching}).
1162
1163 @item -statistics
1164 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1165 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1166 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1167
1168 @item -version
1169 @cindex @code{--version}
1170 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1171 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1172
1173 @end table
1174
1175 @node Startup
1176 @subsection What @value{GDBN} does during startup
1177 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1178
1179 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1180
1181 @enumerate
1182 @item
1183 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1184 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1185
1186 @item
1187 @cindex init file
1188 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1189 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1190 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1191 that file.
1192
1193 @item
1194 Processes command line options and operands.
1195
1196 @item
1197 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1198 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1199 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1200 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1201 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1202 @value{GDBN}.
1203
1204 @item
1205 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1206 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1207
1208 @item
1209 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1210 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1211 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1212 @end enumerate
1213
1214 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1215 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1216 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1217 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1218 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1219 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
1220
1221 @cindex init file name
1222 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1223 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1224 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
1225 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
1226 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
1227 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
1228 environments with special init file names:
1229
1230 @itemize @bullet
1231 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1232 @item
1233 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1234 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1235 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1236 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1237 the file to the standard name.
1238
1239 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
1240 @item
1241 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
1242
1243 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
1244 @item
1245 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
1246
1247 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
1248 @item
1249 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
1250
1251 @item
1252 CISCO 68k: @file{.cisco-gdbinit}
1253 @end itemize
1254
1255
1256 @node Quitting GDB
1257 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1258 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1259 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1260
1261 @table @code
1262 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1263 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1264 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1265 @itemx q
1266 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1267 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1268 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1269 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1270 error code.
1271 @end table
1272
1273 @cindex interrupt
1274 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1275 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1276 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1277 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1278 until a time when it is safe.
1279
1280 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1281 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1282 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1283
1284 @node Shell Commands
1285 @section Shell commands
1286
1287 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1288 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1289 just use the @code{shell} command.
1290
1291 @table @code
1292 @kindex shell
1293 @cindex shell escape
1294 @item shell @var{command string}
1295 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1296 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1297 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1298 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1299 @end table
1300
1301 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1302 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1303 @value{GDBN}:
1304
1305 @table @code
1306 @kindex make
1307 @cindex calling make
1308 @item make @var{make-args}
1309 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1310 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1311 @end table
1312
1313 @node Logging output
1314 @section Logging output
1315 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1316 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1317
1318 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1319 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1320
1321 @table @code
1322 @kindex set logging
1323 @item set logging on
1324 Enable logging.
1325 @item set logging off
1326 Disable logging.
1327 @cindex logging file name
1328 @item set logging file @var{file}
1329 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1330 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1331 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1332 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1333 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1334 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1335 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1336 @kindex show logging
1337 @item show logging
1338 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1339 @end table
1340
1341 @node Commands
1342 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1343
1344 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1345 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1346 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1347 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1348 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1349
1350 @menu
1351 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1352 * Completion:: Command completion
1353 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1354 @end menu
1355
1356 @node Command Syntax
1357 @section Command syntax
1358
1359 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1360 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1361 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1362 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1363 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1364 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1365
1366 @cindex abbreviation
1367 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1368 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1369 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1370 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1371 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1372 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1373 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1374
1375 @cindex repeating commands
1376 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1377 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1378 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1379 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1380 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1381 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1382 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1383
1384 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1385 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1386 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1387
1388 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1389 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1390 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1391 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1392 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1393
1394 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1395 @cindex comment
1396 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1397 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1398 Files,,Command files}).
1399
1400 @cindex repeating command sequences
1401 @kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1402 The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1403 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1404 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1405 for editing.
1406
1407 @node Completion
1408 @section Command completion
1409
1410 @cindex completion
1411 @cindex word completion
1412 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1413 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1414 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1415 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1416
1417 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1418 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1419 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1420 enter it). For example, if you type
1421
1422 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1423 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1424 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1425 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1426 @smallexample
1427 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1428 @end smallexample
1429
1430 @noindent
1431 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1432 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1433
1434 @smallexample
1435 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1436 @end smallexample
1437
1438 @noindent
1439 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1440 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1441 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1442 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1443 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1444 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1445
1446 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1447 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1448 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1449 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1450 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1451 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1452 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1453 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1454 example:
1455
1456 @smallexample
1457 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1458 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1459 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1460 make_abs_section make_function_type
1461 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1462 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1463 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1464 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1465 @end smallexample
1466
1467 @noindent
1468 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1469 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1470 command.
1471
1472 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1473 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1474 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1475 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1476 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1477
1478 @cindex quotes in commands
1479 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1480 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1481 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1482 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1483 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1484 @value{GDBN} commands.
1485
1486 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1487 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1488 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1489 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1490 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1491 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1492 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1493 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1494 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1495 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1496 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1497
1498 @smallexample
1499 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1500 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1501 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1502 @end smallexample
1503
1504 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1505 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1506 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1507 place:
1508
1509 @smallexample
1510 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1511 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1512 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1513 @end smallexample
1514
1515 @noindent
1516 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1517 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1518 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1519
1520 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1521 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1522 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1523 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1524
1525
1526 @node Help
1527 @section Getting help
1528 @cindex online documentation
1529 @kindex help
1530
1531 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1532 using the command @code{help}.
1533
1534 @table @code
1535 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1536 @item help
1537 @itemx h
1538 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1539 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1540
1541 @smallexample
1542 (@value{GDBP}) help
1543 List of classes of commands:
1544
1545 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1546 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1547 data -- Examining data
1548 files -- Specifying and examining files
1549 internals -- Maintenance commands
1550 obscure -- Obscure features
1551 running -- Running the program
1552 stack -- Examining the stack
1553 status -- Status inquiries
1554 support -- Support facilities
1555 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1556 stopping the program
1557 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1558
1559 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1560 commands in that class.
1561 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1562 documentation.
1563 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1564 (@value{GDBP})
1565 @end smallexample
1566 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1567
1568 @item help @var{class}
1569 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1570 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1571 help display for the class @code{status}:
1572
1573 @smallexample
1574 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1575 Status inquiries.
1576
1577 List of commands:
1578
1579 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1580 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1581 info -- Generic command for showing things
1582 about the program being debugged
1583 show -- Generic command for showing things
1584 about the debugger
1585
1586 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1587 documentation.
1588 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1589 (@value{GDBP})
1590 @end smallexample
1591
1592 @item help @var{command}
1593 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1594 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1595
1596 @kindex apropos
1597 @item apropos @var{args}
1598 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1599 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1600 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1601
1602 @smallexample
1603 apropos reload
1604 @end smallexample
1605
1606 @noindent
1607 results in:
1608
1609 @smallexample
1610 @c @group
1611 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1612 multiple times in one run
1613 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1614 multiple times in one run
1615 @c @end group
1616 @end smallexample
1617
1618 @kindex complete
1619 @item complete @var{args}
1620 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1621 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1622 command you want completed. For example:
1623
1624 @smallexample
1625 complete i
1626 @end smallexample
1627
1628 @noindent results in:
1629
1630 @smallexample
1631 @group
1632 if
1633 ignore
1634 info
1635 inspect
1636 @end group
1637 @end smallexample
1638
1639 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1640 @end table
1641
1642 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1643 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1644 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1645 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1646 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1647 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1648
1649 @c @group
1650 @table @code
1651 @kindex info
1652 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1653 @item info
1654 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1655 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1656 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1657 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1658 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1659 @w{@code{help info}}.
1660
1661 @kindex set
1662 @item set
1663 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1664 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1665 @code{set prompt $}.
1666
1667 @kindex show
1668 @item show
1669 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1670 @value{GDBN} itself.
1671 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1672 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1673 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1674 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1675
1676 @kindex info set
1677 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1678 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1679 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1680 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1681 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1682 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1683 @end table
1684 @c @end group
1685
1686 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1687 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1688
1689 @table @code
1690 @kindex show version
1691 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1692 @item show version
1693 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1694 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1695 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1696 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1697 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1698 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1699 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1700 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1701 @value{GDBN}.
1702
1703 @kindex show copying
1704 @kindex info copying
1705 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1706 @item show copying
1707 @itemx info copying
1708 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1709
1710 @kindex show warranty
1711 @kindex info warranty
1712 @item show warranty
1713 @itemx info warranty
1714 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1715 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1716
1717 @end table
1718
1719 @node Running
1720 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1721
1722 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1723 debugging information when you compile it.
1724
1725 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1726 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1727 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1728 kill a child process.
1729
1730 @menu
1731 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1732 * Starting:: Starting your program
1733 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1734 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1735
1736 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1737 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1738 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1739 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1740
1741 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1742 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1743 @end menu
1744
1745 @node Compilation
1746 @section Compiling for debugging
1747
1748 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1749 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1750 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1751 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1752 and addresses in the executable code.
1753
1754 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1755 the compiler.
1756
1757 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1758 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1759 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1760 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1761 executables containing debugging information.
1762
1763 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1764 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1765 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1766 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1767 in pushing your luck.
1768
1769 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1770 @cindex debugging optimized code
1771 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1772 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1773 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1774 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1775 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1776 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1777
1778 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1779 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1780 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1781 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1782 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1783
1784 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1785 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1786 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1787
1788 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1789 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1790 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1791 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1792 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1793 provides macro information if you specify the options
1794 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1795 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1796 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1797 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1798 @option{-g} alone.
1799
1800 @need 2000
1801 @node Starting
1802 @section Starting your program
1803 @cindex starting
1804 @cindex running
1805
1806 @table @code
1807 @kindex run
1808 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1809 @item run
1810 @itemx r
1811 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1812 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1813 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1814 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1815 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1816
1817 @end table
1818
1819 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1820 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1821 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1822 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1823
1824 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1825 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1826 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1827 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1828 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1829 divided into four categories:
1830
1831 @table @asis
1832 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1833 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1834 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1835 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1836 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1837 the arguments.
1838 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1839 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1840 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1841
1842 @item The @emph{environment.}
1843 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1844 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1845 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1846 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1847
1848 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1849 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1850 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1851 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1852
1853 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1854 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1855 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1856 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1857 set a different device for your program.
1858 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1859
1860 @cindex pipes
1861 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1862 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1863 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1864 wrong program.
1865 @end table
1866
1867 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1868 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1869 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1870 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1871 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1872
1873 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1874 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1875 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1876 your current breakpoints.
1877
1878 @table @code
1879 @kindex start
1880 @item start
1881 @cindex run to main procedure
1882 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1883 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1884 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1885 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1886 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1887 procedure, depending on the language used.
1888
1889 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1890 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1891 the @samp{run} command.
1892
1893 @cindex elaboration phase
1894 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1895 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1896 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1897 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1898 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1899 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1900 will remain to halt execution.
1901
1902 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1903 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1904 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1905 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1906 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1907
1908 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1909 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1910 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1911 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1912 elaboration code before running your program.
1913 @end table
1914
1915 @node Arguments
1916 @section Your program's arguments
1917
1918 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1919 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1920 @code{run} command.
1921 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1922 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1923 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1924 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1925 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1926
1927 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1928 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1929 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1930 the program, not by the shell.
1931
1932 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1933 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1934
1935 @table @code
1936 @kindex set args
1937 @item set args
1938 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1939 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1940 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1941 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1942 it again without arguments.
1943
1944 @kindex show args
1945 @item show args
1946 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1947 @end table
1948
1949 @node Environment
1950 @section Your program's environment
1951
1952 @cindex environment (of your program)
1953 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1954 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1955 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1956 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1957 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1958 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1959 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1960
1961 @table @code
1962 @kindex path
1963 @item path @var{directory}
1964 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1965 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1966 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1967 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1968 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1969 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1970 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1971
1972 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1973 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1974 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1975 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1976 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1977 @var{directory} to the search path.
1978 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1979 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1980
1981 @kindex show paths
1982 @item show paths
1983 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1984 environment variable).
1985
1986 @kindex show environment
1987 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1988 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1989 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1990 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1991 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1992
1993 @kindex set environment
1994 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1995 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1996 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1997 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1998 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1999 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2000 null value.
2001 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2002 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2003
2004 For example, this command:
2005
2006 @smallexample
2007 set env USER = foo
2008 @end smallexample
2009
2010 @noindent
2011 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2012 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2013 are not actually required.)
2014
2015 @kindex unset environment
2016 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2017 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2018 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2019 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2020 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2021 @end table
2022
2023 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2024 the shell indicated
2025 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2026 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2027 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2028 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2029 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2030 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2031 @file{.profile}.
2032
2033 @node Working Directory
2034 @section Your program's working directory
2035
2036 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2037 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2038 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2039 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2040 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2041 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2042
2043 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2044 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2045 specify files}.
2046
2047 @table @code
2048 @kindex cd
2049 @cindex change working directory
2050 @item cd @var{directory}
2051 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2052
2053 @kindex pwd
2054 @item pwd
2055 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2056 @end table
2057
2058 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2059 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2060 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2061 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2062 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2063 current working directory of the debuggee.
2064
2065 @node Input/Output
2066 @section Your program's input and output
2067
2068 @cindex redirection
2069 @cindex i/o
2070 @cindex terminal
2071 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2072 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2073 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2074 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2075 running your program.
2076
2077 @table @code
2078 @kindex info terminal
2079 @item info terminal
2080 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2081 program is using.
2082 @end table
2083
2084 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2085 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2086
2087 @smallexample
2088 run > outfile
2089 @end smallexample
2090
2091 @noindent
2092 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2093
2094 @kindex tty
2095 @cindex controlling terminal
2096 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2097 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2098 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2099 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2100 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2101
2102 @smallexample
2103 tty /dev/ttyb
2104 @end smallexample
2105
2106 @noindent
2107 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2108 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2109 that as their controlling terminal.
2110
2111 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2112 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2113 terminal.
2114
2115 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2116 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2117 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2118 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2119
2120 @cindex inferior tty
2121 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2122 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2123 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2124 program.
2125
2126 @table @code
2127 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2128 @kindex set inferior-tty
2129 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2130
2131 @item show inferior-tty
2132 @kindex show inferior-tty
2133 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2134 @end table
2135
2136 @node Attach
2137 @section Debugging an already-running process
2138 @kindex attach
2139 @cindex attach
2140
2141 @table @code
2142 @item attach @var{process-id}
2143 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2144 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2145 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2146 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2147 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2148
2149 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2150 executing the command.
2151 @end table
2152
2153 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2154 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2155 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2156 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2157
2158 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2159 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2160 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2161 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
2162 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2163 Specify Files}.
2164
2165 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2166 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2167 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2168 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2169 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2170 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2171 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2172
2173 @table @code
2174 @kindex detach
2175 @item detach
2176 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2177 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2178 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2179 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2180 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2181 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2182 executing the command.
2183 @end table
2184
2185 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2186 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2187 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2188 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2189 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
2190 messages}).
2191
2192 @node Kill Process
2193 @section Killing the child process
2194
2195 @table @code
2196 @kindex kill
2197 @item kill
2198 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2199 @end table
2200
2201 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2202 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2203 is running.
2204
2205 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2206 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2207 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2208 outside the debugger.
2209
2210 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2211 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2212 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2213 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2214 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2215 breakpoint settings).
2216
2217 @node Threads
2218 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
2219
2220 @cindex threads of execution
2221 @cindex multiple threads
2222 @cindex switching threads
2223 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2224 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2225 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2226 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2227 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2228 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2229 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2230
2231 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2232 programs:
2233
2234 @itemize @bullet
2235 @item automatic notification of new threads
2236 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2237 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2238 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2239 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2240 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2241 @end itemize
2242
2243 @quotation
2244 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2245 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2246 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2247 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2248 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2249 like this:
2250
2251 @smallexample
2252 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2253 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2254 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2255 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2256 @end smallexample
2257 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2258 @c doesn't support threads"?
2259 @end quotation
2260
2261 @cindex focus of debugging
2262 @cindex current thread
2263 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2264 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2265 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2266 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2267 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2268
2269 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2270 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2271 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2272 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2273 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2274 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2275 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2276 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2277 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2278 LynxOS, you might see
2279
2280 @smallexample
2281 [New process 35 thread 27]
2282 @end smallexample
2283
2284 @noindent
2285 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2286 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2287 further qualifier.
2288
2289 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2290 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2291 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2292 @c program?
2293 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2294 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2295 @c threads ab initio?
2296
2297 @cindex thread number
2298 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2299 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2300 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2301
2302 @table @code
2303 @kindex info threads
2304 @item info threads
2305 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2306 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2307
2308 @enumerate
2309 @item
2310 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2311
2312 @item
2313 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2314
2315 @item
2316 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2317 @end enumerate
2318
2319 @noindent
2320 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2321 indicates the current thread.
2322
2323 For example,
2324 @end table
2325 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2326
2327 @smallexample
2328 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2329 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2330 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2331 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2332 at threadtest.c:68
2333 @end smallexample
2334
2335 On HP-UX systems:
2336
2337 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2338 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2339 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2340 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2341 thread in your program.
2342
2343 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2344 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2345 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2346 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2347 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2348 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2349 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2350 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2351 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2352 HP-UX, you see
2353
2354 @smallexample
2355 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2356 @end smallexample
2357
2358 @noindent
2359 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2360
2361 @table @code
2362 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2363 @item info threads
2364 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2365 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2366
2367 @enumerate
2368 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2369
2370 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2371
2372 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2373 @end enumerate
2374
2375 @noindent
2376 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2377 indicates the current thread.
2378
2379 For example,
2380 @end table
2381 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2382
2383 @smallexample
2384 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2385 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2386 at quicksort.c:137
2387 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2388 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2389 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2390 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2391 @end smallexample
2392
2393 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2394 Solaris-specific command:
2395
2396 @table @code
2397 @item maint info sol-threads
2398 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2399 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2400 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2401 @end table
2402
2403 @table @code
2404 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2405 @item thread @var{threadno}
2406 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2407 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2408 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2409 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2410 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2411
2412 @smallexample
2413 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2414 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2415 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2416 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2417 @end smallexample
2418
2419 @noindent
2420 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2421 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2422 threads.
2423
2424 @kindex thread apply
2425 @cindex apply command to several threads
2426 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2427 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2428 more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2429 with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2430 @value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
2431 threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2432 @code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
2433 @end table
2434
2435 @cindex automatic thread selection
2436 @cindex switching threads automatically
2437 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2438 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2439 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2440 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2441 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2442 thread.
2443
2444 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2445 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2446 programs with multiple threads.
2447
2448 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2449 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2450
2451 @node Processes
2452 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2453
2454 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2455 @cindex multiple processes
2456 @cindex processes, multiple
2457 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2458 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2459 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2460 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2461 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2462 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2463 will cause it to terminate.
2464
2465 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2466 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2467 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2468 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2469 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2470 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2471 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2472 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2473 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2474 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2475
2476 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2477 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2478 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2479 only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2480
2481 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2482 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2483
2484 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2485 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2486
2487 @table @code
2488 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2489 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2490 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2491 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2492 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2493
2494 @table @code
2495 @item parent
2496 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2497 unimpeded. This is the default.
2498
2499 @item child
2500 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2501 unimpeded.
2502
2503 @end table
2504
2505 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2506 @item show follow-fork-mode
2507 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2508 @end table
2509
2510 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2511 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2512 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2513 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2514 the child process's @code{main}.
2515
2516 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2517 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2518
2519 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2520 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2521 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2522 argument.
2523
2524 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2525 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2526 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2527
2528 @node Stopping
2529 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2530
2531 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2532 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2533 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2534
2535 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2536 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2537 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2538 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2539 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2540 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2541 explicitly request this information at any time.
2542
2543 @table @code
2544 @kindex info program
2545 @item info program
2546 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2547 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2548 @end table
2549
2550 @menu
2551 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2552 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2553 * Signals:: Signals
2554 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2555 @end menu
2556
2557 @node Breakpoints
2558 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2559
2560 @cindex breakpoints
2561 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2562 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2563 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2564 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2565 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2566 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2567 program.
2568
2569 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2570 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2571 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2572 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2573 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2574 call).
2575
2576 @cindex watchpoints
2577 @cindex memory tracing
2578 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2579 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2580 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2581 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2582 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2583 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2584 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2585 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2586
2587 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2588 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2589 Automatic display}.
2590
2591 @cindex catchpoints
2592 @cindex breakpoint on events
2593 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2594 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2595 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2596 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2597 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2598 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2599 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2600
2601 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2602 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2603 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2604 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2605 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2606 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2607 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2608 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2609 enable it again.
2610
2611 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2612 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2613 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2614 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2615 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2616 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2617 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2618
2619 @menu
2620 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2621 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2622 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2623 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2624 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2625 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2626 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2627 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2628 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2629 * Breakpoint related warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2630 @end menu
2631
2632 @node Set Breaks
2633 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2634
2635 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2636 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2637 @c
2638 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2639
2640 @kindex break
2641 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2642 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2643 @cindex latest breakpoint
2644 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2645 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2646 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2647 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2648 convenience variables.
2649
2650 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2651
2652 @table @code
2653 @item break @var{function}
2654 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2655 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2656 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2657 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2658
2659 @item break +@var{offset}
2660 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2661 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2662 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2663 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2664
2665 @item break @var{linenum}
2666 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2667 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2668 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2669 code on that line.
2670
2671 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2672 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2673
2674 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2675 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2676 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2677 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2678 functions.
2679
2680 @item break *@var{address}
2681 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2682 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2683 information or source files.
2684
2685 @item break
2686 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2687 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2688 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2689 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2690 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2691 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2692 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2693 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2694 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2695 inside loops.
2696
2697 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2698 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2699 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2700 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2701 existed when your program stopped.
2702
2703 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2704 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2705 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2706 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2707 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2708 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2709 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2710
2711 @kindex tbreak
2712 @item tbreak @var{args}
2713 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2714 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2715 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2716 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2717
2718 @kindex hbreak
2719 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2720 @item hbreak @var{args}
2721 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2722 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2723 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2724 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2725 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2726 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2727 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2728 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2729 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2730 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2731 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2732 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2733 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2734 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2735 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2736 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2737 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2738
2739
2740 @kindex thbreak
2741 @item thbreak @var{args}
2742 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2743 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2744 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2745 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2746 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2747 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2748 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2749 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2750
2751 @kindex rbreak
2752 @cindex regular expression
2753 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2754 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2755 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2756 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2757 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2758 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2759 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2760 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2761 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2762
2763 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2764 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2765 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2766 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2767 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2768 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2769
2770 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2771 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2772 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2773 classes.
2774
2775 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2776 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2777 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2778
2779 @smallexample
2780 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2781 @end smallexample
2782
2783 @kindex info breakpoints
2784 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2785 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2786 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2787 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2788 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2789 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2790
2791 @table @emph
2792 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2793 @item Type
2794 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2795 @item Disposition
2796 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2797 @item Enabled or Disabled
2798 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2799 that are not enabled.
2800 @item Address
2801 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. If the
2802 breakpoint is pending (see below for details) on a future load of a shared library, the address
2803 will be listed as @samp{<PENDING>}.
2804 @item What
2805 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2806 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
2807 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
2808 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
2809 @end table
2810
2811 @noindent
2812 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2813 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2814 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
2815 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
2816 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
2817 valid location.
2818
2819 @noindent
2820 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
2821 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2822 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2823 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2824 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2825
2826 @noindent
2827 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2828 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2829 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2830 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2831 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2832 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2833 @end table
2834
2835 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2836 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2837 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2838 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2839
2840 @cindex pending breakpoints
2841 If a specified breakpoint location cannot be found, it may be due to the fact
2842 that the location is in a shared library that is yet to be loaded. In such
2843 a case, you may want @value{GDBN} to create a special breakpoint (known as
2844 a @dfn{pending breakpoint}) that
2845 attempts to resolve itself in the future when an appropriate shared library
2846 gets loaded.
2847
2848 Pending breakpoints are useful to set at the start of your
2849 @value{GDBN} session for locations that you know will be dynamically loaded
2850 later by the program being debugged. When shared libraries are loaded,
2851 a check is made to see if the load resolves any pending breakpoint locations.
2852 If a pending breakpoint location gets resolved,
2853 a regular breakpoint is created and the original pending breakpoint is removed.
2854
2855 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling pending
2856 breakpoint support:
2857
2858 @kindex set breakpoint pending
2859 @kindex show breakpoint pending
2860 @table @code
2861 @item set breakpoint pending auto
2862 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
2863 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
2864
2865 @item set breakpoint pending on
2866 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
2867 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
2868
2869 @item set breakpoint pending off
2870 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
2871 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
2872 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
2873
2874 @item show breakpoint pending
2875 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
2876 @end table
2877
2878 @cindex operations allowed on pending breakpoints
2879 Normal breakpoint operations apply to pending breakpoints as well. You may
2880 specify a condition for a pending breakpoint and/or commands to run when the
2881 breakpoint is reached. You can also enable or disable
2882 the pending breakpoint. When you specify a condition for a pending breakpoint,
2883 the parsing of the condition will be deferred until the point where the
2884 pending breakpoint location is resolved. Disabling a pending breakpoint
2885 tells @value{GDBN} to not attempt to resolve the breakpoint on any subsequent
2886 shared library load. When a pending breakpoint is re-enabled,
2887 @value{GDBN} checks to see if the location is already resolved.
2888 This is done because any number of shared library loads could have
2889 occurred since the time the breakpoint was disabled and one or more
2890 of these loads could resolve the location.
2891
2892 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2893 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2894 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2895 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2896 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2897 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2898 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2899 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
2900
2901
2902 @node Set Watchpoints
2903 @subsection Setting watchpoints
2904
2905 @cindex setting watchpoints
2906 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2907 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2908 this may happen.
2909
2910 @cindex software watchpoints
2911 @cindex hardware watchpoints
2912 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2913 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2914 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2915 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2916 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2917 culprit.)
2918
2919 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
2920 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
2921 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
2922
2923 @table @code
2924 @kindex watch
2925 @item watch @var{expr}
2926 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2927 is written into by the program and its value changes.
2928
2929 @kindex rwatch
2930 @item rwatch @var{expr}
2931 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
2932 by the program.
2933
2934 @kindex awatch
2935 @item awatch @var{expr}
2936 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
2937 or written into by the program.
2938
2939 @kindex info watchpoints
2940 @item info watchpoints
2941 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2942 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
2943 @end table
2944
2945 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2946 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2947 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2948 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2949 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2950 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2951
2952 @cindex use only software watchpoints
2953 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
2954 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
2955 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
2956 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
2957 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
2958 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
2959 mechanism of watching expressiion values.)
2960
2961 @table @code
2962 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
2963 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
2964 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
2965
2966 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
2967 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
2968 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
2969 @end table
2970
2971 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2972 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2973 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2974
2975 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2976
2977 @smallexample
2978 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2979 @end smallexample
2980
2981 @noindent
2982 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2983
2984 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2985 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2986 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2987 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2988 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2989 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2990 will print a message like this:
2991
2992 @smallexample
2993 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2994 @end smallexample
2995
2996 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2997 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2998 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2999 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3000 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3001 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3002 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3003 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3004
3005 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3006 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3007 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3008 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3009 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3010 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3011
3012 @smallexample
3013 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3014 @end smallexample
3015
3016 @noindent
3017 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3018
3019 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3020 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3021 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3022 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3023 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3024 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3025 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3026 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3027 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3028 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3029
3030 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3031 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3032 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3033
3034 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3035 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3036 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3037 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3038 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3039 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3040 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3041 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3042 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3043
3044 @quotation
3045 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3046 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3047 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
3048 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
3049 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
3050 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
3051 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
3052 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
3053 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
3054 the expression.
3055
3056 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
3057 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
3058 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3059 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3060 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3061 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3062 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3063 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3064 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3065 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3066 @end quotation
3067
3068 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3069
3070 @node Set Catchpoints
3071 @subsection Setting catchpoints
3072 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3073 @cindex exception handlers
3074 @cindex event handling
3075
3076 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3077 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3078 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3079
3080 @table @code
3081 @kindex catch
3082 @item catch @var{event}
3083 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3084 @table @code
3085 @item throw
3086 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3087 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3088
3089 @item catch
3090 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3091
3092 @item exec
3093 @cindex break on fork/exec
3094 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3095
3096 @item fork
3097 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3098
3099 @item vfork
3100 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3101
3102 @item load
3103 @itemx load @var{libname}
3104 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3105 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3106 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3107
3108 @item unload
3109 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3110 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3111 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3112 @end table
3113
3114 @item tcatch @var{event}
3115 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3116 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3117
3118 @end table
3119
3120 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3121
3122 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3123 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3124
3125 @itemize @bullet
3126 @item
3127 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3128 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3129 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3130 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3131 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3132 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3133 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3134 disabled within interactive calls.
3135
3136 @item
3137 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3138
3139 @item
3140 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3141 @end itemize
3142
3143 @cindex raise exceptions
3144 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3145 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3146 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3147 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3148 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3149 out where the exception was raised.
3150
3151 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3152 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3153 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3154 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3155
3156 @smallexample
3157 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3158 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3159 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3160 @end smallexample
3161
3162 @noindent
3163 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3164 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3165 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
3166
3167 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
3168 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3169 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3170 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3171 raised.
3172
3173
3174 @node Delete Breaks
3175 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
3176
3177 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3178 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3179 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3180 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3181 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3182 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3183
3184 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3185 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3186 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3187 their breakpoint numbers.
3188
3189 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3190 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3191 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3192
3193 @table @code
3194 @kindex clear
3195 @item clear
3196 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3197 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
3198 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3199 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3200
3201 @item clear @var{function}
3202 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3203 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3204
3205 @item clear @var{linenum}
3206 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3207 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3208 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3209
3210 @cindex delete breakpoints
3211 @kindex delete
3212 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3213 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3214 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3215 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3216 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3217 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3218 @end table
3219
3220 @node Disabling
3221 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
3222
3223 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3224 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3225 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3226 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3227 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3228
3229 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3230 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3231 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3232 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3233 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3234
3235 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3236 states of enablement:
3237
3238 @itemize @bullet
3239 @item
3240 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3241 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3242 @item
3243 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3244 @item
3245 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3246 disabled.
3247 @item
3248 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3249 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3250 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3251 @end itemize
3252
3253 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3254 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3255
3256 @table @code
3257 @kindex disable
3258 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3259 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3260 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3261 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3262 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3263 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3264 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3265
3266 @kindex enable
3267 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3268 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3269 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3270
3271 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3272 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3273 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3274
3275 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3276 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3277 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3278 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3279 @end table
3280
3281 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3282 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3283 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3284 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3285 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3286 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3287 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3288 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3289 stepping}.)
3290
3291 @node Conditions
3292 @subsection Break conditions
3293 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3294 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3295
3296 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3297 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3298 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3299 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3300 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3301 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3302 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3303 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3304
3305 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3306 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3307 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3308 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3309 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3310
3311 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3312 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3313 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3314 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3315 one.
3316
3317 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3318 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3319 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3320 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3321 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3322 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3323 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3324 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3325 conditions for the
3326 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3327 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3328
3329 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3330 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3331 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3332 with the @code{condition} command.
3333
3334 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3335 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3336 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3337 catchpoint.
3338
3339 @table @code
3340 @kindex condition
3341 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3342 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3343 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3344 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3345 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3346 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3347 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3348 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3349 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3350 prints an error message:
3351
3352 @smallexample
3353 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3354 @end smallexample
3355
3356 @noindent
3357 @value{GDBN} does
3358 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3359 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3360 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3361
3362 @item condition @var{bnum}
3363 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3364 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3365 @end table
3366
3367 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3368 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3369 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3370 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3371 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3372 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3373 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3374 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3375 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3376 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3377 your program reaches it.
3378
3379 @table @code
3380 @kindex ignore
3381 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3382 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3383 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3384 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3385 takes no action.
3386
3387 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3388 a count of zero.
3389
3390 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3391 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3392 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3393 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3394
3395 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3396 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3397 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3398
3399 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3400 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3401 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3402 variables}.
3403 @end table
3404
3405 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3406
3407
3408 @node Break Commands
3409 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3410
3411 @cindex breakpoint commands
3412 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3413 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3414 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3415 enable other breakpoints.
3416
3417 @table @code
3418 @kindex commands
3419 @kindex end
3420 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3421 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3422 @itemx end
3423 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3424 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3425 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3426
3427 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3428 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3429
3430 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3431 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3432 recently encountered).
3433 @end table
3434
3435 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3436 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3437
3438 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3439 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3440 that resumes execution.
3441
3442 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3443 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3444 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3445 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3446 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3447
3448 @kindex silent
3449 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3450 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3451 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3452 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3453 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3454 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3455
3456 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3457 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3458 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3459
3460 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3461 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3462
3463 @smallexample
3464 break foo if x>0
3465 commands
3466 silent
3467 printf "x is %d\n",x
3468 cont
3469 end
3470 @end smallexample
3471
3472 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3473 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3474 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3475 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3476 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3477 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3478 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3479
3480 @smallexample
3481 break 403
3482 commands
3483 silent
3484 set x = y + 4
3485 cont
3486 end
3487 @end smallexample
3488
3489 @node Breakpoint Menus
3490 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3491 @cindex overloading
3492 @cindex symbol overloading
3493
3494 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3495 single function name
3496 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3497 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3498 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3499 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3500 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3501 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3502 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3503 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3504 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3505 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3506 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3507 breakpoints.
3508
3509 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3510 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3511 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3512
3513 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3514 @smallexample
3515 @group
3516 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3517 [0] cancel
3518 [1] all
3519 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3520 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3521 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3522 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3523 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3524 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3525 > 2 4 6
3526 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3527 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3528 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3529 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3530 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3531 breakpoints.
3532 (@value{GDBP})
3533 @end group
3534 @end smallexample
3535
3536 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3537 @node Error in Breakpoints
3538 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3539 @c
3540 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3541 @c
3542 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3543 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3544 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3545 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3546
3547 @smallexample
3548 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3549 The same program may be running in another process.
3550 @end smallexample
3551
3552 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3553
3554 @enumerate
3555 @item
3556 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3557
3558 @item
3559 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3560 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3561 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3562 Then start your program again.
3563
3564 @item
3565 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3566 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3567 to nonsharable executables.
3568 @end enumerate
3569 @c @end ifclear
3570
3571 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3572 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3573
3574 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3575 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3576 @smallexample
3577 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3578 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3579 @end smallexample
3580
3581 @noindent
3582 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3583 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3584 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3585
3586 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3587 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3588
3589 @node Breakpoint related warnings
3590 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3591 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3592
3593 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3594 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3595 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3596 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3597
3598 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3599 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3600 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3601 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3602 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3603 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3604 first in the bundle.
3605
3606 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3607 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3608 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3609 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3610 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3611 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3612 is hit.
3613
3614 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3615 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3616
3617 @smallexample
3618 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3619 @end smallexample
3620
3621 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3622 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3623 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3624 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3625 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3626 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3627 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3628 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3629
3630 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3631 adjusted breakpoints:
3632
3633 @smallexample
3634 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3635 to 0x00010410.
3636 @end smallexample
3637
3638 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3639 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3640 frequently than expected.
3641
3642 @node Continuing and Stepping
3643 @section Continuing and stepping
3644
3645 @cindex stepping
3646 @cindex continuing
3647 @cindex resuming execution
3648 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3649 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3650 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3651 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3652 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3653 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3654 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3655 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3656
3657 @table @code
3658 @kindex continue
3659 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3660 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3661 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3662 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3663 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3664 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3665 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3666 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3667 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3668 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3669
3670 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3671 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3672 @code{continue} is ignored.
3673
3674 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3675 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3676 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3677 @code{continue}.
3678 @end table
3679
3680 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3681 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3682 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3683 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3684
3685 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3686 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3687 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3688 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3689 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3690 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3691
3692 @table @code
3693 @kindex step
3694 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3695 @item step
3696 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3697 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3698 abbreviated @code{s}.
3699
3700 @quotation
3701 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3702 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3703 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3704 @c distinction here.
3705 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3706 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3707 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3708 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3709 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3710 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3711 below.
3712 @end quotation
3713
3714 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3715 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3716 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3717 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3718 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3719 called within the line.
3720
3721 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3722 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3723 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3724 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3725 was any debugging information about the routine.
3726
3727 @item step @var{count}
3728 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3729 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3730 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3731
3732 @kindex next
3733 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3734 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3735 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3736 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3737 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3738 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3739 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3740 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3741
3742 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3743
3744
3745 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3746 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3747 @c
3748 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3749 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3750 @c function are executed without stopping.
3751
3752 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3753 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3754 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3755
3756 @kindex set step-mode
3757 @item set step-mode
3758 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3759 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3760 @itemx set step-mode on
3761 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
3762 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3763 information rather than stepping over it.
3764
3765 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3766 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3767 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
3768
3769 @item set step-mode off
3770 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
3771 debug information. This is the default.
3772
3773 @item show step-mode
3774 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
3775 source line debug information.
3776
3777 @kindex finish
3778 @item finish
3779 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3780 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3781
3782 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3783 ,Returning from a function}).
3784
3785 @kindex until
3786 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3787 @cindex run until specified location
3788 @item until
3789 @itemx u
3790 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3791 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3792 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3793 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3794 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3795 than the address of the jump.
3796
3797 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3798 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3799 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3800 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3801 through the next iteration.
3802
3803 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3804 stack frame.
3805
3806 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3807 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3808 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3809 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3810 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3811
3812 @smallexample
3813 (@value{GDBP}) f
3814 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3815 206 expand_input();
3816 (@value{GDBP}) until
3817 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3818 @end smallexample
3819
3820 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3821 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3822 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3823 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3824 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3825 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3826 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3827
3828 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3829 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3830 argument.
3831
3832 @item until @var{location}
3833 @itemx u @var{location}
3834 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3835 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3836 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3837 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
3838 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
3839 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
3840 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
3841 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
3842 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
3843 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
3844 invocations have returned.
3845
3846 @smallexample
3847 94 int factorial (int value)
3848 95 @{
3849 96 if (value > 1) @{
3850 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
3851 98 @}
3852 99 return (value);
3853 100 @}
3854 @end smallexample
3855
3856
3857 @kindex advance @var{location}
3858 @itemx advance @var{location}
3859 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
3860 required, which should be of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
3861 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
3862 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
3863 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
3864 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
3865
3866
3867 @kindex stepi
3868 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
3869 @item stepi
3870 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
3871 @itemx si
3872 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3873
3874 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3875 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3876 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3877 Display,, Automatic display}.
3878
3879 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3880
3881 @need 750
3882 @kindex nexti
3883 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
3884 @item nexti
3885 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
3886 @itemx ni
3887 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3888 proceed until the function returns.
3889
3890 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3891 @end table
3892
3893 @node Signals
3894 @section Signals
3895 @cindex signals
3896
3897 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3898 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3899 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
3900 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
3901 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3902 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3903 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3904 requested an alarm).
3905
3906 @cindex fatal signals
3907 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3908 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
3909 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
3910 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3911 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3912 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3913
3914 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3915 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3916 signal.
3917
3918 @cindex handling signals
3919 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3920 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3921 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
3922 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3923 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3924
3925 @table @code
3926 @kindex info signals
3927 @kindex info handle
3928 @item info signals
3929 @itemx info handle
3930 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3931 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3932 the defined types of signals.
3933
3934 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
3935
3936 @kindex handle
3937 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3938 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3939 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
3940 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
3941 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3942 known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3943 @end table
3944
3945 @c @group
3946 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3947 Their full names are:
3948
3949 @table @code
3950 @item nostop
3951 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3952 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3953
3954 @item stop
3955 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3956 the @code{print} keyword as well.
3957
3958 @item print
3959 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3960
3961 @item noprint
3962 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3963 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3964
3965 @item pass
3966 @itemx noignore
3967 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3968 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3969 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
3970
3971 @item nopass
3972 @itemx ignore
3973 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3974 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
3975 @end table
3976 @c @end group
3977
3978 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3979 program until you
3980 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3981 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3982 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3983 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3984 program sees that signal when you continue.
3985
3986 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3987 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3988 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3989 erroneous signals.
3990
3991 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3992 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3993 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3994 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3995 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3996 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3997 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3998 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3999 program a signal}.
4000
4001 @node Thread Stops
4002 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
4003
4004 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4005 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
4006 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4007
4008 @table @code
4009 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4010 @cindex thread breakpoints
4011 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4012 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4013 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4014 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4015 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4016
4017 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4018 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4019 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4020 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4021 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4022
4023 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4024 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4025 program.
4026
4027 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4028 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4029 breakpoint condition, like this:
4030
4031 @smallexample
4032 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4033 @end smallexample
4034
4035 @end table
4036
4037 @cindex stopped threads
4038 @cindex threads, stopped
4039 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4040 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4041 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4042 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4043 underfoot.
4044
4045 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4046 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4047 @cindex premature return from system calls
4048 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4049 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4050 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4051 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4052 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4053 stop execution.
4054
4055 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4056 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4057 style anyways.
4058
4059 For example, do not write code like this:
4060
4061 @smallexample
4062 sleep (10);
4063 @end smallexample
4064
4065 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4066 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4067
4068 Instead, write this:
4069
4070 @smallexample
4071 int unslept = 10;
4072 while (unslept > 0)
4073 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4074 @end smallexample
4075
4076 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4077 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4078 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4079 @value{GDBN}.
4080
4081 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4082 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4083 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4084 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4085
4086 @cindex continuing threads
4087 @cindex threads, continuing
4088 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4089 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4090 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4091
4092 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4093 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4094 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4095 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4096 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4097 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4098 stops.
4099
4100 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4101 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4102 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4103 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4104
4105 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4106 thread to run.
4107
4108 @table @code
4109 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4110 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4111 @cindex lock scheduler
4112 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4113 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4114 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4115 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4116 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4117 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4118 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4119 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4120 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4121 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4122 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4123
4124 @item show scheduler-locking
4125 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4126 @end table
4127
4128
4129 @node Stack
4130 @chapter Examining the Stack
4131
4132 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4133 stopped and how it got there.
4134
4135 @cindex call stack
4136 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4137 is generated.
4138 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4139 the arguments of the call,
4140 and the local variables of the function being called.
4141 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4142 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4143 stack}.
4144
4145 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4146 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4147
4148 @cindex selected frame
4149 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4150 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4151 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4152 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4153 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4154 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4155
4156 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4157 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4158 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
4159
4160 @menu
4161 * Frames:: Stack frames
4162 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4163 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4164 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4165
4166 @end menu
4167
4168 @node Frames
4169 @section Stack frames
4170
4171 @cindex frame, definition
4172 @cindex stack frame
4173 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4174 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4175 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4176 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4177 which the function is executing.
4178
4179 @cindex initial frame
4180 @cindex outermost frame
4181 @cindex innermost frame
4182 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4183 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4184 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4185 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4186 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4187 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4188 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4189 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4190
4191 @cindex frame pointer
4192 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4193 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4194 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4195 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4196 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4197 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4198
4199 @cindex frame number
4200 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4201 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4202 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4203 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4204 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4205
4206 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4207 @c underflow problems.
4208 @cindex frameless execution
4209 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4210 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
4211 @smallexample
4212 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4213 @end smallexample
4214 generates functions without a frame.)
4215 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4216 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4217 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4218 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4219 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4220 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4221 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4222
4223 @table @code
4224 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4225 @cindex current stack frame
4226 @item frame @var{args}
4227 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4228 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4229 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4230 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4231
4232 @kindex select-frame
4233 @cindex selecting frame silently
4234 @item select-frame
4235 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4236 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4237 @code{frame}.
4238 @end table
4239
4240 @node Backtrace
4241 @section Backtraces
4242
4243 @cindex traceback
4244 @cindex call stack traces
4245 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4246 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4247 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4248 stack.
4249
4250 @table @code
4251 @kindex backtrace
4252 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4253 @item backtrace
4254 @itemx bt
4255 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4256 frames in the stack.
4257
4258 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4259 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
4260
4261 @item backtrace @var{n}
4262 @itemx bt @var{n}
4263 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4264
4265 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4266 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4267 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4268
4269 @item backtrace full
4270 Print the values of the local variables also.
4271 @itemx bt full
4272 @end table
4273
4274 @kindex where
4275 @kindex info stack
4276 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4277 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4278
4279 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4280 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4281 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4282 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4283 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4284 line number.
4285
4286 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4287 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4288
4289 @smallexample
4290 @group
4291 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4292 at builtin.c:993
4293 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4294 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4295 at macro.c:71
4296 (More stack frames follow...)
4297 @end group
4298 @end smallexample
4299
4300 @noindent
4301 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4302 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4303 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4304
4305 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4306 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4307 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4308 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4309 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4310 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4311 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4312 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4313 such a backtrace might look like:
4314
4315 @smallexample
4316 @group
4317 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4318 at builtin.c:993
4319 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4320 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4321 at macro.c:71
4322 (More stack frames follow...)
4323 @end group
4324 @end smallexample
4325
4326 @noindent
4327 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4328 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4329
4330 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4331 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4332 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4333
4334 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4335 @cindex program entry point
4336 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4337 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4338 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4339 @code{main}@footnote{
4340 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4341 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4342 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4343 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4344 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4345 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4346
4347 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4348 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4349
4350 @table @code
4351 @item set backtrace past-main
4352 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4353 @kindex set backtrace
4354 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4355
4356 @item set backtrace past-main off
4357 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4358 default.
4359
4360 @item show backtrace past-main
4361 @kindex show backtrace
4362 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4363
4364 @item set backtrace past-entry
4365 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4366 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4367 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4368 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4369
4370 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4371 Backtraces will stop when they encouter the internal entry point of an
4372 application. This is the default.
4373
4374 @item show backtrace past-entry
4375 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4376
4377 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4378 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4379 @cindex backtrace limit
4380 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4381 unlimited.
4382
4383 @item show backtrace limit
4384 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4385 @end table
4386
4387 @node Selection
4388 @section Selecting a frame
4389
4390 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4391 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4392 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4393 of the stack frame just selected.
4394
4395 @table @code
4396 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4397 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4398 @item frame @var{n}
4399 @itemx f @var{n}
4400 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4401 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4402 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4403 @code{main}.
4404
4405 @item frame @var{addr}
4406 @itemx f @var{addr}
4407 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4408 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4409 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4410 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4411 switches between them.
4412
4413 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4414 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4415
4416 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4417 pointer and a program counter.
4418
4419 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4420 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4421
4422 @kindex up
4423 @item up @var{n}
4424 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4425 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4426 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4427
4428 @kindex down
4429 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4430 @item down @var{n}
4431 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4432 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4433 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4434 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4435 @end table
4436
4437 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4438 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4439 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4440 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4441
4442 @need 1000
4443 For example:
4444
4445 @smallexample
4446 @group
4447 (@value{GDBP}) up
4448 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4449 at env.c:10
4450 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4451 @end group
4452 @end smallexample
4453
4454 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4455 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4456 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4457 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4458 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
4459 for details.
4460
4461 @table @code
4462 @kindex down-silently
4463 @kindex up-silently
4464 @item up-silently @var{n}
4465 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4466 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4467 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4468 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4469 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4470 distracting.
4471 @end table
4472
4473 @node Frame Info
4474 @section Information about a frame
4475
4476 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4477 stack frame.
4478
4479 @table @code
4480 @item frame
4481 @itemx f
4482 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4483 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4484 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4485 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4486 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4487
4488 @kindex info frame
4489 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4490 @item info frame
4491 @itemx info f
4492 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4493 including:
4494
4495 @itemize @bullet
4496 @item
4497 the address of the frame
4498 @item
4499 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4500 @item
4501 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4502 @item
4503 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4504 @item
4505 the address of the frame's arguments
4506 @item
4507 the address of the frame's local variables
4508 @item
4509 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4510 @item
4511 which registers were saved in the frame
4512 @end itemize
4513
4514 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4515 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4516 the usual conventions.
4517
4518 @item info frame @var{addr}
4519 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4520 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4521 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4522 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4523 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4524 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4525
4526 @kindex info args
4527 @item info args
4528 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4529
4530 @item info locals
4531 @kindex info locals
4532 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4533 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4534 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4535
4536 @kindex info catch
4537 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4538 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4539 @item info catch
4540 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4541 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4542 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4543 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4544 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4545
4546 @end table
4547
4548
4549 @node Source
4550 @chapter Examining Source Files
4551
4552 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4553 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4554 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4555 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4556 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4557 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4558 source files by explicit command.
4559
4560 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4561 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4562 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4563
4564 @menu
4565 * List:: Printing source lines
4566 * Edit:: Editing source files
4567 * Search:: Searching source files
4568 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4569 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4570 @end menu
4571
4572 @node List
4573 @section Printing source lines
4574
4575 @kindex list
4576 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4577 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4578 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4579 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4580
4581 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4582
4583 @table @code
4584 @item list @var{linenum}
4585 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4586 current source file.
4587
4588 @item list @var{function}
4589 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4590 @var{function}.
4591
4592 @item list
4593 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4594 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4595 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4596 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4597 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4598
4599 @item list -
4600 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4601 @end table
4602
4603 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4604 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4605 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4606
4607 @table @code
4608 @kindex set listsize
4609 @item set listsize @var{count}
4610 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4611 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4612
4613 @kindex show listsize
4614 @item show listsize
4615 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4616 @end table
4617
4618 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4619 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4620 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4621 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4622 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4623
4624 @cindex linespec
4625 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4626 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4627 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4628 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4629
4630 @table @code
4631 @item list @var{linespec}
4632 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4633
4634 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4635 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4636 linespecs.
4637
4638 @item list ,@var{last}
4639 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4640
4641 @item list @var{first},
4642 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4643
4644 @item list +
4645 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4646
4647 @item list -
4648 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4649
4650 @item list
4651 As described in the preceding table.
4652 @end table
4653
4654 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4655 kinds of linespec.
4656
4657 @table @code
4658 @item @var{number}
4659 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4660 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4661 the same source file as the first linespec.
4662
4663 @item +@var{offset}
4664 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4665 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4666 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4667 first linespec.
4668
4669 @item -@var{offset}
4670 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4671
4672 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4673 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4674
4675 @item @var{function}
4676 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4677 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4678
4679 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4680 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4681 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4682 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4683 identically named functions in different source files.
4684
4685 @item *@var{address}
4686 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4687 @var{address} may be any expression.
4688 @end table
4689
4690 @node Edit
4691 @section Editing source files
4692 @cindex editing source files
4693
4694 @kindex edit
4695 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4696 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4697 The editing program of your choice
4698 is invoked with the current line set to
4699 the active line in the program.
4700 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4701 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4702
4703 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4704
4705 @table @code
4706 @item edit
4707 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4708
4709 @item edit @var{number}
4710 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4711
4712 @item edit @var{function}
4713 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4714
4715 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4716 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4717
4718 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4719 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4720 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4721 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4722 identically named functions in different source files.
4723
4724 @item edit *@var{address}
4725 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4726 @var{address} may be any expression.
4727 @end table
4728
4729 @subsection Choosing your editor
4730 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4731 @footnote{
4732 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4733 following command-line syntax:
4734 @smallexample
4735 ex +@var{number} file
4736 @end smallexample
4737 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
4738 the file where to start editing.}.
4739 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
4740 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4741 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4742 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4743 @smallexample
4744 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4745 export EDITOR
4746 gdb @dots{}
4747 @end smallexample
4748 or in the @code{csh} shell,
4749 @smallexample
4750 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4751 gdb @dots{}
4752 @end smallexample
4753
4754 @node Search
4755 @section Searching source files
4756 @cindex searching source files
4757
4758 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4759 regular expression.
4760
4761 @table @code
4762 @kindex search
4763 @kindex forward-search
4764 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
4765 @itemx search @var{regexp}
4766 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4767 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4768 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4769 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4770 @code{fo}.
4771
4772 @kindex reverse-search
4773 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4774 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4775 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4776 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4777 this command as @code{rev}.
4778 @end table
4779
4780 @node Source Path
4781 @section Specifying source directories
4782
4783 @cindex source path
4784 @cindex directories for source files
4785 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4786 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4787 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4788 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4789 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4790 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4791 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
4792
4793 For example, suppose an executable references the file
4794 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
4795 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
4796 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
4797 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
4798 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
4799 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
4800 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
4801 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
4802 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
4803 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
4804
4805 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
4806 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
4807 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
4808 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
4809 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
4810 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
4811
4812 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
4813 source files. Neither is the current working directory, unless it
4814 happens to be in the source path.
4815
4816 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4817 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4818 each line is in the file.
4819
4820 @kindex directory
4821 @kindex dir
4822 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4823 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
4824 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4825
4826 @table @code
4827 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4828 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4829 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
4830 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4831 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4832 part of absolute file names) or
4833 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4834 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4835
4836 @kindex cdir
4837 @kindex cwd
4838 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4839 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
4840 @cindex compilation directory
4841 @cindex current directory
4842 @cindex working directory
4843 @cindex directory, current
4844 @cindex directory, compilation
4845 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4846 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4847 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4848 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4849 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4850 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4851
4852 @item directory
4853 Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4854
4855 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4856 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4857
4858 @item show directories
4859 @kindex show directories
4860 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4861 @end table
4862
4863 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4864 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4865 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4866
4867 @enumerate
4868 @item
4869 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4870
4871 @item
4872 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4873 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4874 directories in one command.
4875 @end enumerate
4876
4877 @node Machine Code
4878 @section Source and machine code
4879 @cindex source line and its code address
4880
4881 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4882 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4883 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
4884 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
4885 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
4886 well as hex.
4887
4888 @table @code
4889 @kindex info line
4890 @item info line @var{linespec}
4891 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4892 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4893 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4894 source lines}).
4895 @end table
4896
4897 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4898 the object code for the first line of function
4899 @code{m4_changequote}:
4900
4901 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4902 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
4903 @smallexample
4904 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
4905 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4906 @end smallexample
4907
4908 @noindent
4909 @cindex code address and its source line
4910 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4911 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4912 @smallexample
4913 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4914 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4915 @end smallexample
4916
4917 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
4918 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
4919 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
4920 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4921 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4922 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4923 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4924 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4925 variables}).
4926
4927 @table @code
4928 @kindex disassemble
4929 @cindex assembly instructions
4930 @cindex instructions, assembly
4931 @cindex machine instructions
4932 @cindex listing machine instructions
4933 @item disassemble
4934 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4935 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4936 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4937 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4938 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4939 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4940 @end table
4941
4942 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4943 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4944
4945 @smallexample
4946 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4947 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
4948 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
4949 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
4950 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4951 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
4952 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
4953 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
4954 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
4955 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4956 End of assembler dump.
4957 @end smallexample
4958
4959 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4960 mnemonics or other syntax.
4961
4962 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
4963 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
4964 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
4965 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
4966 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
4967
4968 @table @code
4969 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
4970 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4971 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4972 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
4973 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4974 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4975
4976 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
4977 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4978 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4979 assemblers for x86-based targets.
4980
4981 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
4982 @item show disassembly-flavor
4983 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
4984 @end table
4985
4986
4987 @node Data
4988 @chapter Examining Data
4989
4990 @cindex printing data
4991 @cindex examining data
4992 @kindex print
4993 @kindex inspect
4994 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4995 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4996 @c different window or something like that.
4997 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
4998 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4999 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5000 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5001 Different Languages}).
5002
5003 @table @code
5004 @item print @var{expr}
5005 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5006 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5007 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5008 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5009 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5010 formats}.
5011
5012 @item print
5013 @itemx print /@var{f}
5014 @cindex reprint the last value
5015 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5016 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
5017 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5018 @end table
5019
5020 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5021 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5022 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5023
5024 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5025 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5026 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5027 Table}.
5028
5029 @menu
5030 * Expressions:: Expressions
5031 * Variables:: Program variables
5032 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5033 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5034 * Memory:: Examining memory
5035 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5036 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5037 * Value History:: Value history
5038 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5039 * Registers:: Registers
5040 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5041 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5042 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5043 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5044 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5045 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5046 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5047 character set than GDB does
5048 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5049 @end menu
5050
5051 @node Expressions
5052 @section Expressions
5053
5054 @cindex expressions
5055 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5056 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5057 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5058 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5059 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5060 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5061 @ref{Compilation}.
5062
5063 @cindex arrays in expressions
5064 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5065 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5066 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5067 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5068
5069 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5070 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5071 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5072 languages.
5073
5074 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5075 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5076
5077 @cindex casts, in expressions
5078 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5079 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5080 at that address in memory.
5081 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5082
5083 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5084 to programming languages:
5085
5086 @table @code
5087 @item @@
5088 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5089 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
5090
5091 @item ::
5092 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5093 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
5094
5095 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5096 @cindex type casting memory
5097 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5098 @cindex casts, to view memory
5099 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5100 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5101 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5102 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5103 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5104 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5105 @end table
5106
5107 @node Variables
5108 @section Program variables
5109
5110 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5111 in your program.
5112
5113 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5114 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
5115
5116 @itemize @bullet
5117 @item
5118 global (or file-static)
5119 @end itemize
5120
5121 @noindent or
5122
5123 @itemize @bullet
5124 @item
5125 visible according to the scope rules of the
5126 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5127 @end itemize
5128
5129 @noindent This means that in the function
5130
5131 @smallexample
5132 foo (a)
5133 int a;
5134 @{
5135 bar (a);
5136 @{
5137 int b = test ();
5138 bar (b);
5139 @}
5140 @}
5141 @end smallexample
5142
5143 @noindent
5144 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5145 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5146 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5147 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5148
5149 @cindex variable name conflict
5150 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5151 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5152 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5153 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5154 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5155 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5156 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5157
5158 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5159 @iftex
5160 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5161 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5162 @end iftex
5163 @smallexample
5164 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5165 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5166 @end smallexample
5167
5168 @noindent
5169 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5170 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5171 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5172 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5173
5174 @smallexample
5175 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5176 @end smallexample
5177
5178 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5179 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5180 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5181 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5182 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5183 @c conflict?? --mew
5184
5185 @cindex wrong values
5186 @cindex variable values, wrong
5187 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5188 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5189 @quotation
5190 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5191 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5192 scope, and just before exit.
5193 @end quotation
5194 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5195 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5196 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5197 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5198 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5199 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5200 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5201 variable definitions may be gone.
5202
5203 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5204 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5205 when compiling.
5206
5207 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5208 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5209 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5210 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5211 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5212 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5213 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5214
5215 @smallexample
5216 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5217 @end smallexample
5218
5219 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5220 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5221 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5222 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5223 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5224 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5225 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5226 for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
5227 @xref{C, , Debugging C++}, for more info about debug info formats
5228 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5229
5230 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5231 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5232 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5233 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5234
5235 @node Arrays
5236 @section Artificial arrays
5237
5238 @cindex artificial array
5239 @cindex arrays
5240 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5241 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5242 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5243 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5244 program.
5245
5246 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5247 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5248 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5249 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5250 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5251 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5252 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5253 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5254 example. If a program says
5255
5256 @smallexample
5257 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5258 @end smallexample
5259
5260 @noindent
5261 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5262
5263 @smallexample
5264 p *array@@len
5265 @end smallexample
5266
5267 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5268 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5269 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5270 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5271 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
5272
5273 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5274 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5275 The value need not be in memory:
5276 @smallexample
5277 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5278 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5279 @end smallexample
5280
5281 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5282 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5283 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5284 @smallexample
5285 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5286 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5287 @end smallexample
5288
5289 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5290 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5291 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5292 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5293 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5294 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5295 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5296 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5297 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5298 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5299
5300 @smallexample
5301 set $i = 0
5302 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5303 @key{RET}
5304 @key{RET}
5305 @dots{}
5306 @end smallexample
5307
5308 @node Output Formats
5309 @section Output formats
5310
5311 @cindex formatted output
5312 @cindex output formats
5313 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5314 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5315 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5316 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5317 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5318
5319 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5320 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5321 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5322 letters supported are:
5323
5324 @table @code
5325 @item x
5326 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5327 hexadecimal.
5328
5329 @item d
5330 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5331
5332 @item u
5333 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5334
5335 @item o
5336 Print as integer in octal.
5337
5338 @item t
5339 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5340 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5341 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5342 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
5343
5344 @item a
5345 @cindex unknown address, locating
5346 @cindex locate address
5347 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5348 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5349 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5350
5351 @smallexample
5352 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5353 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5354 @end smallexample
5355
5356 @noindent
5357 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5358 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5359
5360 @item c
5361 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5362 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5363 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5364 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5365
5366 @item f
5367 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5368 using typical floating point syntax.
5369 @end table
5370
5371 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5372
5373 @smallexample
5374 p/x $pc
5375 @end smallexample
5376
5377 @noindent
5378 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5379 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5380
5381 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5382 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5383 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5384
5385 @node Memory
5386 @section Examining memory
5387
5388 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5389 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5390
5391 @cindex examining memory
5392 @table @code
5393 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5394 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5395 @itemx x @var{addr}
5396 @itemx x
5397 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5398 @end table
5399
5400 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5401 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5402 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5403 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5404 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5405
5406 @table @r
5407 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5408 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5409 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5410 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5411 @c 4.1.2.
5412
5413 @item @var{f}, the display format
5414 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5415 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5416 @samp{f}), and in addition @samp{s} (for null-terminated strings) and
5417 @samp{i} (for machine instructions). The default is @samp{x}
5418 (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes each time you use either
5419 @code{x} or @code{print}.
5420
5421 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5422 The unit size is any of
5423
5424 @table @code
5425 @item b
5426 Bytes.
5427 @item h
5428 Halfwords (two bytes).
5429 @item w
5430 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5431 @item g
5432 Giant words (eight bytes).
5433 @end table
5434
5435 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5436 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5437 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5438
5439 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5440 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5441 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5442 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5443 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5444 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5445 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5446 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5447 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5448 a value from memory).
5449 @end table
5450
5451 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5452 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5453 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5454 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5455 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5456
5457 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5458 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5459 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5460 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5461 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5462
5463 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5464 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5465 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5466 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
5467 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
5468 Code,,Source and machine code}.
5469
5470 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5471 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5472 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5473 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5474 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5475 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5476 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5477
5478 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5479 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5480 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5481 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5482 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5483 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5484 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5485 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5486 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5487
5488 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5489 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5490 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5491
5492 @cindex remote memory comparison
5493 @cindex verify remote memory image
5494 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
5495 (@pxref{Remote}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
5496 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
5497 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
5498 situations.
5499
5500 @table @code
5501 @kindex compare-sections
5502 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
5503 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
5504 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
5505 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
5506 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
5507 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
5508 remote request.
5509 @end table
5510
5511 @node Auto Display
5512 @section Automatic display
5513 @cindex automatic display
5514 @cindex display of expressions
5515
5516 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5517 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5518 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5519 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5520 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5521 The automatic display looks like this:
5522
5523 @smallexample
5524 2: foo = 38
5525 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5526 @end smallexample
5527
5528 @noindent
5529 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5530 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5531 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5532 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5533 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5534 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5535 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5536
5537 @table @code
5538 @kindex display
5539 @item display @var{expr}
5540 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5541 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5542
5543 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5544
5545 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5546 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5547 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5548 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5549 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5550
5551 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5552 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5553 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5554 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5555 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5556 @end table
5557
5558 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5559 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5560 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5561
5562 @table @code
5563 @kindex delete display
5564 @kindex undisplay
5565 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5566 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5567 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5568
5569 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5570 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5571
5572 @kindex disable display
5573 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5574 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5575 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5576 enabled again later.
5577
5578 @kindex enable display
5579 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5580 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5581 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5582
5583 @item display
5584 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5585 done when your program stops.
5586
5587 @kindex info display
5588 @item info display
5589 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5590 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5591 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5592 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5593 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5594 @end table
5595
5596 @cindex display disabled out of scope
5597 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5598 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5599 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5600 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5601 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5602 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5603 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5604 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5605 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5606 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5607
5608 @node Print Settings
5609 @section Print settings
5610
5611 @cindex format options
5612 @cindex print settings
5613 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5614 and symbols are printed.
5615
5616 @noindent
5617 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5618
5619 @table @code
5620 @kindex set print
5621 @item set print address
5622 @itemx set print address on
5623 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
5624 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5625 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5626 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5627 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5628 @code{set print address on}:
5629
5630 @smallexample
5631 @group
5632 (@value{GDBP}) f
5633 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5634 at input.c:530
5635 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5636 @end group
5637 @end smallexample
5638
5639 @item set print address off
5640 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5641 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5642
5643 @smallexample
5644 @group
5645 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5646 (@value{GDBP}) f
5647 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5648 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5649 @end group
5650 @end smallexample
5651
5652 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5653 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5654 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5655 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5656
5657 @kindex show print
5658 @item show print address
5659 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5660 @end table
5661
5662 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5663 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5664 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5665 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5666 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5667 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5668 it prints a symbolic address:
5669
5670 @table @code
5671 @item set print symbol-filename on
5672 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
5673 @cindex symbol, source file and line
5674 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5675 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5676
5677 @item set print symbol-filename off
5678 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5679 default.
5680
5681 @item show print symbol-filename
5682 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5683 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5684 @end table
5685
5686 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5687 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5688 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5689
5690 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5691 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5692
5693 @table @code
5694 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5695 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
5696 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5697 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5698 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
5699 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5700
5701 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
5702 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5703 symbolic address.
5704 @end table
5705
5706 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5707 @cindex pointer, finding referent
5708 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5709 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5710 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5711 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5712 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5713 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5714
5715 @smallexample
5716 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5717 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5718 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
5719 @end smallexample
5720
5721 @quotation
5722 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5723 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5724 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5725 @end quotation
5726
5727 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5728
5729 @table @code
5730 @item set print array
5731 @itemx set print array on
5732 @cindex pretty print arrays
5733 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5734 but uses more space. The default is off.
5735
5736 @item set print array off
5737 Return to compressed format for arrays.
5738
5739 @item show print array
5740 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5741 arrays.
5742
5743 @cindex print array indexes
5744 @item set print array-indexes
5745 @itemx set print array-indexes on
5746 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
5747 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
5748 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
5749
5750 @item set print array-indexes off
5751 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
5752
5753 @item show print array-indexes
5754 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
5755 arrays.
5756
5757 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5758 @cindex number of array elements to print
5759 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
5760 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5761 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5762 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5763 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
5764 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
5765 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5766
5767 @item show print elements
5768 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5769 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5770
5771 @item set print repeats
5772 @cindex repeated array elements
5773 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
5774 elelments. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
5775 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
5776 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
5777 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
5778 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
5779 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
5780
5781 @item show print repeats
5782 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
5783 elements.
5784
5785 @item set print null-stop
5786 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
5787 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
5788 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
5789 contain only short strings.
5790 The default is off.
5791
5792 @item show print null-stop
5793 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
5794 @sc{null} character.
5795
5796 @item set print pretty on
5797 @cindex print structures in indented form
5798 @cindex indentation in structure display
5799 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
5800 per line, like this:
5801
5802 @smallexample
5803 @group
5804 $1 = @{
5805 next = 0x0,
5806 flags = @{
5807 sweet = 1,
5808 sour = 1
5809 @},
5810 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5811 @}
5812 @end group
5813 @end smallexample
5814
5815 @item set print pretty off
5816 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5817
5818 @smallexample
5819 @group
5820 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5821 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5822 @end group
5823 @end smallexample
5824
5825 @noindent
5826 This is the default format.
5827
5828 @item show print pretty
5829 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5830
5831 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
5832 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
5833 @cindex octal escapes in strings
5834 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5835 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5836 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5837 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5838 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5839
5840 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
5841 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5842 international character sets, and is the default.
5843
5844 @item show print sevenbit-strings
5845 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5846
5847 @item set print union on
5848 @cindex unions in structures, printing
5849 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
5850 and other unions. This is the default setting.
5851
5852 @item set print union off
5853 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
5854 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
5855 instead.
5856
5857 @item show print union
5858 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5859 structures and other unions.
5860
5861 For example, given the declarations
5862
5863 @smallexample
5864 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5865 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5866 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
5867 Bug_forms;
5868
5869 struct thing @{
5870 Species it;
5871 union @{
5872 Tree_forms tree;
5873 Bug_forms bug;
5874 @} form;
5875 @};
5876
5877 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5878 @end smallexample
5879
5880 @noindent
5881 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5882
5883 @smallexample
5884 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5885 @end smallexample
5886
5887 @noindent
5888 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5889
5890 @smallexample
5891 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5892 @end smallexample
5893
5894 @noindent
5895 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
5896 and in Pascal.
5897 @end table
5898
5899 @need 1000
5900 @noindent
5901 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
5902
5903 @table @code
5904 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
5905 @item set print demangle
5906 @itemx set print demangle on
5907 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5908 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
5909 linkage. The default is on.
5910
5911 @item show print demangle
5912 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5913
5914 @item set print asm-demangle
5915 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
5916 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5917 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5918 The default is off.
5919
5920 @item show print asm-demangle
5921 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5922 or demangled form.
5923
5924 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5925 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
5926 @kindex set demangle-style
5927 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
5928 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5929 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5930
5931 @table @code
5932 @item auto
5933 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5934
5935 @item gnu
5936 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
5937 This is the default.
5938
5939 @item hp
5940 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5941
5942 @item lucid
5943 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5944
5945 @item arm
5946 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
5947 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5948 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5949 require further enhancement to permit that.
5950
5951 @end table
5952 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5953
5954 @item show demangle-style
5955 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
5956
5957 @item set print object
5958 @itemx set print object on
5959 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
5960 @cindex display derived types
5961 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5962 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5963 the virtual function table.
5964
5965 @item set print object off
5966 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5967 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5968
5969 @item show print object
5970 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5971
5972 @item set print static-members
5973 @itemx set print static-members on
5974 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
5975 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
5976
5977 @item set print static-members off
5978 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
5979
5980 @item show print static-members
5981 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
5982
5983 @item set print pascal_static-members
5984 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
5985 @cindex static members of Pacal objects
5986 @cindex Pacal objects, static members display
5987 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
5988
5989 @item set print pascal_static-members off
5990 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
5991
5992 @item show print pascal_static-members
5993 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
5994
5995 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5996 @item set print vtbl
5997 @itemx set print vtbl on
5998 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
5999 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6000 @cindex VTBL display
6001 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6002 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6003 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6004
6005 @item set print vtbl off
6006 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6007
6008 @item show print vtbl
6009 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6010 @end table
6011
6012 @node Value History
6013 @section Value history
6014
6015 @cindex value history
6016 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6017 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6018 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6019 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6020 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6021 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6022 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6023 symbol table.
6024
6025 @cindex @code{$}
6026 @cindex @code{$$}
6027 @cindex history number
6028 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6029 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6030 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6031 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6032 history number.
6033
6034 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6035 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6036 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6037 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6038 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6039 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6040 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6041
6042 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6043 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6044
6045 @smallexample
6046 p *$
6047 @end smallexample
6048
6049 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6050 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6051
6052 @smallexample
6053 p *$.next
6054 @end smallexample
6055
6056 @noindent
6057 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6058 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6059
6060 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6061 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6062
6063 @smallexample
6064 print x
6065 set x=5
6066 @end smallexample
6067
6068 @noindent
6069 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6070 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6071
6072 @table @code
6073 @kindex show values
6074 @item show values
6075 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6076 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6077 values} does not change the history.
6078
6079 @item show values @var{n}
6080 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6081
6082 @item show values +
6083 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6084 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6085 @end table
6086
6087 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6088 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6089
6090 @node Convenience Vars
6091 @section Convenience variables
6092
6093 @cindex convenience variables
6094 @cindex user-defined variables
6095 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6096 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6097 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6098 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6099 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6100
6101 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6102 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6103 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6104 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6105 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
6106
6107 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6108 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6109 For example:
6110
6111 @smallexample
6112 set $foo = *object_ptr
6113 @end smallexample
6114
6115 @noindent
6116 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6117 @code{object_ptr}.
6118
6119 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6120 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6121 value with another assignment at any time.
6122
6123 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6124 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6125 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6126 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6127
6128 @table @code
6129 @kindex show convenience
6130 @cindex show all user variables
6131 @item show convenience
6132 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6133 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6134 @end table
6135
6136 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6137 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6138 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6139
6140 @smallexample
6141 set $i = 0
6142 print bar[$i++]->contents
6143 @end smallexample
6144
6145 @noindent
6146 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6147
6148 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6149 values likely to be useful.
6150
6151 @table @code
6152 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6153 @item $_
6154 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6155 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
6156 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6157 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6158 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6159 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6160 to the type of @code{$__}.
6161
6162 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6163 @item $__
6164 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6165 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6166 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6167
6168 @item $_exitcode
6169 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6170 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6171 the program being debugged terminates.
6172 @end table
6173
6174 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6175 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6176 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6177
6178 @node Registers
6179 @section Registers
6180
6181 @cindex registers
6182 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6183 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6184 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6185 your machine.
6186
6187 @table @code
6188 @kindex info registers
6189 @item info registers
6190 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6191 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6192
6193 @kindex info all-registers
6194 @cindex floating point registers
6195 @item info all-registers
6196 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6197 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6198
6199 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6200 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6201 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6202 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6203 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6204 @end table
6205
6206 @cindex stack pointer register
6207 @cindex program counter register
6208 @cindex process status register
6209 @cindex frame pointer register
6210 @cindex standard registers
6211 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6212 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6213 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6214 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6215 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6216 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6217 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6218 you could print the program counter in hex with
6219
6220 @smallexample
6221 p/x $pc
6222 @end smallexample
6223
6224 @noindent
6225 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6226
6227 @smallexample
6228 x/i $pc
6229 @end smallexample
6230
6231 @noindent
6232 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6233 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6234 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6235 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6236 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6237 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6238 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
6239
6240 @smallexample
6241 set $sp += 4
6242 @end smallexample
6243
6244 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6245 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6246 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6247 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6248 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6249 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6250 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6251
6252 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6253 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6254 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6255 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6256 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6257 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6258 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6259
6260 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6261 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6262 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6263 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6264 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6265 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6266 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6267 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6268 prints the data in both formats.
6269
6270 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6271 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
6272 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6273 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6274 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6275 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6276
6277 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6278 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6279 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6280 frame makes no difference.
6281
6282 @node Floating Point Hardware
6283 @section Floating point hardware
6284 @cindex floating point
6285
6286 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6287 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6288
6289 @table @code
6290 @kindex info float
6291 @item info float
6292 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6293 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6294 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6295 the ARM and x86 machines.
6296 @end table
6297
6298 @node Vector Unit
6299 @section Vector Unit
6300 @cindex vector unit
6301
6302 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6303 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6304
6305 @table @code
6306 @kindex info vector
6307 @item info vector
6308 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6309 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6310 @end table
6311
6312 @node OS Information
6313 @section Operating system auxiliary information
6314 @cindex OS information
6315
6316 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6317 you debug your program.
6318
6319 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6320 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6321 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6322 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6323 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6324 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6325 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6326 structure.
6327
6328 @table @code
6329 @item info udot
6330 @kindex info udot
6331 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6332 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6333 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6334 the @code{examine} command.
6335 @end table
6336
6337 @cindex auxiliary vector
6338 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6339 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6340 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6341 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6342 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6343 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6344 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6345 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6346 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6347 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6348 support of the @samp{qPart:auxv:read} packet, see @ref{Remote
6349 configuration, auxiliary vector}.
6350
6351 @table @code
6352 @kindex info auxv
6353 @item info auxv
6354 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6355 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6356 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6357 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6358 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6359 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6360 an unrecognized tag.
6361 @end table
6362
6363
6364 @node Memory Region Attributes
6365 @section Memory region attributes
6366 @cindex memory region attributes
6367
6368 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6369 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
6370 to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
6371 use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
6372
6373 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6374 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6375 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6376 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6377 all memory.
6378
6379 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6380 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6381
6382 @table @code
6383 @kindex mem
6384 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6385 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6386 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
6387 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
6388 case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
6389 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
6390
6391 @kindex delete mem
6392 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6393 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
6394 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
6395
6396 @kindex disable mem
6397 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6398 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6399 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
6400 It may be enabled again later.
6401
6402 @kindex enable mem
6403 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6404 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6405
6406 @kindex info mem
6407 @item info mem
6408 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6409 for each region:
6410
6411 @table @emph
6412 @item Memory Region Number
6413 @item Enabled or Disabled.
6414 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
6415 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6416
6417 @item Lo Address
6418 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6419
6420 @item Hi Address
6421 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
6422
6423 @item Attributes
6424 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
6425 @end table
6426 @end table
6427
6428
6429 @subsection Attributes
6430
6431 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
6432 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
6433 write accesses to a memory region.
6434
6435 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
6436 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
6437 etc. from accessing memory.
6438
6439 @table @code
6440 @item ro
6441 Memory is read only.
6442 @item wo
6443 Memory is write only.
6444 @item rw
6445 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
6446 @end table
6447
6448 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
6449 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
6450 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
6451 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
6452 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
6453
6454 @table @code
6455 @item 8
6456 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
6457 @item 16
6458 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
6459 @item 32
6460 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
6461 @item 64
6462 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
6463 @end table
6464
6465 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
6466 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6467 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
6468 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
6469 @c
6470 @c @table @code
6471 @c @item hwbreak
6472 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
6473 @c @item swbreak (default)
6474 @c @end table
6475
6476 @subsubsection Data Cache
6477 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
6478 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
6479 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
6480 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
6481 registers.
6482
6483 @table @code
6484 @item cache
6485 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6486 @item nocache
6487 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
6488 @end table
6489
6490 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
6491 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6492 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
6493 @c
6494 @c @table @code
6495 @c @item verify
6496 @c @item noverify (default)
6497 @c @end table
6498
6499 @node Dump/Restore Files
6500 @section Copy between memory and a file
6501 @cindex dump/restore files
6502 @cindex append data to a file
6503 @cindex dump data to a file
6504 @cindex restore data from a file
6505
6506 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
6507 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
6508 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
6509 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
6510 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
6511 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
6512 files.
6513
6514 @table @code
6515
6516 @kindex dump
6517 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6518 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6519 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6520 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
6521
6522 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
6523 @table @code
6524 @item binary
6525 Raw binary form.
6526 @item ihex
6527 Intel hex format.
6528 @item srec
6529 Motorola S-record format.
6530 @item tekhex
6531 Tektronix Hex format.
6532 @end table
6533
6534 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
6535 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
6536 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
6537 form.
6538
6539 @kindex append
6540 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6541 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6542 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6543 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
6544 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
6545
6546 @kindex restore
6547 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
6548 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
6549 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
6550 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
6551 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
6552
6553 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
6554 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
6555 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
6556 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
6557 from that location.
6558
6559 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
6560 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
6561 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
6562 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
6563
6564 @end table
6565
6566 @node Core File Generation
6567 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
6568 @cindex dump core from inferior
6569
6570 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
6571 image of a running process and its process status (register values
6572 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
6573 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
6574 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
6575 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
6576 the post-mortem debugging mode.
6577
6578 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
6579 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
6580 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
6581
6582 @table @code
6583 @kindex gcore
6584 @kindex generate-core-file
6585 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
6586 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
6587 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
6588 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
6589 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
6590 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
6591
6592 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
6593 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
6594 @end table
6595
6596 @node Character Sets
6597 @section Character Sets
6598 @cindex character sets
6599 @cindex charset
6600 @cindex translating between character sets
6601 @cindex host character set
6602 @cindex target character set
6603
6604 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
6605 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
6606 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
6607 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
6608 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
6609 @dfn{target character set}.
6610
6611 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
6612 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
6613 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
6614 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
6615 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
6616 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
6617 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
6618 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
6619 character and string literals in expressions.
6620
6621 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
6622 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
6623 target-charset} command, described below.
6624
6625 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
6626 support:
6627
6628 @table @code
6629 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
6630 @kindex set target-charset
6631 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
6632 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
6633 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
6634 list the target character sets it supports.
6635 @end table
6636
6637 @table @code
6638 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
6639 @kindex set host-charset
6640 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
6641
6642 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
6643 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
6644 @code{set host-charset} command.
6645
6646 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
6647 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
6648 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
6649 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
6650 list the host character sets it supports.
6651
6652 @item set charset @var{charset}
6653 @kindex set charset
6654 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
6655 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
6656 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
6657 for both host and target.
6658
6659
6660 @item show charset
6661 @kindex show charset
6662 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
6663
6664 @itemx show host-charset
6665 @kindex show host-charset
6666 Show the name of the current host charset.
6667
6668 @itemx show target-charset
6669 @kindex show target-charset
6670 Show the name of the current target charset.
6671
6672 @end table
6673
6674 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
6675 sets:
6676
6677 @table @code
6678
6679 @item ASCII
6680 @cindex ASCII character set
6681 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
6682 character set.
6683
6684 @item ISO-8859-1
6685 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
6686 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
6687 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
6688 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
6689 this as its host character set.
6690
6691 @item EBCDIC-US
6692 @itemx IBM1047
6693 @cindex EBCDIC character set
6694 @cindex IBM1047 character set
6695 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
6696 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
6697 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
6698
6699 @end table
6700
6701 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
6702 GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
6703 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
6704
6705 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
6706 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
6707 @file{charset-test.c}:
6708
6709 @smallexample
6710 #include <stdio.h>
6711
6712 char ascii_hello[]
6713 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6714 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6715 char ibm1047_hello[]
6716 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6717 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6718
6719 main ()
6720 @{
6721 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6722 @}
6723 @end smallexample
6724
6725 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6726 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6727 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6728
6729 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6730
6731 @smallexample
6732 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6733 $ gdb -nw charset-test
6734 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6735 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6736 @dots{}
6737 (@value{GDBP})
6738 @end smallexample
6739
6740 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6741 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6742 strings:
6743
6744 @smallexample
6745 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
6746 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
6747 (@value{GDBP})
6748 @end smallexample
6749
6750 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6751 initial character set:
6752 @smallexample
6753 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
6754 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
6755 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
6756 (@value{GDBP})
6757 @end smallexample
6758
6759 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6760 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6761 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6762 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6763 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6764
6765 @smallexample
6766 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
6767 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6768 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
6769 $2 = 72 'H'
6770 (@value{GDBP})
6771 @end smallexample
6772
6773 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6774 literals you use in expressions:
6775
6776 @smallexample
6777 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
6778 $3 = 43 '+'
6779 (@value{GDBP})
6780 @end smallexample
6781
6782 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6783 character.
6784
6785 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6786 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6787 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6788
6789 @smallexample
6790 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
6791 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6792 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6793 $5 = 200 '\310'
6794 (@value{GDBP})
6795 @end smallexample
6796
6797 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
6798 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6799
6800 @smallexample
6801 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
6802 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
6803 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
6804 @end smallexample
6805
6806 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6807 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6808 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6809 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6810 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6811
6812 @smallexample
6813 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
6814 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
6815 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
6816 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
6817 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
6818 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6819 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
6820 $7 = 72 '\110'
6821 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
6822 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6823 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6824 $9 = 200 'H'
6825 (@value{GDBP})
6826 @end smallexample
6827
6828 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6829 string literals you use in expressions:
6830
6831 @smallexample
6832 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
6833 $10 = 78 '+'
6834 (@value{GDBP})
6835 @end smallexample
6836
6837 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
6838 character.
6839
6840 @node Caching Remote Data
6841 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
6842 @cindex caching data of remote targets
6843
6844 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
6845 remote target (@pxref{Remote}). Such caching generally improves
6846 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
6847 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
6848 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
6849 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
6850 volatile registers are in use.
6851
6852 @table @code
6853 @kindex set remotecache
6854 @item set remotecache on
6855 @itemx set remotecache off
6856 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
6857 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
6858
6859 @kindex show remotecache
6860 @item show remotecache
6861 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
6862
6863 @kindex info dcache
6864 @item info dcache
6865 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
6866 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
6867 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
6868 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
6869 the data cache operation.
6870 @end table
6871
6872
6873 @node Macros
6874 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6875
6876 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
6877 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6878 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6879 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6880 where it was defined.
6881
6882 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6883 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6884 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6885 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6886
6887 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6888 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6889 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6890 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6891 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6892 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6893 see @ref{List}.
6894
6895 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6896 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6897 variable-arity macros.
6898
6899 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6900 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6901 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6902
6903 @table @code
6904
6905 @kindex macro expand
6906 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6907 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6908 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6909 @item macro expand @var{expression}
6910 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6911 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6912 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6913 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6914 it can be any string of tokens.
6915
6916 @kindex macro exp1
6917 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6918 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6919 @cindex expand macro once
6920 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6921 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6922 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6923 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6924 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6925 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6926 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6927 can be any string of tokens.
6928
6929 @kindex info macro
6930 @cindex macro definition, showing
6931 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
6932 @item info macro @var{macro}
6933 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6934 source location where that definition was established.
6935
6936 @kindex macro define
6937 @cindex user-defined macros
6938 @cindex defining macros interactively
6939 @cindex macros, user-defined
6940 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6941 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6942 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6943 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6944 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6945 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6946 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6947 given in @var{arglist}.
6948
6949 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6950 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6951 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6952 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6953 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6954
6955 @kindex macro undef
6956 @item macro undef @var{macro}
6957 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6958 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6959 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6960 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6961 debugged.
6962
6963 @kindex macro list
6964 @item macro list
6965 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
6966 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
6967 @end table
6968
6969 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
6970 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6971 show our source files:
6972
6973 @smallexample
6974 $ cat sample.c
6975 #include <stdio.h>
6976 #include "sample.h"
6977
6978 #define M 42
6979 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6980
6981 main ()
6982 @{
6983 #define N 28
6984 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6985 #undef N
6986 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6987 #define N 1729
6988 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6989 @}
6990 $ cat sample.h
6991 #define Q <
6992 $
6993 @end smallexample
6994
6995 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6996 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6997 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6998 information.
6999
7000 @smallexample
7001 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7002 $
7003 @end smallexample
7004
7005 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7006
7007 @smallexample
7008 $ gdb -nw sample
7009 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7010 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7011 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7012 (@value{GDBP})
7013 @end smallexample
7014
7015 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7016 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7017 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7018
7019 @smallexample
7020 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7021 3
7022 4 #define M 42
7023 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7024 6
7025 7 main ()
7026 8 @{
7027 9 #define N 28
7028 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7029 11 #undef N
7030 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7031 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7032 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7033 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7034 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7035 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7036 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7037 #define Q <
7038 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7039 expands to: (42 + 1)
7040 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7041 expands to: once (M + 1)
7042 (@value{GDBP})
7043 @end smallexample
7044
7045 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7046 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7047 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7048 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7049
7050 Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
7051 the source line of the current stack frame:
7052
7053 @smallexample
7054 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7055 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7056 (@value{GDBP}) run
7057 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7058
7059 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7060 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7061 (@value{GDBP})
7062 @end smallexample
7063
7064 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7065
7066 @smallexample
7067 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7068 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7069 #define N 28
7070 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7071 expands to: 28 < 42
7072 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7073 $1 = 1
7074 (@value{GDBP})
7075 @end smallexample
7076
7077 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7078 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7079 thereof) in force at each point:
7080
7081 @smallexample
7082 (@value{GDBP}) next
7083 Hello, world!
7084 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7085 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7086 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7087 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7088 (@value{GDBP}) next
7089 We're so creative.
7090 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7091 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7092 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7093 #define N 1729
7094 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7095 expands to: 1729 < 42
7096 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7097 $2 = 0
7098 (@value{GDBP})
7099 @end smallexample
7100
7101
7102 @node Tracepoints
7103 @chapter Tracepoints
7104 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7105 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7106
7107 @cindex tracepoints
7108 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7109 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7110 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7111 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7112 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7113 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7114 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7115
7116 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7117 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7118 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7119 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7120 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7121 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7122 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7123 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7124 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7125 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7126 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7127
7128 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7129 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
7130 to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
7131 stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
7132 tracepoints as of this writing.
7133
7134 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7135
7136 @menu
7137 * Set Tracepoints::
7138 * Analyze Collected Data::
7139 * Tracepoint Variables::
7140 @end menu
7141
7142 @node Set Tracepoints
7143 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7144
7145 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7146 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7147 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7148 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7149 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7150 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7151 work on.
7152
7153 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7154 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7155 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7156 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7157 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7158 tracepoint was hit.
7159
7160 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7161 conditions and actions.
7162
7163 @menu
7164 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7165 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7166 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7167 * Tracepoint Actions::
7168 * Listing Tracepoints::
7169 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
7170 @end menu
7171
7172 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7173 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7174
7175 @table @code
7176 @cindex set tracepoint
7177 @kindex trace
7178 @item trace
7179 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7180 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7181 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7182 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7183 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7184 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7185 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7186 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7187 running.
7188
7189 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7190
7191 @smallexample
7192 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7193
7194 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7195
7196 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7197
7198 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7199
7200 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7201 @end smallexample
7202
7203 @noindent
7204 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7205
7206 @vindex $tpnum
7207 @cindex last tracepoint number
7208 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7209 @cindex tracepoint number
7210 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7211 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7212
7213 @kindex delete tracepoint
7214 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7215 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7216 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7217 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7218
7219 Examples:
7220
7221 @smallexample
7222 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7223
7224 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7225 @end smallexample
7226
7227 @noindent
7228 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7229 @end table
7230
7231 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7232 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7233
7234 @table @code
7235 @kindex disable tracepoint
7236 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7237 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7238 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7239 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7240 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7241
7242 @kindex enable tracepoint
7243 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7244 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7245 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7246 run.
7247 @end table
7248
7249 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7250 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7251
7252 @table @code
7253 @kindex passcount
7254 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7255 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7256 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7257 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7258 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7259 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7260 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7261 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7262 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7263 user.
7264
7265 Examples:
7266
7267 @smallexample
7268 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7269 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7270
7271 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7272 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7273 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7274 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7275 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7276 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7277 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7278 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7279 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7280 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7281 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7282 @end smallexample
7283 @end table
7284
7285 @node Tracepoint Actions
7286 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7287
7288 @table @code
7289 @kindex actions
7290 @cindex tracepoint actions
7291 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7292 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7293 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7294 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7295 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7296 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7297 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7298 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7299 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7300 @code{while-stepping}.
7301
7302 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7303 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7304 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7305
7306 @smallexample
7307 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7308
7309 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7310
7311 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7312 @end smallexample
7313
7314 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7315 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7316 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7317 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7318 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7319 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7320 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7321 @code{end} command.
7322
7323 @smallexample
7324 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7325 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7326 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7327 > collect bar,baz
7328 > collect $regs
7329 > while-stepping 12
7330 > collect $fp, $sp
7331 > end
7332 end
7333 @end smallexample
7334
7335 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7336 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7337 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7338 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7339 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7340 special arguments are supported:
7341
7342 @table @code
7343 @item $regs
7344 collect all registers
7345
7346 @item $args
7347 collect all function arguments
7348
7349 @item $locals
7350 collect all local variables.
7351 @end table
7352
7353 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7354 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
7355 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
7356
7357 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
7358 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
7359
7360 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
7361 @item while-stepping @var{n}
7362 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
7363 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
7364 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
7365 its own @code{end} command):
7366
7367 @smallexample
7368 > while-stepping 12
7369 > collect $regs, myglobal
7370 > end
7371 >
7372 @end smallexample
7373
7374 @noindent
7375 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
7376 @code{stepping}.
7377 @end table
7378
7379 @node Listing Tracepoints
7380 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
7381
7382 @table @code
7383 @kindex info tracepoints
7384 @kindex info tp
7385 @cindex information about tracepoints
7386 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7387 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
7388 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
7389 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
7390 shown:
7391
7392 @itemize @bullet
7393 @item
7394 its number
7395 @item
7396 whether it is enabled or disabled
7397 @item
7398 its address
7399 @item
7400 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
7401 @item
7402 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
7403 @item
7404 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
7405 @item
7406 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
7407 @end itemize
7408
7409 @smallexample
7410 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
7411 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
7412 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
7413 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
7414 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
7415 (@value{GDBP})
7416 @end smallexample
7417
7418 @noindent
7419 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
7420 @end table
7421
7422 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7423 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7424
7425 @table @code
7426 @kindex tstart
7427 @cindex start a new trace experiment
7428 @cindex collected data discarded
7429 @item tstart
7430 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
7431 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
7432 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
7433 experiment.
7434
7435 @kindex tstop
7436 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
7437 @item tstop
7438 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
7439 stops collecting data.
7440
7441 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
7442 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
7443 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
7444
7445 @kindex tstatus
7446 @cindex status of trace data collection
7447 @cindex trace experiment, status of
7448 @item tstatus
7449 This command displays the status of the current trace data
7450 collection.
7451 @end table
7452
7453 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
7454
7455 @smallexample
7456 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
7457 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7458 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
7459 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
7460 > while-stepping 11
7461 > collect $regs
7462 > end
7463 > end
7464 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7465 [time passes @dots{}]
7466 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
7467 @end smallexample
7468
7469
7470 @node Analyze Collected Data
7471 @section Using the collected data
7472
7473 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
7474 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
7475 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
7476 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
7477 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
7478 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
7479 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
7480 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
7481 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
7482 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
7483 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
7484 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
7485 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
7486 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
7487 the buffer will fail.
7488
7489 @menu
7490 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
7491 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
7492 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
7493 @end menu
7494
7495 @node tfind
7496 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
7497
7498 @kindex tfind
7499 @cindex select trace snapshot
7500 @cindex find trace snapshot
7501 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
7502 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
7503 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
7504 snapshot is selected.
7505
7506 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
7507
7508 @table @code
7509 @item tfind start
7510 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
7511 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
7512
7513 @item tfind none
7514 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
7515
7516 @item tfind end
7517 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
7518
7519 @item tfind
7520 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
7521
7522 @item tfind -
7523 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
7524 retracing earlier steps.
7525
7526 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
7527 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
7528 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
7529 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
7530 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
7531
7532 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
7533 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
7534 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
7535 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
7536 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
7537
7538 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
7539 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
7540 addresses.
7541
7542 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
7543 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
7544 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
7545
7546 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
7547 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
7548 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
7549 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
7550 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
7551 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
7552 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
7553 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
7554 @end table
7555
7556 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
7557 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
7558 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
7559 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
7560 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
7561 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
7562 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
7563 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
7564 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
7565 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
7566 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
7567 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
7568 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
7569 tracepoint as the current one.
7570
7571 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
7572 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
7573 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
7574 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
7575 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
7576
7577 @smallexample
7578 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7579 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
7580 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
7581 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
7582 > tfind
7583 > end
7584
7585 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
7586 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
7587 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
7588 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
7589 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
7590 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
7591 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
7592 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
7593 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
7594 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
7595 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
7596 @end smallexample
7597
7598 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
7599 the buffer:
7600
7601 @smallexample
7602 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7603 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
7604 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
7605 > tfind line
7606 > end
7607
7608 Frame 0, X = 1
7609 Frame 7, X = 2
7610 Frame 13, X = 255
7611 @end smallexample
7612
7613 @node tdump
7614 @subsection @code{tdump}
7615 @kindex tdump
7616 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
7617 @cindex tracepoint data, display
7618
7619 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
7620 the current trace snapshot.
7621
7622 @smallexample
7623 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
7624 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7625 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
7626 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
7627 > end
7628
7629 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7630
7631 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
7632 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
7633 at gdb_test.c:444
7634 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
7635
7636 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
7637 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
7638 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
7639 d1 0x18 24
7640 d2 0x80 128
7641 d3 0x33 51
7642 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
7643 d5 0x22 34
7644 d6 0xe0 224
7645 d7 0x380035 3670069
7646 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
7647 a1 0x3000668 50333288
7648 a2 0x100 256
7649 a3 0x322000 3284992
7650 a4 0x3000698 50333336
7651 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
7652 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
7653 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
7654 ps 0x0 0
7655 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
7656 fpcontrol 0x0 0
7657 fpstatus 0x0 0
7658 fpiaddr 0x0 0
7659 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
7660 p1 = (void *) 0x11
7661 p2 = (void *) 0x22
7662 p3 = (void *) 0x33
7663 p4 = (void *) 0x44
7664 p5 = (void *) 0x55
7665 p6 = (void *) 0x66
7666 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
7667
7668 (@value{GDBP})
7669 @end smallexample
7670
7671 @node save-tracepoints
7672 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
7673 @kindex save-tracepoints
7674 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
7675
7676 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
7677 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
7678 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
7679 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
7680 Files}).
7681
7682 @node Tracepoint Variables
7683 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
7684 @cindex tracepoint variables
7685 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
7686
7687 @table @code
7688 @vindex $trace_frame
7689 @item (int) $trace_frame
7690 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
7691 snapshot is selected.
7692
7693 @vindex $tracepoint
7694 @item (int) $tracepoint
7695 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
7696
7697 @vindex $trace_line
7698 @item (int) $trace_line
7699 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
7700
7701 @vindex $trace_file
7702 @item (char []) $trace_file
7703 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
7704
7705 @vindex $trace_func
7706 @item (char []) $trace_func
7707 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
7708 @end table
7709
7710 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
7711 use @code{output} instead.
7712
7713 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
7714 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
7715 data.
7716
7717 @smallexample
7718 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7719
7720 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
7721 > output $trace_file
7722 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
7723 > tfind
7724 > end
7725 @end smallexample
7726
7727 @node Overlays
7728 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
7729 @cindex overlays
7730
7731 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
7732 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
7733 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
7734 use overlays.
7735
7736 @menu
7737 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
7738 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
7739 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
7740 mapped by asking the inferior.
7741 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
7742 @end menu
7743
7744 @node How Overlays Work
7745 @section How Overlays Work
7746 @cindex mapped overlays
7747 @cindex unmapped overlays
7748 @cindex load address, overlay's
7749 @cindex mapped address
7750 @cindex overlay area
7751
7752 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7753 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7754 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7755 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7756 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7757
7758 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7759 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7760 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7761 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7762 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7763 largest overlay as well.
7764
7765 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7766 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7767 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7768 there.
7769
7770 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7771 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7772 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7773
7774 @smallexample
7775 @group
7776 Data Instruction Larger
7777 Address Space Address Space Address Space
7778 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7779 | | | | | |
7780 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7781 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7782 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
7783 | and heap | | | | | |
7784 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7785 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
7786 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7787 | | | | | |
7788 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7789 address | | | | | |
7790 | overlay | <-' | | |
7791 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7792 | | <---. | | load address
7793 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7794 | | | |
7795 +-----------+ | |
7796 +-----------+
7797 | |
7798 +-----------+
7799
7800 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
7801 @end group
7802 @end smallexample
7803
7804 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7805 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7806 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7807 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7808 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7809 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7810 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7811 program and the overlay area.
7812
7813 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7814 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7815 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7816 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7817 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7818 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7819 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7820
7821 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7822 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7823 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7824
7825 @itemize @bullet
7826
7827 @item
7828 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7829 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7830 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7831 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7832
7833 @item
7834 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7835 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7836 your program's performance.
7837
7838 @item
7839 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7840 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7841 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7842 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7843 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7844 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7845 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7846
7847 @item
7848 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7849 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7850 instruction and data spaces.
7851
7852 @end itemize
7853
7854 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7855 improved in many ways:
7856
7857 @itemize @bullet
7858
7859 @item
7860 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7861 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7862 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7863 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7864 area in the usual way.
7865
7866 @item
7867 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7868 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7869
7870 @item
7871 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7872 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7873 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7874 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7875 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7876 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7877 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7878
7879 @end itemize
7880
7881
7882 @node Overlay Commands
7883 @section Overlay Commands
7884
7885 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7886 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7887 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7888 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7889 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7890 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7891
7892 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7893 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7894
7895 @table @code
7896 @item overlay off
7897 @kindex overlay
7898 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7899 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7900 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7901 overlay support is disabled.
7902
7903 @item overlay manual
7904 @cindex manual overlay debugging
7905 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7906 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7907 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7908 commands described below.
7909
7910 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7911 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7912 @cindex map an overlay
7913 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7914 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7915 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7916 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7917 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7918 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7919
7920 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7921 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7922 @cindex unmap an overlay
7923 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7924 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7925 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7926 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7927
7928 @item overlay auto
7929 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7930 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7931 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7932 Overlay Debugging}.
7933
7934 @item overlay load-target
7935 @itemx overlay load
7936 @cindex reloading the overlay table
7937 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7938 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7939 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7940 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7941 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7942
7943 @item overlay list-overlays
7944 @itemx overlay list
7945 @cindex listing mapped overlays
7946 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7947 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7948
7949 @end table
7950
7951 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7952 of the function the address falls in:
7953
7954 @smallexample
7955 (@value{GDBP}) print main
7956 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
7957 @end smallexample
7958 @noindent
7959 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7960 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7961 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7962 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7963
7964 @smallexample
7965 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
7966 No sections are mapped.
7967 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
7968 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
7969 @end smallexample
7970 @noindent
7971 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7972 name normally:
7973
7974 @smallexample
7975 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
7976 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
7977 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7978 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
7979 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
7980 @end smallexample
7981
7982 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7983 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7984 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7985 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7986 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7987
7988 @itemize @bullet
7989 @item
7990 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
7991 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7992 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7993 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7994 @item
7995 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7996 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7997 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7998 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7999 breakpoints properly.
8000 @end itemize
8001
8002
8003 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8004 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8005 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8006
8007 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8008 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8009 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8010 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8011 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8012 current state of the overlays.
8013
8014 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8015 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8016
8017 @table @asis
8018
8019 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8020 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8021
8022 @smallexample
8023 struct
8024 @{
8025 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8026 unsigned long vma;
8027
8028 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8029 unsigned long size;
8030
8031 /* The overlay's load address. */
8032 unsigned long lma;
8033
8034 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8035 zero otherwise. */
8036 unsigned long mapped;
8037 @}
8038 @end smallexample
8039
8040 @item @code{_novlys}:
8041 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8042 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8043
8044 @end table
8045
8046 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8047 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8048 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8049 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8050 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8051 currently mapped.
8052
8053 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8054 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8055 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8056 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8057 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8058 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8059 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8060 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8061 are not being executed.
8062
8063 @node Overlay Sample Program
8064 @section Overlay Sample Program
8065 @cindex overlay example program
8066
8067 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8068 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8069 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8070 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8071 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8072 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8073 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8074
8075 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8076 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8077 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8078 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8079
8080 @table @file
8081 @item overlays.c
8082 The main program file.
8083 @item ovlymgr.c
8084 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8085 @item foo.c
8086 @itemx bar.c
8087 @itemx baz.c
8088 @itemx grbx.c
8089 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8090 @item d10v.ld
8091 @itemx m32r.ld
8092 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8093 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8094 @end table
8095
8096 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8097 cross-compiler like this:
8098
8099 @smallexample
8100 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8101 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8102 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8103 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8104 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8105 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8106 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8107 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8108 @end smallexample
8109
8110 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8111 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8112 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8113
8114
8115 @node Languages
8116 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8117 @cindex languages
8118
8119 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8120 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8121 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8122 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8123 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8124 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8125
8126 @cindex working language
8127 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8128 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8129 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8130 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8131 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8132 language}.
8133
8134 @menu
8135 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8136 * Show:: Displaying the language
8137 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8138 * Supported languages:: Supported languages
8139 * Unsupported languages:: Unsupported languages
8140 @end menu
8141
8142 @node Setting
8143 @section Switching between source languages
8144
8145 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8146 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8147 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8148 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8149 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8150 are printed, etc.
8151
8152 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8153 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8154 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8155 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8156 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8157 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8158 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8159 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8160 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8161 Displaying the language}.
8162
8163 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8164 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8165 another language. In that case, make the
8166 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8167 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8168 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8169
8170 @menu
8171 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8172 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8173 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8174 @end menu
8175
8176 @node Filenames
8177 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
8178
8179 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8180 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8181
8182 @table @file
8183 @item .ada
8184 @itemx .ads
8185 @itemx .adb
8186 @itemx .a
8187 Ada source file.
8188
8189 @item .c
8190 C source file
8191
8192 @item .C
8193 @itemx .cc
8194 @itemx .cp
8195 @itemx .cpp
8196 @itemx .cxx
8197 @itemx .c++
8198 C@t{++} source file
8199
8200 @item .m
8201 Objective-C source file
8202
8203 @item .f
8204 @itemx .F
8205 Fortran source file
8206
8207 @item .mod
8208 Modula-2 source file
8209
8210 @item .s
8211 @itemx .S
8212 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8213 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8214 @end table
8215
8216 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8217 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
8218
8219 @node Manually
8220 @subsection Setting the working language
8221
8222 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8223 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8224 your program.
8225
8226 @kindex set language
8227 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8228 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8229 a language, such as
8230 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8231 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8232
8233 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8234 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8235 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8236 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8237 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8238 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8239 command such as:
8240
8241 @smallexample
8242 print a = b + c
8243 @end smallexample
8244
8245 @noindent
8246 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8247 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8248 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8249 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8250
8251 @node Automatically
8252 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8253
8254 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8255 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8256 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8257 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8258 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8259 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8260 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8261 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8262 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8263
8264 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8265 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8266 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8267 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8268 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8269
8270 @node Show
8271 @section Displaying the language
8272
8273 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8274 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8275
8276 @table @code
8277 @item show language
8278 @kindex show language
8279 Display the current working language. This is the
8280 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8281 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8282
8283 @item info frame
8284 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8285 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8286 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8287 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
8288 information listed here.
8289
8290 @item info source
8291 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8292 Display the source language of this source file.
8293 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8294 information listed here.
8295 @end table
8296
8297 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8298 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8299 with a language explicitly:
8300
8301 @table @code
8302 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8303 @kindex set extension-language
8304 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8305 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8306
8307 @item info extensions
8308 @kindex info extensions
8309 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8310 @end table
8311
8312 @node Checks
8313 @section Type and range checking
8314
8315 @quotation
8316 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8317 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8318 section documents the intended facilities.
8319 @end quotation
8320 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8321
8322 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8323 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8324 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8325 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8326 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8327 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8328 errors when your program is running.
8329
8330 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8331 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8332 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8333 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8334 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8335 automatically based on your program's source language.
8336 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default
8337 settings of supported languages.
8338
8339 @menu
8340 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8341 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8342 @end menu
8343
8344 @cindex type checking
8345 @cindex checks, type
8346 @node Type Checking
8347 @subsection An overview of type checking
8348
8349 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8350 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8351 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8352 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8353
8354 @smallexample
8355 1 + 2 @result{} 3
8356 @exdent but
8357 @error{} 1 + 2.3
8358 @end smallexample
8359
8360 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
8361 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
8362
8363 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
8364 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
8365 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
8366 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
8367 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
8368 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
8369 also issues a warning.
8370
8371 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
8372 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
8373 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
8374 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
8375 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
8376 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
8377
8378 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
8379 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
8380 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
8381 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
8382 operators. @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for further
8383 details on specific languages.
8384
8385 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
8386
8387 @kindex set check type
8388 @kindex show check type
8389 @table @code
8390 @item set check type auto
8391 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
8392 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8393 each language.
8394
8395 @item set check type on
8396 @itemx set check type off
8397 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8398 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
8399 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
8400 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
8401 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
8402
8403 @item set check type warn
8404 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
8405 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
8406 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
8407 numbers and structures.
8408
8409 @item show type
8410 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
8411 is setting it automatically.
8412 @end table
8413
8414 @cindex range checking
8415 @cindex checks, range
8416 @node Range Checking
8417 @subsection An overview of range checking
8418
8419 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
8420 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
8421 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
8422 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
8423 not exceed the bounds of the array.
8424
8425 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
8426 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
8427 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
8428 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
8429
8430 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
8431 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
8432 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
8433 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
8434 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
8435 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
8436
8437 @smallexample
8438 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
8439 @end smallexample
8440
8441 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
8442 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported languages, ,
8443 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
8444
8445 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
8446
8447 @kindex set check range
8448 @kindex show check range
8449 @table @code
8450 @item set check range auto
8451 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
8452 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8453 each language.
8454
8455 @item set check range on
8456 @itemx set check range off
8457 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8458 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
8459 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
8460 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
8461
8462 @item set check range warn
8463 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
8464 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
8465 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
8466 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
8467 systems).
8468
8469 @item show range
8470 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
8471 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
8472 @end table
8473
8474 @node Supported languages
8475 @section Supported languages
8476
8477 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
8478 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
8479 @c This is false ...
8480 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
8481 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
8482 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
8483 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
8484 language.
8485
8486 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
8487 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
8488 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
8489 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
8490 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
8491 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
8492 language reference or tutorial.
8493
8494 @menu
8495 * C:: C and C@t{++}
8496 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
8497 * Fortran:: Fortran
8498 * Pascal:: Pascal
8499 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
8500 * Ada:: Ada
8501 @end menu
8502
8503 @node C
8504 @subsection C and C@t{++}
8505
8506 @cindex C and C@t{++}
8507 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
8508
8509 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
8510 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
8511 together.
8512
8513 @cindex C@t{++}
8514 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
8515 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
8516 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
8517 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
8518 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
8519 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
8520 compiler (@code{aCC}).
8521
8522 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
8523 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
8524 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
8525 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
8526 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
8527 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
8528
8529 @menu
8530 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
8531 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
8532 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
8533 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
8534 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
8535 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
8536 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
8537 @end menu
8538
8539 @node C Operators
8540 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
8541
8542 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
8543
8544 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8545 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8546 often defined on groups of types.
8547
8548 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
8549
8550 @itemize @bullet
8551
8552 @item
8553 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
8554 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
8555
8556 @item
8557 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
8558 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
8559
8560 @item
8561 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
8562
8563 @item
8564 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
8565
8566 @end itemize
8567
8568 @noindent
8569 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
8570 in order of increasing precedence:
8571
8572 @table @code
8573 @item ,
8574 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
8575 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
8576 expression being the last expression evaluated.
8577
8578 @item =
8579 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
8580 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
8581
8582 @item @var{op}=
8583 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
8584 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
8585 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
8586 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
8587 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
8588
8589 @item ?:
8590 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
8591 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
8592 integral type.
8593
8594 @item ||
8595 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8596
8597 @item &&
8598 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
8599
8600 @item |
8601 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8602
8603 @item ^
8604 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8605
8606 @item &
8607 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
8608
8609 @item ==@r{, }!=
8610 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
8611 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
8612
8613 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
8614 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
8615 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
8616 and non-zero for true.
8617
8618 @item <<@r{, }>>
8619 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
8620
8621 @item @@
8622 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8623
8624 @item +@r{, }-
8625 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
8626 pointer types.
8627
8628 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
8629 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
8630 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
8631 integral types.
8632
8633 @item ++@r{, }--
8634 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
8635 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
8636 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
8637 operation takes place.
8638
8639 @item *
8640 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
8641 @code{++}.
8642
8643 @item &
8644 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
8645
8646 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
8647 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
8648 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
8649 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
8650 stored.
8651
8652 @item -
8653 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
8654 precedence as @code{++}.
8655
8656 @item !
8657 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
8658 @code{++}.
8659
8660 @item ~
8661 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
8662 @code{++}.
8663
8664
8665 @item .@r{, }->
8666 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
8667 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
8668 pointer based on the stored type information.
8669 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
8670
8671 @item .*@r{, }->*
8672 Dereferences of pointers to members.
8673
8674 @item []
8675 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
8676 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
8677
8678 @item ()
8679 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
8680
8681 @item ::
8682 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
8683 and @code{class} types.
8684
8685 @item ::
8686 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
8687 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
8688 above.
8689 @end table
8690
8691 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
8692 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
8693 predefined meaning.
8694
8695 @menu
8696 * C Constants::
8697 @end menu
8698
8699 @node C Constants
8700 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
8701
8702 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
8703
8704 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
8705 following ways:
8706
8707 @itemize @bullet
8708 @item
8709 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
8710 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
8711 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
8712 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
8713 @code{long} value.
8714
8715 @item
8716 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
8717 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
8718 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
8719 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
8720 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
8721 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
8722 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
8723 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
8724 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
8725 constant.
8726
8727 @item
8728 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
8729 integral equivalents.
8730
8731 @item
8732 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
8733 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
8734 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
8735 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
8736 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
8737 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
8738 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
8739 @samp{\n} for newline.
8740
8741 @item
8742 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
8743 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
8744 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
8745 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
8746 characters.
8747
8748 @item
8749 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8750 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8751
8752 @item
8753 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8754 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8755 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8756 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8757 @end itemize
8758
8759 @menu
8760 * C plus plus expressions::
8761 * C Defaults::
8762 * C Checks::
8763
8764 * Debugging C::
8765 @end menu
8766
8767 @node C plus plus expressions
8768 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8769
8770 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8771 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8772
8773 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
8774 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
8775 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
8776 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
8777 @quotation
8778 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
8779 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
8780 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
8781 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
8782 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
8783 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
8784 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
8785 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
8786 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
8787 C@t{++} code.
8788 @end quotation
8789
8790 @enumerate
8791
8792 @cindex member functions
8793 @item
8794 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8795
8796 @smallexample
8797 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
8798 @end smallexample
8799
8800 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
8801 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
8802 @item
8803 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8804 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8805 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
8806 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
8807
8808 @cindex call overloaded functions
8809 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
8810 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
8811 @item
8812 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
8813 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
8814 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8815 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8816 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8817 default arguments.
8818
8819 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8820 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8821 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8822 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8823 number of function arguments.
8824
8825 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8826 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
8827 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
8828
8829 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
8830 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8831 @smallexample
8832 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8833 @end smallexample
8834
8835 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
8836 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
8837
8838 @cindex reference declarations
8839 @item
8840 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8841 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
8842 dereferenced.
8843
8844 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8845 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8846 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8847 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8848 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8849
8850 @item
8851 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
8852 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8853 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8854 necessary, for example in an expression like
8855 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
8856 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
8857 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8858 @end enumerate
8859
8860 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
8861 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8862 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8863 invoking user-defined operators.
8864
8865 @node C Defaults
8866 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
8867
8868 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
8869
8870 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8871 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
8872 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8873 selects the working language.
8874
8875 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8876 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8877 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
8878 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
8879 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8880 for further details.
8881
8882 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8883 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8884 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
8885
8886 @node C Checks
8887 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
8888
8889 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
8890
8891 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
8892 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8893 considers two variables type equivalent if:
8894
8895 @itemize @bullet
8896 @item
8897 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8898 enumerated tag.
8899
8900 @item
8901 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8902 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8903
8904 @ignore
8905 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8906 @c FIXME--beers?
8907 @item
8908 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8909 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8910 compilers.)
8911 @end ignore
8912 @end itemize
8913
8914 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8915 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8916 that is not itself an array.
8917
8918 @node Debugging C
8919 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
8920
8921 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8922 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
8923 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8924 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
8925
8926 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8927 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8928 ,Expressions}.
8929
8930 @menu
8931 * Debugging C plus plus::
8932 @end menu
8933
8934 @node Debugging C plus plus
8935 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
8936
8937 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
8938
8939 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8940 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
8941
8942 @table @code
8943 @cindex break in overloaded functions
8944 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
8945 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8946 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8947 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8948
8949 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
8950 @item rbreak @var{regex}
8951 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8952 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8953 classes.
8954 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8955
8956 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
8957 @item catch throw
8958 @itemx catch catch
8959 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
8960 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8961
8962 @cindex inheritance
8963 @item ptype @var{typename}
8964 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8965 @var{typename}.
8966 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8967
8968 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
8969 @item set print demangle
8970 @itemx show print demangle
8971 @itemx set print asm-demangle
8972 @itemx show print asm-demangle
8973 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8974 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
8975 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8976
8977 @item set print object
8978 @itemx show print object
8979 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8980 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8981
8982 @item set print vtbl
8983 @itemx show print vtbl
8984 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8985 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8986 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
8987 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
8988
8989 @kindex set overload-resolution
8990 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
8991 @item set overload-resolution on
8992 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
8993 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8994 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
8995 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
8996 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
8997 message.
8998
8999 @item set overload-resolution off
9000 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9001 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9002 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9003 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9004 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9005 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9006 argument types.
9007
9008 @kindex show overload-resolution
9009 @item show overload-resolution
9010 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9011
9012 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9013 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9014 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9015 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9016 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9017 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9018 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
9019 @end table
9020
9021 @node Objective-C
9022 @subsection Objective-C
9023
9024 @cindex Objective-C
9025 This section provides information about some commands and command
9026 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9027 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9028 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9029
9030 @menu
9031 * Method Names in Commands::
9032 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9033 @end menu
9034
9035 @node Method Names in Commands, The Print Command with Objective-C, Objective-C, Objective-C
9036 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9037
9038 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9039 names as line specifications:
9040
9041 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9042 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9043 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9044 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9045 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9046 @itemize
9047 @item @code{clear}
9048 @item @code{break}
9049 @item @code{info line}
9050 @item @code{jump}
9051 @item @code{list}
9052 @end itemize
9053
9054 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9055
9056 @smallexample
9057 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9058 @end smallexample
9059
9060 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9061 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9062 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9063 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9064 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9065 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9066 debugged, enter:
9067
9068 @smallexample
9069 break -[Fruit create]
9070 @end smallexample
9071
9072 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9073 enter:
9074
9075 @smallexample
9076 list +[NSText initialize]
9077 @end smallexample
9078
9079 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9080 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9081 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9082 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9083
9084 @smallexample
9085 break create
9086 @end smallexample
9087
9088 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9089 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9090 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9091 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9092 none apply.
9093
9094 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9095 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9096
9097 @smallexample
9098 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9099 @end smallexample
9100
9101 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9102 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9103 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9104 @kindex print-object
9105 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9106
9107 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9108
9109 @smallexample
9110 print -[@var{object} hash]
9111 @end smallexample
9112
9113 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9114 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9115 @noindent
9116 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9117 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9118 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9119 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9120 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9121 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9122
9123 @node Fortran
9124 @subsection Fortran
9125 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9126
9127 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9128 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9129
9130 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9131 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9132 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9133 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9134 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9135 underscore.
9136
9137 @menu
9138 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9139 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9140 * Special Fortran commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9141 @end menu
9142
9143 @node Fortran Operators
9144 @subsubsection Fortran operators and expressions
9145
9146 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9147
9148 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9149 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9150 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9151
9152 @table @code
9153 @item **
9154 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9155 of the second one.
9156
9157 @item :
9158 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9159 represent a section of array.
9160 @end table
9161
9162 @node Fortran Defaults
9163 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9164
9165 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9166
9167 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9168 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9169 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9170 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9171
9172 @node Special Fortran commands
9173 @subsubsection Special Fortran commands
9174
9175 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9176
9177 @value{GDBN} had some commands to support Fortran specific feature,
9178 such as common block displaying.
9179
9180 @table @code
9181 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9182 @kindex info common
9183 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9184 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9185 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9186 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at current program location are
9187 printed.
9188 @end table
9189
9190 @node Pascal
9191 @subsection Pascal
9192
9193 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9194 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9195 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9196 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9197 syntax.
9198
9199 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9200 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9201 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9202
9203 @node Modula-2
9204 @subsection Modula-2
9205
9206 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9207
9208 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9209 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9210 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9211 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9212 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9213 table.
9214
9215 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9216 @menu
9217 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9218 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9219 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9220 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9221 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9222 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9223 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9224 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9225 @end menu
9226
9227 @node M2 Operators
9228 @subsubsection Operators
9229 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9230
9231 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9232 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9233 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9234 following definitions hold:
9235
9236 @itemize @bullet
9237
9238 @item
9239 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9240 their subranges.
9241
9242 @item
9243 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9244
9245 @item
9246 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9247
9248 @item
9249 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9250 @var{type}}.
9251
9252 @item
9253 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9254
9255 @item
9256 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9257
9258 @item
9259 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9260 @end itemize
9261
9262 @noindent
9263 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9264 increasing precedence:
9265
9266 @table @code
9267 @item ,
9268 Function argument or array index separator.
9269
9270 @item :=
9271 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9272 @var{value}.
9273
9274 @item <@r{, }>
9275 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9276 types.
9277
9278 @item <=@r{, }>=
9279 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9280 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9281 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9282
9283 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9284 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9285 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9286 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9287 comment character.
9288
9289 @item IN
9290 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9291 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9292
9293 @item OR
9294 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9295
9296 @item AND@r{, }&
9297 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9298
9299 @item @@
9300 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9301
9302 @item +@r{, }-
9303 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9304 and difference on set types.
9305
9306 @item *
9307 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9308 on set types.
9309
9310 @item /
9311 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9312 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9313
9314 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9315 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9316 precedence as @code{*}.
9317
9318 @item -
9319 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9320
9321 @item ^
9322 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9323
9324 @item NOT
9325 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9326 @code{^}.
9327
9328 @item .
9329 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9330 precedence as @code{^}.
9331
9332 @item []
9333 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9334
9335 @item ()
9336 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9337 as @code{^}.
9338
9339 @item ::@r{, }.
9340 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9341 @end table
9342
9343 @quotation
9344 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9345 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9346 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
9347 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
9348 @end quotation
9349
9350
9351 @node Built-In Func/Proc
9352 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
9353 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
9354
9355 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
9356 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
9357
9358 @table @var
9359
9360 @item a
9361 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
9362
9363 @item c
9364 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
9365
9366 @item i
9367 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
9368
9369 @item m
9370 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
9371 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
9372 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
9373
9374 @item n
9375 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
9376
9377 @item r
9378 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
9379
9380 @item t
9381 represents a type.
9382
9383 @item v
9384 represents a variable.
9385
9386 @item x
9387 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
9388 explanation of the function for details.
9389 @end table
9390
9391 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
9392
9393 @table @code
9394 @item ABS(@var{n})
9395 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
9396
9397 @item CAP(@var{c})
9398 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
9399 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
9400
9401 @item CHR(@var{i})
9402 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9403
9404 @item DEC(@var{v})
9405 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9406
9407 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
9408 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9409 new value.
9410
9411 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9412 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
9413 set.
9414
9415 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
9416 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
9417
9418 @item HIGH(@var{a})
9419 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
9420
9421 @item INC(@var{v})
9422 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9423
9424 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
9425 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9426 new value.
9427
9428 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9429 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
9430 there. Returns the new set.
9431
9432 @item MAX(@var{t})
9433 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
9434
9435 @item MIN(@var{t})
9436 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
9437
9438 @item ODD(@var{i})
9439 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
9440
9441 @item ORD(@var{x})
9442 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
9443 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
9444 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
9445 integral, character and enumerated types.
9446
9447 @item SIZE(@var{x})
9448 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
9449
9450 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
9451 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
9452
9453 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
9454 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9455 @end table
9456
9457 @quotation
9458 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
9459 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
9460 an error.
9461 @end quotation
9462
9463 @cindex Modula-2 constants
9464 @node M2 Constants
9465 @subsubsection Constants
9466
9467 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
9468 ways:
9469
9470 @itemize @bullet
9471
9472 @item
9473 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
9474 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
9475 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
9476 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
9477
9478 @item
9479 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
9480 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
9481 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
9482 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
9483 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
9484 digits.
9485
9486 @item
9487 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
9488 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
9489 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
9490 followed by a @samp{C}.
9491
9492 @item
9493 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
9494 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
9495 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
9496 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
9497 sequences.
9498
9499 @item
9500 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
9501
9502 @item
9503 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
9504 @code{FALSE}.
9505
9506 @item
9507 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
9508
9509 @item
9510 Set constants are not yet supported.
9511 @end itemize
9512
9513 @node M2 Defaults
9514 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
9515 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
9516
9517 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
9518 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
9519 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9520 selected the working language.
9521
9522 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
9523 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
9524 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
9525 the language automatically}, for further details.
9526
9527 @node Deviations
9528 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
9529 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
9530
9531 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
9532 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
9533
9534 @itemize @bullet
9535 @item
9536 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
9537 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
9538 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
9539 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
9540 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
9541 returned a pointer.)
9542
9543 @item
9544 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
9545 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
9546 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
9547 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
9548
9549 @item
9550 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
9551 argument.
9552
9553 @item
9554 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
9555 @end itemize
9556
9557 @node M2 Checks
9558 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
9559 @cindex Modula-2 checks
9560
9561 @quotation
9562 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
9563 range checking.
9564 @end quotation
9565 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
9566
9567 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
9568
9569 @itemize @bullet
9570 @item
9571 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
9572 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
9573
9574 @item
9575 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
9576 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
9577 @end itemize
9578
9579 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
9580 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
9581
9582 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
9583 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
9584
9585 @node M2 Scope
9586 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9587 @cindex scope
9588 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
9589 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
9590 @ifinfo
9591 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
9592 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
9593 @end ifinfo
9594 @iftex
9595 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
9596 @end iftex
9597
9598 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
9599 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
9600 similar syntax:
9601
9602 @smallexample
9603
9604 @var{module} . @var{id}
9605 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
9606 @end smallexample
9607
9608 @noindent
9609 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
9610 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
9611 identifier within your program, except another module.
9612
9613 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
9614 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
9615 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
9616 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
9617
9618 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
9619 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
9620 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
9621 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
9622 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
9623 @var{module}.
9624
9625 @node GDB/M2
9626 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9627
9628 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
9629 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
9630 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
9631 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
9632 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
9633 analogue in Modula-2.
9634
9635 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
9636 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
9637 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
9638 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
9639 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
9640 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
9641
9642 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
9643 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
9644 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
9645
9646 @node Ada
9647 @subsection Ada
9648 @cindex Ada
9649
9650 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
9651 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
9652 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
9653 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9654 to be difficult.
9655
9656
9657 @cindex expressions in Ada
9658 @menu
9659 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
9660 and semantics supported by Ada mode
9661 in @value{GDBN}.
9662 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
9663 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
9664 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
9665 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
9666 @end menu
9667
9668 @node Ada Mode Intro
9669 @subsubsection Introduction
9670 @cindex Ada mode, general
9671
9672 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
9673 syntax, with some extensions.
9674 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
9675
9676 @itemize @bullet
9677 @item
9678 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
9679 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
9680 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
9681 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
9682
9683 @item
9684 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
9685 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
9686
9687 @item
9688 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
9689 @end itemize
9690
9691 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
9692 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
9693 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
9694 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
9695 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
9696
9697 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
9698 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
9699 was translated from an Ada source file.
9700
9701 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
9702 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
9703 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
9704 middle (to allow based literals).
9705
9706 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
9707 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
9708 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
9709 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
9710 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
9711 functions to procedures elsewhere.
9712
9713 @node Omissions from Ada
9714 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
9715 @cindex Ada, omissions from
9716
9717 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
9718
9719 @itemize @bullet
9720 @item
9721 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
9722
9723 @itemize @minus
9724 @item
9725 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
9726 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
9727
9728 @item
9729 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
9730
9731 @item
9732 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
9733
9734 @item
9735 @t{'Tag}.
9736
9737 @item
9738 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
9739 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
9740
9741 @item
9742 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
9743 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
9744
9745 @item
9746 @t{'Address}.
9747 @end itemize
9748
9749 @item
9750 The names in
9751 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
9752 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
9753 not currently available.
9754
9755 @item
9756 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
9757 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
9758 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
9759 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
9760 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
9761 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
9762 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
9763 indeterminate values.
9764
9765 @item
9766 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
9767 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
9768 are not implemented.
9769
9770 @item
9771 There are no record or array aggregates.
9772
9773 @item
9774 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
9775
9776 @item
9777 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
9778 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in which a subexpression
9779 appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much looser in its rules for allowing
9780 type matches. As a result, some function calls will be ambiguous, and the user
9781 will be asked to choose the proper resolution.
9782
9783 @item
9784 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
9785
9786 @item
9787 Entry calls are not implemented.
9788
9789 @item
9790 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
9791 formats are not supported.
9792
9793 @item
9794 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
9795 @end itemize
9796
9797 @node Additions to Ada
9798 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
9799 @cindex Ada, deviations from
9800
9801 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
9802 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
9803
9804 @itemize @bullet
9805 @item
9806 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory
9807 (typically a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is
9808 a positive integer, then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of
9809 @var{E} and the @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array.
9810 In Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use
9811 is in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in Ada.
9812 However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs
9813 in which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
9814
9815 @item
9816 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that appears
9817 in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name, you must typically
9818 surround it in single quotes.
9819
9820 @item
9821 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
9822 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
9823
9824 @item
9825 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
9826 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
9827 @end itemize
9828
9829 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright additions specific
9830 to Ada:
9831
9832 @itemize @bullet
9833 @item
9834 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
9835 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
9836
9837 @smallexample
9838 set x := y + 3
9839 print A(tmp := y + 1)
9840 @end smallexample
9841
9842 @item
9843 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
9844 the value of its right-hand operand.
9845 This allows, for example,
9846 complex conditional breaks:
9847
9848 @smallexample
9849 break f
9850 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
9851 @end smallexample
9852
9853 @item
9854 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
9855 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
9856 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
9857 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
9858 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
9859 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
9860 in strings. For example,
9861 @smallexample
9862 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
9863 @end smallexample
9864 @noindent
9865 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF}) after each
9866 period.
9867
9868 @item
9869 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
9870 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
9871 to write
9872
9873 @smallexample
9874 print 'max(x, y)
9875 @end smallexample
9876
9877 @item
9878 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
9879 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
9880 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound of 3 might print as
9881
9882 @smallexample
9883 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
9884 @end smallexample
9885
9886 @noindent
9887 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
9888 clause.
9889
9890 @item
9891 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
9892 multi-character subsequence of
9893 their names (an exact match gets preference).
9894 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
9895 in place of @t{a'length}.
9896
9897 @item
9898 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
9899 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
9900 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
9901 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
9902 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
9903 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
9904 For example,
9905 @smallexample
9906 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
9907 @end smallexample
9908
9909 @item
9910 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
9911 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
9912 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
9913 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
9914 object.
9915
9916 @end itemize
9917
9918 @node Stopping Before Main Program
9919 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
9920
9921 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
9922 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
9923 before reaching the main procedure.
9924 As defined in the Ada Reference
9925 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
9926 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
9927 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
9928 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
9929
9930 @node Ada Glitches
9931 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
9932 @cindex Ada, problems
9933
9934 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
9935 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
9936 @value{GDBN},
9937 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
9938 and the GNU Ada compiler.
9939
9940 @itemize @bullet
9941 @item
9942 Currently, the debugger
9943 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
9944 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
9945 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
9946 to get it printed properly.
9947
9948 @item
9949 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
9950 storage are invisible to the debugger.
9951
9952 @item
9953 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
9954 argument lists are treated as positional).
9955
9956 @item
9957 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
9958
9959 @item
9960 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
9961 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
9962 the host machine.
9963
9964 @item
9965 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
9966
9967 @item
9968 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
9969 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
9970 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
9971 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
9972 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
9973 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
9974 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
9975 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
9976 you can usually resolve the confusion
9977 by qualifying the problematic names with package
9978 @code{Standard} explicitly.
9979 @end itemize
9980
9981 @node Unsupported languages
9982 @section Unsupported languages
9983
9984 @cindex unsupported languages
9985 @cindex minimal language
9986 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
9987 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
9988 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
9989 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
9990 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
9991 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
9992
9993 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
9994 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
9995 language.
9996
9997 @node Symbols
9998 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
9999
10000 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10001 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10002 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10003 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10004 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10005 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
10006 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10007
10008 @cindex symbol names
10009 @cindex names of symbols
10010 @cindex quoting names
10011 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10012 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10013 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10014 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
10015 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10016 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10017 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10018 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10019
10020 @smallexample
10021 p 'foo.c'::x
10022 @end smallexample
10023
10024 @noindent
10025 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10026
10027 @table @code
10028 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10029 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10030 @kindex set case-sensitive
10031 @item set case-sensitive on
10032 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10033 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10034 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10035 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10036 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10037 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10038 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10039 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10040 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10041 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10042 case-insensitive matches.
10043
10044 @kindex show case-sensitive
10045 @item show case-sensitive
10046 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10047 lookups.
10048
10049 @kindex info address
10050 @cindex address of a symbol
10051 @item info address @var{symbol}
10052 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10053 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10054 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10055 is always stored.
10056
10057 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10058 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10059 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10060
10061 @kindex info symbol
10062 @cindex symbol from address
10063 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10064 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10065 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10066 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10067 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10068
10069 @smallexample
10070 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10071 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10072 @end smallexample
10073
10074 @noindent
10075 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10076 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10077
10078 @kindex whatis
10079 @item whatis @var{expr}
10080 Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
10081 actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10082 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
10083 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10084
10085 @item whatis
10086 Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10087
10088 @kindex ptype
10089 @item ptype @var{typename}
10090 Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
10091 the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
10092 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
10093 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10094
10095 @item ptype @var{expr}
10096 @itemx ptype
10097 Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
10098 differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
10099 of just the name of the type.
10100
10101 For example, for this variable declaration:
10102
10103 @smallexample
10104 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10105 @end smallexample
10106
10107 @noindent
10108 the two commands give this output:
10109
10110 @smallexample
10111 @group
10112 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10113 type = struct complex
10114 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10115 type = struct complex @{
10116 double real;
10117 double imag;
10118 @}
10119 @end group
10120 @end smallexample
10121
10122 @noindent
10123 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10124 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10125
10126 @cindex incomplete type
10127 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10128 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10129 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10130 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10131 given these declarations:
10132
10133 @smallexample
10134 struct foo;
10135 struct foo *fooptr;
10136 @end smallexample
10137
10138 @noindent
10139 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
10140
10141 @smallexample
10142 (gdb) ptype foo
10143 $1 = <incomplete type>
10144 @end smallexample
10145
10146 @noindent
10147 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
10148 completely specified.
10149
10150 @kindex info types
10151 @item info types @var{regexp}
10152 @itemx info types
10153 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
10154 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
10155 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
10156 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
10157 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
10158 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
10159 name is @code{value}.
10160
10161 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
10162 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
10163 lists all source files where a type is defined.
10164
10165 @kindex info scope
10166 @cindex local variables
10167 @item info scope @var{location}
10168 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
10169 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
10170 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
10171 to the scope defined by that location. For example:
10172
10173 @smallexample
10174 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
10175 Scope for command_line_handler:
10176 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
10177 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
10178 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
10179 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
10180 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
10181 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
10182 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
10183 @end smallexample
10184
10185 @noindent
10186 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
10187 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
10188 collect}.
10189
10190 @kindex info source
10191 @item info source
10192 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
10193 the function containing the current point of execution:
10194 @itemize @bullet
10195 @item
10196 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
10197 @item
10198 the directory it was compiled in,
10199 @item
10200 its length, in lines,
10201 @item
10202 which programming language it is written in,
10203 @item
10204 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
10205 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
10206 @item
10207 whether the debugging information includes information about
10208 preprocessor macros.
10209 @end itemize
10210
10211
10212 @kindex info sources
10213 @item info sources
10214 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
10215 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
10216 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
10217
10218 @kindex info functions
10219 @item info functions
10220 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
10221
10222 @item info functions @var{regexp}
10223 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
10224 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
10225 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
10226 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
10227 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
10228 that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
10229 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
10230
10231 @kindex info variables
10232 @item info variables
10233 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
10234 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
10235
10236 @item info variables @var{regexp}
10237 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
10238 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
10239 @var{regexp}.
10240
10241 @kindex info classes
10242 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
10243 @item info classes
10244 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
10245 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
10246 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10247 expression.
10248
10249 @kindex info selectors
10250 @item info selectors
10251 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
10252 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
10253 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10254 expression.
10255
10256 @ignore
10257 This was never implemented.
10258 @kindex info methods
10259 @item info methods
10260 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
10261 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
10262 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
10263 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
10264 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
10265 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
10266 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
10267 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
10268 @end ignore
10269
10270 @cindex reloading symbols
10271 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
10272 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
10273 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
10274 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
10275 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
10276
10277 @table @code
10278 @kindex set symbol-reloading
10279 @item set symbol-reloading on
10280 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
10281 object file with a particular name is seen again.
10282
10283 @item set symbol-reloading off
10284 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
10285 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
10286 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
10287 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
10288 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
10289 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
10290 name.
10291
10292 @kindex show symbol-reloading
10293 @item show symbol-reloading
10294 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
10295 @end table
10296
10297 @cindex opaque data types
10298 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
10299 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
10300 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
10301 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
10302 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
10303 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
10304 another source file. The default is on.
10305
10306 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
10307 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
10308
10309 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
10310 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
10311 is printed as follows:
10312 @smallexample
10313 @{<no data fields>@}
10314 @end smallexample
10315
10316 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
10317 @item show opaque-type-resolution
10318 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
10319
10320 @kindex maint print symbols
10321 @cindex symbol dump
10322 @kindex maint print psymbols
10323 @cindex partial symbol dump
10324 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
10325 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
10326 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
10327 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
10328 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
10329 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
10330 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
10331 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
10332 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
10333 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
10334 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
10335 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
10336 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
10337 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
10338 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
10339 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
10340 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
10341
10342 @kindex maint info symtabs
10343 @kindex maint info psymtabs
10344 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
10345 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10346 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10347 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10348 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
10349 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
10350
10351 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
10352 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
10353 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
10354 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
10355 structure in more detail. For example:
10356
10357 @smallexample
10358 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
10359 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
10360 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
10361 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
10362 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
10363 readin no
10364 fullname (null)
10365 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
10366 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
10367 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
10368 dependencies (none)
10369 @}
10370 @}
10371 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
10372 (@value{GDBP})
10373 @end smallexample
10374 @noindent
10375 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
10376 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
10377 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
10378 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
10379 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
10380
10381 @smallexample
10382 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
10383 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
10384 line 1574.
10385 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
10386 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
10387 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
10388 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
10389 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
10390 dirname (null)
10391 fullname (null)
10392 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
10393 debugformat DWARF 2
10394 @}
10395 @}
10396 (@value{GDBP})
10397 @end smallexample
10398 @end table
10399
10400
10401 @node Altering
10402 @chapter Altering Execution
10403
10404 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
10405 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
10406 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
10407 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
10408 program.
10409
10410 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
10411 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
10412 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
10413
10414 @menu
10415 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
10416 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
10417 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
10418 * Returning:: Returning from a function
10419 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
10420 * Patching:: Patching your program
10421 @end menu
10422
10423 @node Assignment
10424 @section Assignment to variables
10425
10426 @cindex assignment
10427 @cindex setting variables
10428 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
10429 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
10430
10431 @smallexample
10432 print x=4
10433 @end smallexample
10434
10435 @noindent
10436 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
10437 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
10438 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
10439 information on operators in supported languages.
10440
10441 @kindex set variable
10442 @cindex variables, setting
10443 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
10444 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
10445 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
10446 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
10447 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
10448
10449 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
10450 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
10451 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
10452 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
10453 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
10454 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
10455 command @code{set width}:
10456
10457 @smallexample
10458 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
10459 type = double
10460 (@value{GDBP}) p width
10461 $4 = 13
10462 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
10463 Invalid syntax in expression.
10464 @end smallexample
10465
10466 @noindent
10467 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
10468 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
10469
10470 @smallexample
10471 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
10472 @end smallexample
10473
10474 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
10475 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
10476 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
10477 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
10478 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
10479 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
10480
10481 @smallexample
10482 @group
10483 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
10484 type = double
10485 (@value{GDBP}) p g
10486 $1 = 1
10487 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
10488 (@value{GDBP}) p g
10489 $2 = 1
10490 (@value{GDBP}) r
10491 The program being debugged has been started already.
10492 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
10493 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
10494 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
10495 Invalid bfd target.
10496 (@value{GDBP}) show g
10497 The current BFD target is "=4".
10498 @end group
10499 @end smallexample
10500
10501 @noindent
10502 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
10503 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
10504 @code{g}, use
10505
10506 @smallexample
10507 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
10508 @end smallexample
10509
10510 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
10511 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
10512 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
10513 same length or shorter.
10514 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
10515 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
10516
10517 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
10518 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
10519 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
10520 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
10521 and representation in memory), and
10522
10523 @smallexample
10524 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
10525 @end smallexample
10526
10527 @noindent
10528 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
10529
10530 @node Jumping
10531 @section Continuing at a different address
10532
10533 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
10534 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
10535 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
10536
10537 @table @code
10538 @kindex jump
10539 @item jump @var{linespec}
10540 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
10541 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
10542 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
10543 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
10544 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
10545 breakpoints}.
10546
10547 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
10548 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
10549 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
10550 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
10551 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
10552 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
10553 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
10554 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
10555 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
10556
10557 @item jump *@var{address}
10558 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
10559 @end table
10560
10561 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
10562 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
10563 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
10564 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
10565 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
10566 example,
10567
10568 @smallexample
10569 set $pc = 0x485
10570 @end smallexample
10571
10572 @noindent
10573 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
10574 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
10575 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
10576
10577 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
10578 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
10579 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
10580 detail.
10581
10582 @c @group
10583 @node Signaling
10584 @section Giving your program a signal
10585 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
10586
10587 @table @code
10588 @kindex signal
10589 @item signal @var{signal}
10590 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
10591 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
10592 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
10593 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
10594
10595 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
10596 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
10597 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
10598 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
10599 signal.
10600
10601 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
10602 after executing the command.
10603 @end table
10604 @c @end group
10605
10606 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
10607 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
10608 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
10609 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
10610 passes the signal directly to your program.
10611
10612
10613 @node Returning
10614 @section Returning from a function
10615
10616 @table @code
10617 @cindex returning from a function
10618 @kindex return
10619 @item return
10620 @itemx return @var{expression}
10621 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
10622 command. If you give an
10623 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
10624 value.
10625 @end table
10626
10627 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
10628 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
10629 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
10630 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
10631
10632 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
10633 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
10634 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
10635 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
10636 of functions.
10637
10638 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
10639 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
10640 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
10641 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
10642 selected stack frame returns naturally.
10643
10644 @node Calling
10645 @section Calling program functions
10646
10647 @table @code
10648 @cindex calling functions
10649 @cindex inferior functions, calling
10650 @item print @var{expr}
10651 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resuling value.
10652 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
10653 debugged.
10654
10655 @kindex call
10656 @item call @var{expr}
10657 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
10658 returned values.
10659
10660 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
10661 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
10662 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
10663 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
10664 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
10665 value history.
10666 @end table
10667
10668 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
10669 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
10670 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
10671 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
10672
10673 @table @code
10674 @item set unwindonsignal
10675 @kindex set unwindonsignal
10676 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
10677 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
10678 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
10679 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
10680 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
10681 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
10682 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
10683 received.
10684
10685 @item show unwindonsignal
10686 @kindex show unwindonsignal
10687 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
10688 @value{GDBN}.
10689 @end table
10690
10691 @cindex weak alias functions
10692 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
10693 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
10694 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
10695 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
10696 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
10697 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
10698 function instead.
10699
10700 @node Patching
10701 @section Patching programs
10702
10703 @cindex patching binaries
10704 @cindex writing into executables
10705 @cindex writing into corefiles
10706
10707 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
10708 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
10709 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
10710 patching your program's binary.
10711
10712 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
10713 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
10714 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
10715 repairs.
10716
10717 @table @code
10718 @kindex set write
10719 @item set write on
10720 @itemx set write off
10721 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
10722 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
10723 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
10724
10725 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
10726 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
10727 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
10728
10729 @item show write
10730 @kindex show write
10731 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
10732 as well as reading.
10733 @end table
10734
10735 @node GDB Files
10736 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
10737
10738 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
10739 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
10740 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
10741 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
10742
10743 @menu
10744 * Files:: Commands to specify files
10745 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
10746 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
10747 @end menu
10748
10749 @node Files
10750 @section Commands to specify files
10751
10752 @cindex symbol table
10753 @cindex core dump file
10754
10755 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
10756 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
10757 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
10758 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
10759
10760 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
10761 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
10762 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
10763 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file}). In these situations the
10764 @value{GDBN} commands to specify new files are useful.
10765
10766 @table @code
10767 @cindex executable file
10768 @kindex file
10769 @item file @var{filename}
10770 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
10771 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
10772 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
10773 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
10774 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
10775 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
10776 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
10777 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
10778
10779 @cindex unlinked object files
10780 @cindex patching object files
10781 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
10782 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
10783 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
10784 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
10785 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
10786 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
10787 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
10788 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
10789
10790 @item file
10791 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
10792 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
10793
10794 @kindex exec-file
10795 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
10796 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
10797 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
10798 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
10799 discard information on the executable file.
10800
10801 @kindex symbol-file
10802 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
10803 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
10804 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
10805 table and program to run from the same file.
10806
10807 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
10808 program's symbol table.
10809
10810 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
10811 of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
10812 auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
10813 the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
10814 the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
10815
10816 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
10817 executing it once.
10818
10819 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
10820 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
10821 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
10822 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
10823 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
10824 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
10825 optimized code.
10826
10827 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
10828 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
10829 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
10830 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
10831 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
10832
10833 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
10834 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
10835 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
10836 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
10837 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
10838 warnings and messages}.)
10839
10840 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
10841 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
10842 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
10843 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
10844 in stabs format.
10845
10846 @kindex readnow
10847 @cindex reading symbols immediately
10848 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
10849 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
10850 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
10851 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
10852 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
10853 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
10854 entire symbol table available.
10855
10856 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
10857 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
10858 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
10859 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
10860 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
10861 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
10862 @c files.
10863
10864 @kindex core-file
10865 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
10866 @itemx core
10867 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
10868 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
10869 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
10870 executable file itself for other parts.
10871
10872 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
10873 to be used.
10874
10875 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
10876 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
10877 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
10878 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
10879 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
10880
10881 @kindex add-symbol-file
10882 @cindex dynamic linking
10883 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
10884 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
10885 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
10886 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
10887 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
10888 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
10889 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
10890 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
10891 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
10892 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
10893 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
10894 @var{address} as an expression.
10895
10896 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
10897 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
10898 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
10899 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
10900 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
10901
10902 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
10903 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
10904 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
10905 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
10906 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
10907 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
10908 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
10909 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
10910 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
10911
10912 @itemize @bullet
10913 @item
10914 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
10915 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
10916 @item
10917 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
10918 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
10919 @item
10920 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
10921 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10922 @end itemize
10923
10924 @noindent
10925 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
10926 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
10927 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
10928 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
10929 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
10930 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
10931 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
10932 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
10933 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
10934 way.
10935
10936 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10937
10938 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
10939 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
10940 @cindex load symbols from memory
10941 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
10942 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
10943 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
10944 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
10945 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
10946 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
10947 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
10948 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
10949 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
10950
10951 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
10952 @kindex assf
10953 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
10954 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
10955 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
10956 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
10957 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
10958 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
10959 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
10960 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
10961 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
10962 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
10963
10964 @kindex section
10965 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
10966 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
10967 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
10968 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
10969 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
10970 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
10971 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
10972 their addresses.
10973
10974 @kindex info files
10975 @kindex info target
10976 @item info files
10977 @itemx info target
10978 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
10979 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
10980 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
10981 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
10982 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
10983 current ones.
10984
10985 @kindex maint info sections
10986 @item maint info sections
10987 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
10988 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
10989 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
10990 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
10991 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
10992 may be arbitrarily combined):
10993
10994 @table @code
10995 @item ALLOBJ
10996 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
10997 @item @var{sections}
10998 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
10999 @item @var{section-flags}
11000 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11001 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11002 @table @code
11003 @item ALLOC
11004 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11005 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11006 @item LOAD
11007 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11008 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11009 @item RELOC
11010 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11011 @item READONLY
11012 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11013 @item CODE
11014 Section contains executable code only.
11015 @item DATA
11016 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11017 @item ROM
11018 Section will reside in ROM.
11019 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11020 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11021 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11022 Section is not empty.
11023 @item NEVER_LOAD
11024 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11025 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11026 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11027 COFF shared library information.
11028 @item IS_COMMON
11029 Section contains common symbols.
11030 @end table
11031 @end table
11032 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11033 @cindex read-only sections
11034 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11035 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11036 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11037 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11038 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11039 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11040 enhancement to debugging performance.
11041
11042 The default is off.
11043
11044 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11045 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11046 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11047 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11048
11049 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11050 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11051 @end table
11052
11053 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11054 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11055 name and remembers it that way.
11056
11057 @cindex shared libraries
11058 @value{GDBN} supports GNU/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11059 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11060
11061 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11062 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11063 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11064 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11065 debugging a core file).
11066
11067 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11068 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11069
11070 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11071 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11072 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11073
11074 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11075 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11076 particularly large or there are many of them.
11077
11078 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11079 commands:
11080
11081 @table @code
11082 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11083 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11084 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11085 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11086 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11087 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11088 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11089 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11090
11091 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11092 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11093 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11094 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11095 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11096 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11097 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11098 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expresion that matches
11099 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11100
11101 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11102 @item show auto-solib-add
11103 Display the current autoloading mode.
11104 @end table
11105
11106 @cindex load shared library
11107 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11108 command:
11109
11110 @table @code
11111 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11112 @kindex info share
11113 @item info share
11114 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11115 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11116
11117 @kindex sharedlibrary
11118 @kindex share
11119 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11120 @itemx share @var{regex}
11121 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11122 Unix regular expression.
11123 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11124 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11125 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11126 loaded.
11127
11128 @item nosharedlibrary
11129 @kindex nosharedlibrary
11130 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11131 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
11132 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
11133 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
11134 discarded.
11135 @end table
11136
11137 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
11138 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
11139 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
11140
11141 @table @code
11142 @item set stop-on-solib-events
11143 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
11144 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
11145 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
11146 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
11147 shared library.
11148
11149 @item show stop-on-solib-events
11150 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
11151 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
11152 library events happen.
11153 @end table
11154
11155 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
11156 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
11157 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
11158 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
11159 not.
11160
11161 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
11162 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
11163 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
11164 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
11165 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
11166
11167 @table @code
11168 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
11169 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
11170 @item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
11171 If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
11172 absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
11173 paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
11174 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
11175 out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
11176 @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
11177
11178 @cindex default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
11179 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
11180 You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
11181 configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
11182
11183 @kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
11184 @item show solib-absolute-prefix
11185 Display the current shared library prefix.
11186
11187 @kindex set solib-search-path
11188 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
11189 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
11190 to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
11191 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
11192 the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
11193 @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
11194 set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
11195 @value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
11196
11197 @kindex show solib-search-path
11198 @item show solib-search-path
11199 Display the current shared library search path.
11200 @end table
11201
11202
11203 @node Separate Debug Files
11204 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
11205 @cindex separate debugging information files
11206 @cindex debugging information in separate files
11207 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
11208 @cindex debugging information directory, global
11209 @cindex global debugging information directory
11210
11211 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
11212 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
11213 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
11214 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
11215 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
11216 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
11217 install only when they need to debug a problem.
11218
11219 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
11220 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
11221 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
11222 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
11223 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
11224 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
11225 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
11226 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
11227 places:
11228
11229 @itemize @bullet
11230 @item
11231 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
11232 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
11233 @item
11234 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
11235 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
11236 @item
11237 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
11238 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
11239 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
11240 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
11241 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
11242 @end itemize
11243 @noindent
11244 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
11245 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
11246 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
11247
11248 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
11249 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
11250 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
11251 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
11252 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
11253 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
11254
11255 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
11256 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
11257
11258 @table @code
11259
11260 @kindex set debug-file-directory
11261 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
11262 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11263 information files to @var{directory}.
11264
11265 @kindex show debug-file-directory
11266 @item show debug-file-directory
11267 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11268 information files.
11269
11270 @end table
11271
11272 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
11273 @cindex debug links
11274 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
11275 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
11276
11277 @itemize
11278 @item
11279 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
11280 a zero byte,
11281 @item
11282 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
11283 boundary within the section, and
11284 @item
11285 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
11286 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
11287 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
11288 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
11289 @end itemize
11290
11291 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
11292 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
11293 described above.
11294
11295 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
11296 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
11297 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
11298 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
11299 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
11300 in an ordinary executable.
11301
11302 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
11303 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
11304 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
11305 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
11306 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
11307 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
11308 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
11309
11310 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
11311 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
11312 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
11313 complete code for a function that computes it:
11314
11315 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
11316 @smallexample
11317 unsigned long
11318 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
11319 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
11320 @{
11321 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
11322 @{
11323 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
11324 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
11325 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
11326 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
11327 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
11328 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
11329 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
11330 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
11331 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
11332 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
11333 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
11334 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
11335 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
11336 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
11337 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
11338 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
11339 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
11340 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
11341 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
11342 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
11343 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
11344 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
11345 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
11346 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
11347 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
11348 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
11349 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
11350 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
11351 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
11352 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
11353 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
11354 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
11355 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
11356 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
11357 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
11358 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
11359 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
11360 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
11361 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
11362 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
11363 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
11364 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
11365 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
11366 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
11367 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
11368 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
11369 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
11370 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
11371 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
11372 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
11373 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
11374 0x2d02ef8d
11375 @};
11376 unsigned char *end;
11377
11378 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
11379 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
11380 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
11381 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
11382 @}
11383 @end smallexample
11384
11385
11386 @node Symbol Errors
11387 @section Errors reading symbol files
11388
11389 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
11390 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
11391 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
11392 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
11393 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
11394 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
11395 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
11396 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
11397 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
11398 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
11399 messages}).
11400
11401 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
11402
11403 @table @code
11404 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
11405
11406 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
11407 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
11408 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
11409 in its outer scope blocks.
11410
11411 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
11412 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
11413 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
11414 function.
11415
11416 @item block at @var{address} out of order
11417
11418 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
11419 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
11420 do so.
11421
11422 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
11423 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
11424 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
11425 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
11426 messages}.)
11427
11428 @item bad block start address patched
11429
11430 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
11431 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
11432 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
11433
11434 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
11435 starting on the previous source line.
11436
11437 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
11438
11439 @cindex foo
11440 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
11441 larger than the size of the string table.
11442
11443 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
11444 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
11445 with this name.
11446
11447 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
11448
11449 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
11450 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
11451 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
11452
11453 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
11454 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
11455 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
11456 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
11457 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
11458 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
11459
11460 @item stub type has NULL name
11461
11462 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
11463
11464 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
11465 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
11466 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
11467 it.
11468
11469 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
11470
11471 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
11472
11473 @end table
11474
11475 @node Targets
11476 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
11477
11478 @cindex debugging target
11479 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
11480
11481 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
11482 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
11483 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
11484 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
11485 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
11486 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
11487 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
11488 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11489
11490 @cindex target architecture
11491 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
11492 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
11493 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
11494 command.
11495
11496 @table @code
11497 @kindex set architecture
11498 @kindex show architecture
11499 @item set architecture @var{arch}
11500 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
11501 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
11502 supported architectures.
11503
11504 @item show architecture
11505 Show the current target architecture.
11506
11507 @item set processor
11508 @itemx processor
11509 @kindex set processor
11510 @kindex show processor
11511 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
11512 and @code{show architecture}.
11513 @end table
11514
11515 @menu
11516 * Active Targets:: Active targets
11517 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
11518 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
11519 * Remote:: Remote debugging
11520 * KOD:: Kernel Object Display
11521
11522 @end menu
11523
11524 @node Active Targets
11525 @section Active targets
11526
11527 @cindex stacking targets
11528 @cindex active targets
11529 @cindex multiple targets
11530
11531 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
11532 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
11533 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
11534 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
11535 a core file.
11536
11537 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
11538 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
11539 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
11540 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
11541 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
11542 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
11543 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
11544 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
11545 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
11546
11547 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
11548 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
11549 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
11550 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
11551 process target is active.
11552
11553 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
11554 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
11555 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
11556 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
11557 process}).
11558
11559 @node Target Commands
11560 @section Commands for managing targets
11561
11562 @table @code
11563 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
11564 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
11565 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
11566 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
11567 protocol of the target machine.
11568
11569 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
11570 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
11571 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
11572
11573 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
11574 after executing the command.
11575
11576 @kindex help target
11577 @item help target
11578 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
11579 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
11580 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
11581
11582 @item help target @var{name}
11583 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
11584 select it.
11585
11586 @kindex set gnutarget
11587 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
11588 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
11589 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
11590 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
11591 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
11592 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
11593
11594 @quotation
11595 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
11596 you must know the actual BFD name.
11597 @end quotation
11598
11599 @noindent
11600 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
11601
11602 @kindex show gnutarget
11603 @item show gnutarget
11604 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
11605 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
11606 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
11607 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
11608 @end table
11609
11610 @cindex common targets
11611 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
11612 configuration):
11613
11614 @table @code
11615 @kindex target
11616 @item target exec @var{program}
11617 @cindex executable file target
11618 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
11619 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
11620
11621 @item target core @var{filename}
11622 @cindex core dump file target
11623 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
11624 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
11625
11626 @item target remote @var{dev}
11627 @cindex remote target
11628 Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
11629 specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
11630 @file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
11631 supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
11632 some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
11633 it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
11634
11635 @item target sim
11636 @cindex built-in simulator target
11637 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
11638 In general,
11639 @smallexample
11640 target sim
11641 load
11642 run
11643 @end smallexample
11644 @noindent
11645 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
11646 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
11647 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
11648 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
11649 Processors}.
11650
11651 @end table
11652
11653 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
11654
11655 @table @code
11656
11657 @item target nrom @var{dev}
11658 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
11659 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
11660
11661 @end table
11662
11663 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
11664 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
11665
11666 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
11667 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
11668 various aspects of this process, such as the size of the data chunks
11669 used by @value{GDBN} to download program parts to the remote target.
11670
11671 @table @code
11672 @kindex set download-write-size
11673 @item set download-write-size @var{size}
11674 Set the write size used when downloading a program. Only used when
11675 downloading a program onto a remote target. Specify zero or a
11676 negative value to disable blocked writes. The actual size of each
11677 transfer is also limited by the size of the target packet and the
11678 memory cache.
11679
11680 @kindex show download-write-size
11681 @item show download-write-size
11682 @kindex show download-write-size
11683 Show the current value of the write size.
11684
11685 @item set hash
11686 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
11687 @cindex hash mark while downloading
11688 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
11689 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
11690 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
11691 monitor.
11692
11693 @item show hash
11694 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
11695 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
11696
11697 @item set debug monitor
11698 @kindex set debug monitor
11699 @cindex display remote monitor communications
11700 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
11701 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
11702
11703 @item show debug monitor
11704 @kindex show debug monitor
11705 Show the current status of displaying communications between
11706 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
11707 @end table
11708
11709 @table @code
11710
11711 @kindex load @var{filename}
11712 @item load @var{filename}
11713 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
11714 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
11715 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
11716 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
11717 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
11718 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11719
11720 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
11721 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
11722 target is @dots{}}''
11723
11724 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
11725 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
11726 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
11727 specifies a fixed address.
11728 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
11729
11730 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
11731 @end table
11732
11733 @node Byte Order
11734 @section Choosing target byte order
11735
11736 @cindex choosing target byte order
11737 @cindex target byte order
11738
11739 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
11740 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
11741 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
11742 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
11743 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
11744 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
11745
11746 @table @code
11747 @kindex set endian
11748 @item set endian big
11749 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
11750
11751 @item set endian little
11752 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
11753
11754 @item set endian auto
11755 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
11756 executable.
11757
11758 @item show endian
11759 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
11760
11761 @end table
11762
11763 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
11764 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
11765 target system.
11766
11767 @node Remote
11768 @section Remote debugging
11769 @cindex remote debugging
11770
11771 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
11772 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
11773 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
11774 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
11775 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
11776
11777 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
11778 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
11779 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
11780 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
11781 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
11782 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
11783
11784 Other remote targets may be available in your
11785 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
11786
11787 Once you've connected to the remote target, @value{GDBN} allows you to
11788 send arbitrary commands to the remote monitor:
11789
11790 @table @code
11791 @item remote @var{command}
11792 @kindex remote@r{, a command}
11793 @cindex send command to remote monitor
11794 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the remote monitor.
11795 @end table
11796
11797
11798 @node KOD
11799 @section Kernel Object Display
11800 @cindex kernel object display
11801 @cindex KOD
11802
11803 Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
11804 @value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
11805 and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
11806 mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
11807 displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
11808
11809 @kindex set os
11810 Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
11811 @value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
11812
11813 @smallexample
11814 (@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
11815 @end smallexample
11816
11817 @kindex show os
11818 The associated command @code{show os} displays the operating system
11819 set with the @code{set os} command; if no operating system has been
11820 set, @code{show os} will display an empty string @samp{""}.
11821
11822 If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
11823 about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
11824 which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
11825 after the operating system:
11826
11827 @kindex info cisco
11828 @smallexample
11829 (@value{GDBP}) info cisco
11830 List of Cisco Kernel Objects
11831 Object Description
11832 any Any and all objects
11833 @end smallexample
11834
11835 Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
11836 by the kernel.
11837
11838 There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating
11839 system is supported other than to try setting it with @kbd{set os
11840 @var{name}}, where @var{name} is the name of the operating system you
11841 want to try.
11842
11843
11844 @node Remote Debugging
11845 @chapter Debugging remote programs
11846
11847 @menu
11848 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
11849 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
11850 * NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
11851 * Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
11852 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
11853 @end menu
11854
11855 @node Connecting
11856 @section Connecting to a remote target
11857
11858 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
11859 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symobl and debugging information.
11860 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
11861 program as the first argument.
11862
11863 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
11864 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
11865 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
11866 (@pxref{Remote configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
11867 @code{target} command.
11868
11869 After that, use @code{target remote} to establish communications with
11870 the target machine. Its argument specifies how to communicate---either
11871 via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a TCP or UDP port
11872 (possibly to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
11873 target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the device
11874 named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
11875
11876 @smallexample
11877 target remote /dev/ttyb
11878 @end smallexample
11879
11880 @cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
11881 To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
11882 @code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
11883 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
11884 terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
11885
11886 @smallexample
11887 target remote manyfarms:2828
11888 @end smallexample
11889
11890 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
11891 your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
11892 the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
11893 to port 1234 on your local machine:
11894
11895 @smallexample
11896 target remote :1234
11897 @end smallexample
11898 @noindent
11899
11900 Note that the colon is still required here.
11901
11902 @cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
11903 To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
11904 @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
11905 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
11906
11907 @smallexample
11908 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
11909 @end smallexample
11910
11911 When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
11912 that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
11913 busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
11914 session.
11915
11916 Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
11917 step and continue the remote program.
11918
11919 @cindex interrupting remote programs
11920 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
11921 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
11922 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
11923 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
11924 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
11925 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
11926
11927 @smallexample
11928 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
11929 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
11930 @end smallexample
11931
11932 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
11933 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
11934 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
11935 goes back to waiting.
11936
11937 @table @code
11938 @kindex detach (remote)
11939 @item detach
11940 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
11941 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
11942 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
11943 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
11944 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
11945
11946 @kindex disconnect
11947 @item disconnect
11948 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
11949 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
11950 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
11951 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
11952 another target.
11953
11954 @cindex send command to remote monitor
11955 @kindex monitor
11956 @item monitor @var{cmd}
11957 This command allows you to send commands directly to the remote
11958 monitor.
11959 @end table
11960
11961 @node Server
11962 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
11963
11964 @kindex gdbserver
11965 @cindex remote connection without stubs
11966 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
11967 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
11968 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
11969
11970 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
11971 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
11972 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
11973 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
11974 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
11975 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
11976 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
11977 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
11978 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
11979 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
11980 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
11981 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
11982 choice for debugging.
11983
11984 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
11985 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
11986 protocol.
11987
11988 @table @emph
11989 @item On the target machine,
11990 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
11991 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
11992 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
11993 system does all the symbol handling.
11994
11995 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
11996 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
11997 syntax is:
11998
11999 @smallexample
12000 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12001 @end smallexample
12002
12003 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12004 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12005 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12006 @file{/dev/com1}:
12007
12008 @smallexample
12009 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12010 @end smallexample
12011
12012 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12013 with it.
12014
12015 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12016
12017 @smallexample
12018 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12019 @end smallexample
12020
12021 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12022 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12023 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12024 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12025 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12026 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12027 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12028 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12029 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12030 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12031 @code{target remote} command.
12032
12033 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12034 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12035
12036 @smallexample
12037 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12038 @end smallexample
12039
12040 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
12041 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
12042
12043 @pindex pidof
12044 @cindex attach to a program by name
12045 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
12046 @code{pidof} utility:
12047
12048 @smallexample
12049 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{PROGRAM}`
12050 @end smallexample
12051
12052 In case more than one copy of @var{PROGRAM} is running, or @var{PROGRAM}
12053 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
12054 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
12055
12056 @item On the host machine,
12057 connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
12058 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
12059 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
12060 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
12061 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
12062 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
12063 already on the target. However, if you want to load the symbols (as
12064 you normally would), do that with the @code{file} command, and issue
12065 it @emph{before} connecting to the server; otherwise, you will get an
12066 error message saying @code{"Program is already running"}, since the
12067 program is considered running after the connection.
12068
12069 @end table
12070
12071 @node NetWare
12072 @section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
12073
12074 @kindex gdbserve.nlm
12075 @code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
12076 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12077 @code{target remote}.
12078
12079 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
12080 using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
12081
12082 @table @emph
12083 @item On the target machine,
12084 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12085 @code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
12086 can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
12087 host system does all the symbol handling.
12088
12089 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
12090 @value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
12091 program. The syntax is:
12092
12093 @smallexample
12094 load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
12095 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12096 @end smallexample
12097
12098 @var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
12099 the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
12100 to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
12101
12102 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
12103 communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
12104 using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
12105
12106 @smallexample
12107 load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
12108 @end smallexample
12109
12110 @item
12111 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,
12112 Connecting to a remote target}).
12113
12114 @end table
12115
12116 @node Remote configuration
12117 @section Remote configuration
12118
12119 @kindex set remote
12120 @kindex show remote
12121 This section documents the configuration options available when
12122 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
12123 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{The system call,
12124 system-call-allowed}.
12125
12126 @table @code
12127 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
12128 @cindex adress size for remote targets
12129 @cindex bits in remote address
12130 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
12131 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
12132 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
12133 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
12134
12135 @item show remoteaddresssize
12136 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
12137
12138 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
12139 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
12140 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
12141 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
12142 remote targets.
12143
12144 @item show remotebaud
12145 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
12146
12147 @item set remotebreak
12148 @cindex interrupt remote programs
12149 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
12150 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
12151 when you press the @key{Ctrl-C} key to interrupt the program running
12152 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Strl-C}
12153 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
12154 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
12155
12156 @item show remotebreak
12157 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
12158 interrupt the remote program.
12159
12160 @item set remotedebug
12161 @cindex debug remote protocol
12162 @cindex remote protocol debugging
12163 @cindex display remote packets
12164 Control the debugging of the remote protocol. When enabled, each
12165 packet sent to or received from the remote target is displayed. The
12166 defaults is off.
12167
12168 @item show remotedebug
12169 Show the current setting of the remote protocol debugging.
12170
12171 @item set remotedevice @var{device}
12172 @cindex serial port name
12173 Set the name of the serial port through which to communicate to the
12174 remote target to @var{device}. This is the device used by
12175 @value{GDBN} to open the serial communications line to the remote
12176 target. There's no default, so you must set a valid port name for the
12177 remote serial communications to work. (Some varieties of the
12178 @code{target} command accept the port name as part of their
12179 arguments.)
12180
12181 @item show remotedevice
12182 Show the current name of the serial port.
12183
12184 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
12185 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
12186 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
12187 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
12188 @code{ascii}.
12189
12190 @item show remotelogbase
12191 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
12192 protocol.
12193
12194 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
12195 @cindex record serial communications on file
12196 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
12197 default is not to record at all.
12198
12199 @item show remotelogfile.
12200 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
12201 serial communications.
12202
12203 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
12204 @cindex timeout for serial communications
12205 @cindex remote timeout
12206 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
12207 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
12208
12209 @item show remotetimeout
12210 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
12211 responses.
12212
12213 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12214 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
12215 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
12216 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
12217 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
12218 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
12219 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
12220 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
12221
12222 @item set remote fetch-register-packet
12223 @itemx set remote set-register-packet
12224 @itemx set remote P-packet
12225 @itemx set remote p-packet
12226 @cindex P-packet
12227 @cindex fetch registers from remote targets
12228 @cindex set registers in remote targets
12229 Determine whether @value{GDBN} can set and fetch registers from the
12230 remote target using the @samp{P} packets. The default depends on the
12231 remote stub's support of the @samp{P} packets (@value{GDBN} queries
12232 the stub when this packet is first required).
12233
12234 @item show remote fetch-register-packet
12235 @itemx show remote set-register-packet
12236 @itemx show remote P-packet
12237 @itemx show remote p-packet
12238 Show the current setting of using the @samp{P} packets for setting and
12239 fetching registers from the remote target.
12240
12241 @cindex binary downloads
12242 @cindex X-packet
12243 @item set remote binary-download-packet
12244 @itemx set remote X-packet
12245 Determine whether @value{GDBN} sends downloads in binary mode using
12246 the @samp{X} packets. The default is on.
12247
12248 @item show remote binary-download-packet
12249 @itemx show remote X-packet
12250 Show the current setting of using the @samp{X} packets for binary
12251 downloads.
12252
12253 @item set remote read-aux-vector-packet
12254 @cindex auxiliary vector of remote target
12255 @cindex @code{auxv}, and remote targets
12256 Set the use of the remote protocol's @samp{qPart:auxv:read} (target
12257 auxiliary vector read) request. This request is used to fetch the
12258 remote target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}, see @ref{OS Information,
12259 Auxiliary Vector}. The default setting depends on the remote stub's
12260 support of this request (@value{GDBN} queries the stub when this
12261 request is first required). @xref{General Query Packets, qPart}, for
12262 more information about this request.
12263
12264 @item show remote read-aux-vector-packet
12265 Show the current setting of use of the @samp{qPart:auxv:read} request.
12266
12267 @item set remote symbol-lookup-packet
12268 @cindex remote symbol lookup request
12269 Set the use of the remote protocol's @samp{qSymbol} (target symbol
12270 lookup) request. This request is used to communicate symbol
12271 information to the remote target, e.g., whenever a new shared library
12272 is loaded by the remote (@pxref{Files, shared libraries}). The
12273 default setting depends on the remote stub's support of this request
12274 (@value{GDBN} queries the stub when this request is first required).
12275 @xref{General Query Packets, qSymbol}, for more information about this
12276 request.
12277
12278 @item show remote symbol-lookup-packet
12279 Show the current setting of use of the @samp{qSymbol} request.
12280
12281 @item set remote verbose-resume-packet
12282 @cindex resume remote target
12283 @cindex signal thread, and remote targets
12284 @cindex single-step thread, and remote targets
12285 @cindex thread-specific operations on remote targets
12286 Set the use of the remote protocol's @samp{vCont} (descriptive resume)
12287 request. This request is used to resume specific threads in the
12288 remote target, and to single-step or signal them. The default setting
12289 depends on the remote stub's support of this request (@value{GDBN}
12290 queries the stub when this request is first required). This setting
12291 affects debugging of multithreaded programs: if @samp{vCont} cannot be
12292 used, @value{GDBN} might be unable to single-step a specific thread,
12293 especially under @code{set scheduler-locking off}; it is also
12294 impossible to pause a specific thread. @xref{Packets, vCont}, for
12295 more details.
12296
12297 @item show remote verbose-resume-packet
12298 Show the current setting of use of the @samp{vCont} request
12299
12300 @item set remote software-breakpoint-packet
12301 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-packet
12302 @itemx set remote write-watchpoint-packet
12303 @itemx set remote read-watchpoint-packet
12304 @itemx set remote access-watchpoint-packet
12305 @itemx set remote Z-packet
12306 @cindex Z-packet
12307 @cindex remote hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12308 These commands enable or disable the use of @samp{Z} packets for
12309 setting breakpoints and watchpoints in the remote target. The default
12310 depends on the remote stub's support of the @samp{Z} packets
12311 (@value{GDBN} queries the stub when each packet is first required).
12312 The command @code{set remote Z-packet}, kept for back-compatibility,
12313 turns on or off all the features that require the use of @samp{Z}
12314 packets.
12315
12316 @item show remote software-breakpoint-packet
12317 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-packet
12318 @itemx show remote write-watchpoint-packet
12319 @itemx show remote read-watchpoint-packet
12320 @itemx show remote access-watchpoint-packet
12321 @itemx show remote Z-packet
12322 Show the current setting of @samp{Z} packets usage.
12323
12324 @item set remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12325 @kindex set remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12326 @cindex thread local storage of remote targets
12327 This command enables or disables the use of the @samp{qGetTLSAddr}
12328 (Get Thread Local Storage Address) request packet. The default
12329 depends on whether the remote stub supports this request.
12330 @xref{General Query Packets, qGetTLSAddr}, for more details about this
12331 packet.
12332
12333 @item show remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12334 @kindex show remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12335 Show the current setting of @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet usage.
12336 @end table
12337
12338 @node remote stub
12339 @section Implementing a remote stub
12340
12341 @cindex debugging stub, example
12342 @cindex remote stub, example
12343 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
12344 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
12345 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
12346 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
12347 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
12348 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
12349 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
12350 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
12351
12352 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
12353 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
12354 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
12355 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
12356 program, you need:
12357
12358 @enumerate
12359 @item
12360 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
12361 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
12362 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
12363
12364 @item
12365 A C subroutine library to support your program's
12366 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
12367
12368 @item
12369 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
12370 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
12371 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
12372 documentation.
12373 @end enumerate
12374
12375 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
12376 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
12377 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
12378
12379 @table @emph
12380 @item On the host,
12381 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
12382 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
12383 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
12384
12385 @item On the target,
12386 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
12387 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
12388 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
12389
12390 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
12391 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
12392 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
12393 @end table
12394
12395 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
12396 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
12397 @sc{sparc} boards.
12398
12399 @cindex remote serial stub list
12400 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
12401
12402 @table @code
12403
12404 @item i386-stub.c
12405 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
12406 @cindex Intel
12407 @cindex i386
12408 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
12409
12410 @item m68k-stub.c
12411 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
12412 @cindex Motorola 680x0
12413 @cindex m680x0
12414 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
12415
12416 @item sh-stub.c
12417 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
12418 @cindex Renesas
12419 @cindex SH
12420 For Renesas SH architectures.
12421
12422 @item sparc-stub.c
12423 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
12424 @cindex Sparc
12425 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
12426
12427 @item sparcl-stub.c
12428 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
12429 @cindex Fujitsu
12430 @cindex SparcLite
12431 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
12432
12433 @end table
12434
12435 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
12436 recently added stubs.
12437
12438 @menu
12439 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
12440 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
12441 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
12442 @end menu
12443
12444 @node Stub Contents
12445 @subsection What the stub can do for you
12446
12447 @cindex remote serial stub
12448 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
12449 subroutines:
12450
12451 @table @code
12452 @item set_debug_traps
12453 @findex set_debug_traps
12454 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
12455 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
12456 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
12457 beginning of your program.
12458
12459 @item handle_exception
12460 @findex handle_exception
12461 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
12462 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
12463 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
12464 run when a trap is triggered.
12465
12466 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
12467 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
12468 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
12469 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
12470 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
12471 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
12472 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
12473 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
12474 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
12475 machine.
12476
12477 @item breakpoint
12478 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
12479 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
12480 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
12481 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
12482 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
12483 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
12484 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
12485 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
12486 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
12487 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
12488 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
12489
12490 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
12491 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
12492 start of your debugging session.
12493 @end table
12494
12495 @node Bootstrapping
12496 @subsection What you must do for the stub
12497
12498 @cindex remote stub, support routines
12499 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
12500 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
12501 debugging target machine.
12502
12503 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
12504 serial port.
12505
12506 @table @code
12507 @item int getDebugChar()
12508 @findex getDebugChar
12509 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
12510 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
12511 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
12512
12513 @item void putDebugChar(int)
12514 @findex putDebugChar
12515 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
12516 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
12517 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
12518 @end table
12519
12520 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
12521 @cindex interrupting remote targets
12522 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
12523 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
12524 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
12525 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
12526 remote system to stop.
12527
12528 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
12529 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
12530 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
12531 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
12532
12533 Other routines you need to supply are:
12534
12535 @table @code
12536 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
12537 @findex exceptionHandler
12538 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
12539 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
12540 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
12541 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
12542 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
12543 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
12544 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
12545 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
12546 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
12547 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
12548 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
12549 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
12550 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
12551
12552 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
12553 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
12554 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
12555 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
12556 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
12557
12558 @item void flush_i_cache()
12559 @findex flush_i_cache
12560 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
12561 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
12562 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
12563
12564 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
12565 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
12566 @end table
12567
12568 @noindent
12569 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
12570
12571 @table @code
12572 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
12573 @findex memset
12574 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
12575 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
12576 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
12577 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
12578 @end table
12579
12580 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
12581 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
12582 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
12583 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
12584
12585
12586 @node Debug Session
12587 @subsection Putting it all together
12588
12589 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
12590 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
12591 steps.
12592
12593 @enumerate
12594 @item
12595 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
12596 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
12597 @display
12598 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
12599 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
12600 @end display
12601
12602 @item
12603 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
12604
12605 @smallexample
12606 set_debug_traps();
12607 breakpoint();
12608 @end smallexample
12609
12610 @item
12611 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
12612 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
12613
12614 @smallexample
12615 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
12616 @end smallexample
12617
12618 @noindent
12619 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
12620 function in your program, that function is called when
12621 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
12622 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
12623 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
12624
12625 @item
12626 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
12627 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
12628
12629 @item
12630 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
12631 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
12632
12633 @item
12634 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
12635 @c document that. FIXME.
12636 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
12637 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
12638
12639 @item
12640 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
12641 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
12642
12643 @end enumerate
12644
12645 @node Configurations
12646 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
12647
12648 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
12649 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
12650 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
12651
12652 There are three major categories of configurations: native
12653 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
12654 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
12655 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
12656 are quite different from each other.
12657
12658 @menu
12659 * Native::
12660 * Embedded OS::
12661 * Embedded Processors::
12662 * Architectures::
12663 @end menu
12664
12665 @node Native
12666 @section Native
12667
12668 This section describes details specific to particular native
12669 configurations.
12670
12671 @menu
12672 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
12673 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
12674 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
12675 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
12676 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
12677 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
12678 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
12679 @end menu
12680
12681 @node HP-UX
12682 @subsection HP-UX
12683
12684 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
12685 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
12686 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
12687
12688
12689 @node BSD libkvm Interface
12690 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
12691
12692 @cindex libkvm
12693 @cindex kernel memory image
12694 @cindex kernel crash dump
12695
12696 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
12697 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
12698 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
12699 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
12700 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
12701 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
12702 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
12703 @code{kvm} target:
12704
12705 @smallexample
12706 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
12707 @end smallexample
12708
12709 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
12710 argument:
12711
12712 @smallexample
12713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
12714 @end smallexample
12715
12716 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
12717 available:
12718
12719 @table @code
12720 @kindex kvm
12721 @item kvm pcb
12722 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
12723
12724 @item kvm proc
12725 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
12726 modern FreeBSD systems.
12727 @end table
12728
12729 @node SVR4 Process Information
12730 @subsection SVR4 process information
12731 @cindex /proc
12732 @cindex examine process image
12733 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
12734
12735 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
12736 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
12737 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
12738 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
12739 proc} is available to report information about the process running
12740 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
12741 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
12742 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
12743 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
12744
12745 @table @code
12746 @kindex info proc
12747 @cindex process ID
12748 @item info proc
12749 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
12750 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
12751 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
12752 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
12753 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
12754 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
12755 executable file's absolute file name.
12756
12757 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
12758 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
12759 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
12760 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
12761 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
12762 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
12763
12764 @item info proc mappings
12765 @cindex memory address space mappings
12766 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
12767 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
12768 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
12769 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
12770 memory access rights to that range.
12771
12772 @item info proc stat
12773 @itemx info proc status
12774 @cindex process detailed status information
12775 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
12776 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
12777 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
12778 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
12779 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
12780 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
12781 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
12782
12783 @item info proc all
12784 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
12785 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
12786
12787 @ignore
12788 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
12789 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
12790 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
12791 @kindex info proc times
12792 @item info proc times
12793 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
12794 its children.
12795
12796 @kindex info proc id
12797 @item info proc id
12798 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
12799 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
12800 @end ignore
12801
12802 @item set procfs-trace
12803 @kindex set procfs-trace
12804 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
12805 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
12806
12807 @item show procfs-trace
12808 @kindex show procfs-trace
12809 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
12810
12811 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
12812 @kindex set procfs-file
12813 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
12814 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
12815 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
12816 standard output.
12817
12818 @item show procfs-file
12819 @kindex show procfs-file
12820 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
12821
12822 @item proc-trace-entry
12823 @itemx proc-trace-exit
12824 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
12825 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
12826 @kindex proc-trace-entry
12827 @kindex proc-trace-exit
12828 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
12829 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
12830 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
12831 from the @code{syscall} interface.
12832
12833 @item info pidlist
12834 @kindex info pidlist
12835 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
12836 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
12837 processes and all the threads within each process.
12838
12839 @item info meminfo
12840 @kindex info meminfo
12841 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
12842 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
12843 @end table
12844
12845 @node DJGPP Native
12846 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
12847 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
12848 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
12849 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
12850
12851 @cindex DPMI
12852 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
12853 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
12854 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
12855 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
12856
12857 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
12858 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
12859 subsection describes those commands.
12860
12861 @table @code
12862 @kindex info dos
12863 @item info dos
12864 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
12865 information about the target system and important OS structures.
12866
12867 @kindex sysinfo
12868 @cindex MS-DOS system info
12869 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
12870 @item info dos sysinfo
12871 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
12872 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
12873 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
12874
12875 @cindex GDT
12876 @cindex LDT
12877 @cindex IDT
12878 @cindex segment descriptor tables
12879 @cindex descriptor tables display
12880 @item info dos gdt
12881 @itemx info dos ldt
12882 @itemx info dos idt
12883 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
12884 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
12885 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
12886 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
12887 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
12888 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
12889 rights.
12890
12891 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
12892 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
12893 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
12894 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
12895 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
12896
12897 @cindex garbled pointers
12898 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
12899 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
12900 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
12901 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
12902 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
12903 debugged program's data segment:
12904
12905 @smallexample
12906 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
12907 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
12908 @end smallexample
12909
12910 @noindent
12911 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
12912 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
12913
12914 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
12915 @item info dos pde
12916 @itemx info dos pte
12917 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
12918 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
12919 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
12920 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
12921 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
12922 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
12923 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
12924 that is currently in use.
12925
12926 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
12927 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
12928 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
12929 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
12930 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
12931 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
12932 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
12933
12934 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
12935 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
12936 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
12937 controller.
12938
12939 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
12940
12941 @cindex physical address from linear address
12942 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
12943 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
12944 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
12945 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
12946 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
12947 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
12948 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
12949
12950 @smallexample
12951 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
12952 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
12953 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
12954 @end smallexample
12955
12956 @noindent
12957 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
12958 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
12959 attributes of that page.
12960
12961 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
12962 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
12963 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
12964 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
12965 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
12966 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
12967
12968 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
12969 transfer buffer:
12970
12971 @smallexample
12972 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
12973 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
12974 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
12975 @end smallexample
12976
12977 @noindent
12978 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
12979 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
12980 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
12981 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
12982 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
12983
12984 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
12985 @end table
12986
12987 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
12988 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
12989 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
12990 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
12991
12992 @table @code
12993 @kindex set com1base
12994 @kindex set com1irq
12995 @kindex set com2base
12996 @kindex set com2irq
12997 @kindex set com3base
12998 @kindex set com3irq
12999 @kindex set com4base
13000 @kindex set com4irq
13001 @item set com1base @var{addr}
13002 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13003 port.
13004
13005 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
13006 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13007 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13008
13009 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13010 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13011 other 3 COM ports.
13012
13013 @kindex show com1base
13014 @kindex show com1irq
13015 @kindex show com2base
13016 @kindex show com2irq
13017 @kindex show com3base
13018 @kindex show com3irq
13019 @kindex show com4base
13020 @kindex show com4irq
13021 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13022 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13023 lines used by the COM ports.
13024
13025 @item info serial
13026 @kindex info serial
13027 @cindex DOS serial port status
13028 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13029 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13030 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13031 counts of various errors encountered so far.
13032 @end table
13033
13034
13035 @node Cygwin Native
13036 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
13037 @cindex MS Windows debugging
13038 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
13039 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13040
13041 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13042 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13043 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
13044 subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
13045 that have no debugging symbols.
13046
13047
13048 @table @code
13049 @kindex info w32
13050 @item info w32
13051 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
13052 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13053
13054 @item info w32 selector
13055 This command displays information returned by
13056 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13057 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13058 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13059 Without argument, this command displays information
13060 about the the six segment registers.
13061
13062 @kindex info dll
13063 @item info dll
13064 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
13065
13066 @kindex dll-symbols
13067 @item dll-symbols
13068 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
13069 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
13070
13071 @kindex set new-console
13072 @item set new-console @var{mode}
13073 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
13074 be started in a new console on next start.
13075 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
13076 be started in the same console as the debugger.
13077
13078 @kindex show new-console
13079 @item show new-console
13080 Displays whether a new console is used
13081 when the debuggee is started.
13082
13083 @kindex set new-group
13084 @item set new-group @var{mode}
13085 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
13086 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
13087 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
13088 Ctrl-C.
13089
13090 @kindex show new-group
13091 @item show new-group
13092 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
13093
13094 @kindex set debugevents
13095 @item set debugevents
13096 This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
13097
13098 @kindex set debugexec
13099 @item set debugexec
13100 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
13101 seen by the debugger.
13102
13103 @kindex set debugexceptions
13104 @item set debugexceptions
13105 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
13106 seen by the debugger.
13107
13108 @kindex set debugmemory
13109 @item set debugmemory
13110 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
13111 seen by the debugger.
13112
13113 @kindex set shell
13114 @item set shell
13115 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
13116 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
13117
13118 @kindex show shell
13119 @item show shell
13120 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
13121
13122 @end table
13123
13124 @menu
13125 * Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13126 @end menu
13127
13128 @node Non-debug DLL symbols
13129 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13130 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
13131 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
13132
13133 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
13134 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
13135 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
13136 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
13137 information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
13138 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
13139 ``minimal symbols''.
13140
13141 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
13142 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
13143 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
13144 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
13145 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
13146 see the shared library information in @pxref{Files} or the
13147 @code{dll-symbols} command in @pxref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
13148 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
13149 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
13150 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
13151
13152 @subsubsection DLL name prefixes
13153
13154 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
13155 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
13156 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
13157 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
13158 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
13159 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
13160 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
13161 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
13162 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
13163
13164 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
13165 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
13166 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
13167 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
13168 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} (see
13169 @pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
13170
13171 @smallexample
13172 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
13173 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
13174
13175 Non-debugging symbols:
13176 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
13177 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
13178 @end smallexample
13179
13180 @smallexample
13181 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
13182 All functions matching regular expression "!":
13183
13184 Non-debugging symbols:
13185 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
13186 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
13187 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
13188 [etc...]
13189 @end smallexample
13190
13191 @subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
13192
13193 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
13194 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
13195 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
13196 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
13197 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
13198 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
13199 a function within a DLL without a running program.
13200
13201 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
13202 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
13203 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
13204 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
13205 problem:
13206
13207 @smallexample
13208 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
13209 $1 = 268572168
13210 @end smallexample
13211
13212 @smallexample
13213 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
13214 0x10021610: "\230y\""
13215 @end smallexample
13216
13217 And two possible solutions:
13218
13219 @smallexample
13220 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
13221 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13222 @end smallexample
13223
13224 @smallexample
13225 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
13226 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
13227 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
13228 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
13229 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
13230 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13231 @end smallexample
13232
13233 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
13234 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
13235 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
13236 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
13237 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
13238
13239 @smallexample
13240 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
13241 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
13242 @end smallexample
13243
13244 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
13245 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
13246 safe.
13247
13248 @node Hurd Native
13249 @subsection Commands specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd systems
13250 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
13251
13252 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
13253 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
13254
13255 @table @code
13256 @item set signals
13257 @itemx set sigs
13258 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
13259 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13260 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
13261 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
13262 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
13263 @code{signals}.
13264
13265 @item show signals
13266 @itemx show sigs
13267 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
13268 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13269 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
13270
13271 @item set signal-thread
13272 @itemx set sigthread
13273 @kindex set signal-thread
13274 @kindex set sigthread
13275 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
13276 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
13277 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
13278 signal-thread}.
13279
13280 @item show signal-thread
13281 @itemx show sigthread
13282 @kindex show signal-thread
13283 @kindex show sigthread
13284 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
13285 delivered a signal.
13286
13287 @item set stopped
13288 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13289 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
13290 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
13291 continued by delivering a signal to it.
13292
13293 @item show stopped
13294 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13295 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
13296 stopped.
13297
13298 @item set exceptions
13299 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13300 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
13301 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
13302 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
13303 trapping on.
13304
13305 @item show exceptions
13306 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13307 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
13308
13309 @item set task pause
13310 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
13311 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13312 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13313 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
13314 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
13315 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
13316 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
13317 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
13318 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
13319
13320 @item show task pause
13321 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
13322 Show the current state of task suspension.
13323
13324 @item set task detach-suspend-count
13325 @cindex task suspend count
13326 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13327 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
13328 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
13329
13330 @item show task detach-suspend-count
13331 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
13332
13333 @item set task exception-port
13334 @itemx set task excp
13335 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13336 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
13337 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
13338 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
13339
13340 @item set noninvasive
13341 @cindex noninvasive task options
13342 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
13343 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
13344 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
13345 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
13346
13347 @item info send-rights
13348 @itemx info receive-rights
13349 @itemx info port-rights
13350 @itemx info port-sets
13351 @itemx info dead-names
13352 @itemx info ports
13353 @itemx info psets
13354 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13355 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13356 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13357 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13358 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13359 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
13360 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
13361 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
13362 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
13363
13364 @item set thread pause
13365 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
13366 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13367 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13368 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
13369 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
13370 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
13371 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
13372 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
13373 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
13374 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
13375 only the current thread.
13376
13377 @item show thread pause
13378 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
13379 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
13380
13381 @item set thread run
13382 This comamnd sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13383
13384 @item show thread run
13385 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13386
13387 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
13388 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13389 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13390 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
13391 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
13392 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
13393 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
13394
13395 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
13396 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
13397 detaching.
13398
13399 @item set thread exception-port
13400 @itemx set thread excp
13401 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
13402 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
13403 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
13404
13405 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
13406 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
13407 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
13408 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
13409
13410 @item set thread default
13411 @itemx show thread default
13412 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13413 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
13414 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
13415 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
13416 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
13417 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
13418 the non-default commands.
13419 @end table
13420
13421
13422 @node Neutrino
13423 @subsection QNX Neutrino
13424 @cindex QNX Neutrino
13425
13426 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
13427 Neutrino target:
13428
13429 @table @code
13430 @item set debug nto-debug
13431 @kindex set debug nto-debug
13432 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
13433 Neutrino support.
13434
13435 @item show debug nto-debug
13436 @kindex show debug nto-debug
13437 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
13438 @end table
13439
13440
13441 @node Embedded OS
13442 @section Embedded Operating Systems
13443
13444 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
13445 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
13446 architectures.
13447
13448 @menu
13449 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
13450 @end menu
13451
13452 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
13453 various real-time operating systems.
13454
13455 @node VxWorks
13456 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
13457
13458 @cindex VxWorks
13459
13460 @table @code
13461
13462 @kindex target vxworks
13463 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
13464 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
13465 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
13466
13467 @end table
13468
13469 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
13470 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
13471
13472 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
13473 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
13474 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
13475 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
13476 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
13477 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
13478 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
13479
13480 @table @code
13481 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
13482 @kindex vxworks-timeout
13483 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
13484 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
13485 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
13486 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
13487 of a thin network line.
13488 @end table
13489
13490 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
13491 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
13492 procedures.
13493
13494 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
13495 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
13496 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
13497 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
13498 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
13499 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
13500 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
13501 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
13502 manual.
13503 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
13504
13505 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
13506 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
13507 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
13508 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
13509
13510 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
13511
13512 @smallexample
13513 (vxgdb)
13514 @end smallexample
13515
13516 @menu
13517 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
13518 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
13519 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
13520 @end menu
13521
13522 @node VxWorks Connection
13523 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
13524
13525 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
13526 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
13527
13528 @smallexample
13529 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
13530 @end smallexample
13531
13532 @need 750
13533 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
13534
13535 @smallexample
13536 Attaching remote machine across net...
13537 Connected to tt.
13538 @end smallexample
13539
13540 @need 1000
13541 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
13542 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
13543 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
13544 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
13545 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
13546
13547 @smallexample
13548 prog.o: No such file or directory.
13549 @end smallexample
13550
13551 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
13552 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
13553 command again.
13554
13555 @node VxWorks Download
13556 @subsubsection VxWorks download
13557
13558 @cindex download to VxWorks
13559 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
13560 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
13561 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
13562 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
13563 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
13564 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
13565 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
13566 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
13567 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
13568 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
13569 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
13570 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
13571 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
13572 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
13573 program, type this on VxWorks:
13574
13575 @smallexample
13576 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
13577 @end smallexample
13578
13579 @noindent
13580 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
13581
13582 @smallexample
13583 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
13584 (vxgdb) load prog.o
13585 @end smallexample
13586
13587 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
13588
13589 @smallexample
13590 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
13591 @end smallexample
13592
13593 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
13594 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
13595 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
13596 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
13597 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
13598 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
13599 table.)
13600
13601 @node VxWorks Attach
13602 @subsubsection Running tasks
13603
13604 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
13605 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
13606 follows:
13607
13608 @smallexample
13609 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
13610 @end smallexample
13611
13612 @noindent
13613 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
13614 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
13615 the time of attachment.
13616
13617 @node Embedded Processors
13618 @section Embedded Processors
13619
13620 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
13621 configurations.
13622
13623 @cindex send command to simulator
13624 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
13625 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
13626
13627 @table @code
13628 @item sim @var{command}
13629 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
13630 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
13631 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
13632 acceptable commands.
13633 @end table
13634
13635
13636 @menu
13637 * ARM:: ARM RDI
13638 * H8/300:: Renesas H8/300
13639 * H8/500:: Renesas H8/500
13640 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
13641 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
13642 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
13643 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
13644 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
13645 * PowerPC: PowerPC
13646 * SH:: Renesas SH
13647 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
13648 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
13649 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
13650 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
13651 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
13652 * CRIS:: CRIS
13653 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
13654 * WinCE:: Windows CE child processes
13655 @end menu
13656
13657 @node ARM
13658 @subsection ARM
13659 @cindex ARM RDI
13660
13661 @table @code
13662 @kindex target rdi
13663 @item target rdi @var{dev}
13664 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
13665 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
13666 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
13667
13668 @kindex target rdp
13669 @item target rdp @var{dev}
13670 ARM Demon monitor.
13671
13672 @end table
13673
13674 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
13675
13676 @table @code
13677 @item set arm disassembler
13678 @kindex set arm
13679 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
13680 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
13681
13682 @item show arm disassembler
13683 @kindex show arm
13684 Show the current disassembly style.
13685
13686 @item set arm apcs32
13687 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
13688 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
13689
13690 @item show arm apcs32
13691 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
13692
13693 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
13694 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
13695 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
13696
13697 @table @code
13698 @item auto
13699 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
13700 @item softfpa
13701 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
13702 processors.
13703 @item fpa
13704 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
13705 @item softvfp
13706 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
13707 @item vfp
13708 VFP co-processor.
13709 @end table
13710
13711 @item show arm fpu
13712 Show the current type of the FPU.
13713
13714 @item set arm abi
13715 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
13716
13717 @item show arm abi
13718 Show the currently used ABI.
13719
13720 @item set debug arm
13721 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
13722 target support subsystem.
13723
13724 @item show debug arm
13725 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
13726 @end table
13727
13728 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
13729 using the RDI interface:
13730
13731 @table @code
13732 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
13733 @kindex rdilogfile
13734 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
13735 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
13736 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
13737 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
13738 @file{rdi.log}.
13739
13740 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
13741 @kindex rdilogenable
13742 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
13743 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
13744 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
13745 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
13746 are logged to a file.
13747
13748 @item set rdiromatzero
13749 @kindex set rdiromatzero
13750 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
13751 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
13752 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
13753 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
13754 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
13755
13756 @item show rdiromatzero
13757 @kindex show rdiromatzero
13758 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
13759
13760 @item set rdiheartbeat
13761 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
13762 @cindex RDI heartbeat
13763 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
13764 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
13765 well as the Angel monitor.
13766
13767 @item show rdiheartbeat
13768 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
13769 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
13770 @end table
13771
13772
13773 @node H8/300
13774 @subsection Renesas H8/300
13775
13776 @table @code
13777
13778 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
13779 @item target hms @var{dev}
13780 A Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
13781 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
13782 line and the communications speed used.
13783
13784 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
13785 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
13786 E7000 emulator for Renesas H8 and SH.
13787
13788 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
13789 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
13790 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
13791 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
13792 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
13793
13794 @end table
13795
13796 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
13797 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
13798 @cindex download to Renesas SH
13799 @cindex Renesas SH download
13800 When you select remote debugging to a Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500
13801 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Renesas
13802 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
13803 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
13804
13805 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
13806 Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
13807
13808 @enumerate
13809 @item
13810 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
13811 for Renesas microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
13812 emulator for the Renesas SH and the Renesas 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
13813 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Renesas SH,
13814 H8/300, or H8/500.)
13815
13816 @item
13817 what serial device connects your host to your Renesas board (the first
13818 serial device available on your host is the default).
13819
13820 @item
13821 what speed to use over the serial device.
13822 @end enumerate
13823
13824 @menu
13825 * Renesas Boards:: Connecting to Renesas boards.
13826 * Renesas ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
13827 * Renesas Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros.
13828 @end menu
13829
13830 @node Renesas Boards
13831 @subsubsection Connecting to Renesas boards
13832
13833 @c only for Unix hosts
13834 @kindex device
13835 @cindex serial device, Renesas micros
13836 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
13837 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
13838 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
13839 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
13840
13841 @kindex speed
13842 @cindex serial line speed, Renesas micros
13843 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
13844 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
13845 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
13846 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
13847 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
13848
13849 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
13850 use a Unix host to debug your Renesas microprocessor programs. If you
13851 use a DOS host,
13852 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
13853 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
13854 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
13855 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
13856
13857 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
13858 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
13859 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
13860 the Renesas SH and the H8/500.
13861
13862 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
13863 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
13864 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
13865 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
13866 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
13867 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
13868 @code{COM2}.
13869
13870 @smallexample
13871 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
13872 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
13873
13874 Resident portion of MODE loaded
13875
13876 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
13877
13878 @end smallexample
13879
13880 @quotation
13881 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
13882 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
13883 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
13884 your development board.
13885 @end quotation
13886
13887 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
13888 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
13889 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBN}} with
13890 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
13891 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
13892 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
13893 cross-debugging to the Renesas board, and the @code{load} command to
13894 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
13895 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
13896 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
13897 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
13898 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
13899 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
13900
13901 @smallexample
13902 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
13903 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
13904 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
13905 the conditions.
13906 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
13907 for details.
13908 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
13909 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
13910 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
13911 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
13912 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
13913 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
13914 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
13915 @end smallexample
13916
13917 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
13918 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
13919 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
13920 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
13921 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
13922 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
13923
13924 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
13925 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
13926 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
13927
13928 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
13929 @itemize @bullet
13930 @item
13931 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
13932 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
13933
13934 @item
13935 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
13936 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
13937 to detect program completion.
13938 @end itemize
13939
13940 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
13941 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
13942
13943 @node Renesas ICE
13944 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
13945
13946 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas ICE}
13947 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
13948 Renesas SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
13949 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
13950
13951 @table @code
13952 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
13953 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
13954 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
13955 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
13956 (for example, @samp{9600}).
13957
13958 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
13959 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
13960 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
13961 @end table
13962
13963 The following special commands are available when debugging with the
13964 Renesas E7000 ICE:
13965
13966 @table @code
13967 @item e7000 @var{command}
13968 @kindex e7000
13969 @cindex send command to E7000 monitor
13970 This sends the specified @var{command} to the E7000 monitor.
13971
13972 @item ftplogin @var{machine} @var{username} @var{password} @var{dir}
13973 @kindex ftplogin@r{, E7000}
13974 This command records information for subsequent interface with the
13975 E7000 monitor via the FTP protocol: @value{GDBN} will log into the
13976 named @var{machine} using specified @var{username} and @var{password},
13977 and then chdir to the named directory @var{dir}.
13978
13979 @item ftpload @var{file}
13980 @kindex ftpload@r{, E7000}
13981 This command uses credentials recorded by @code{ftplogin} to fetch and
13982 load the named @var{file} from the E7000 monitor.
13983
13984 @item drain
13985 @kindex drain@r{, E7000}
13986 This command drains any pending text buffers stored on the E7000.
13987
13988 @item set usehardbreakpoints
13989 @itemx show usehardbreakpoints
13990 @kindex set usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
13991 @kindex show usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
13992 @cindex hardware breakpoints, and E7000
13993 These commands set and show the use of hardware breakpoints for all
13994 breakpoints. @xref{Set Breaks, hardware-assisted breakpoint}, for
13995 more information about using hardware breakpoints selectively.
13996 @end table
13997
13998 @node Renesas Special
13999 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros
14000
14001 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
14002
14003 @table @code
14004
14005 @kindex set machine
14006 @kindex show machine
14007 @item set machine h8300
14008 @itemx set machine h8300h
14009 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
14010 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
14011 to check which variant is currently in effect.
14012
14013 @end table
14014
14015 @node H8/500
14016 @subsection H8/500
14017
14018 @table @code
14019
14020 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
14021 @cindex memory models, H8/500
14022 @item set memory @var{mod}
14023 @itemx show memory
14024 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
14025 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
14026 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
14027 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
14028
14029 @end table
14030
14031 @node M32R/D
14032 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14033
14034 @table @code
14035 @kindex target m32r
14036 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14037 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14038
14039 @kindex target m32rsdi
14040 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14041 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14042 @end table
14043
14044 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14045
14046 @table @code
14047 @item set download-path @var{path}
14048 @kindex set download-path
14049 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14050 Set the default path for finding donwloadable @sc{srec} files.
14051
14052 @item show download-path
14053 @kindex show download-path
14054 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14055
14056 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14057 @kindex set board-address
14058 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14059 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14060
14061 @item show board-address
14062 @kindex show board-address
14063 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14064
14065 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14066 @kindex set server-address
14067 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14068 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14069 host machine.
14070
14071 @item show server-address
14072 @kindex show server-address
14073 Display the IP address of the download server.
14074
14075 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14076 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14077 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14078 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14079 executable file is uploaded.
14080
14081 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14082 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14083 Test the @code{upload} command.
14084 @end table
14085
14086 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14087
14088 @table @code
14089 @item sdireset
14090 @kindex sdireset
14091 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14092 This command resets the SDI connection.
14093
14094 @item sdistatus
14095 @kindex sdistatus
14096 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14097
14098 @item debug_chaos
14099 @kindex debug_chaos
14100 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14101 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14102
14103 @item use_debug_dma
14104 @kindex use_debug_dma
14105 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14106
14107 @item use_mon_code
14108 @kindex use_mon_code
14109 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14110
14111 @item use_ib_break
14112 @kindex use_ib_break
14113 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14114
14115 @item use_dbt_break
14116 @kindex use_dbt_break
14117 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14118 @end table
14119
14120 @node M68K
14121 @subsection M68k
14122
14123 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
14124 target command for the following ROM monitors.
14125
14126 @table @code
14127
14128 @kindex target abug
14129 @item target abug @var{dev}
14130 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
14131
14132 @kindex target cpu32bug
14133 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
14134 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14135
14136 @kindex target dbug
14137 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14138 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14139
14140 @kindex target est
14141 @item target est @var{dev}
14142 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14143
14144 @kindex target rom68k
14145 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
14146 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
14147
14148 @end table
14149
14150 @table @code
14151
14152 @kindex target rombug
14153 @item target rombug @var{dev}
14154 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
14155
14156 @end table
14157
14158 @node MIPS Embedded
14159 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14160
14161 @cindex MIPS boards
14162 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14163 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14164 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14165
14166 @need 1000
14167 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14168
14169 @table @code
14170 @item target mips @var{port}
14171 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14172 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14173 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14174 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14175 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14176 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14177 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14178
14179 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14180 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14181 debugger:
14182
14183 @smallexample
14184 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14185 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14186 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14187 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14188 (@value{GDBP}) run
14189 @end smallexample
14190
14191 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14192 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14193 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14194 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14195 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14196
14197 @item target pmon @var{port}
14198 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14199 PMON ROM monitor.
14200
14201 @item target ddb @var{port}
14202 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14203 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14204
14205 @item target lsi @var{port}
14206 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14207 LSI variant of PMON.
14208
14209 @kindex target r3900
14210 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14211 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14212
14213 @kindex target array
14214 @item target array @var{dev}
14215 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14216
14217 @end table
14218
14219
14220 @noindent
14221 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14222
14223 @table @code
14224 @item set mipsfpu double
14225 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14226 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14227 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14228 @itemx show mipsfpu
14229 @kindex set mipsfpu
14230 @kindex show mipsfpu
14231 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14232 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14233 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14234 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14235 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14236 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14237 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14238 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14239 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14240 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14241 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14242 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14243 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14244
14245 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14246 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14247 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14248
14249 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14250 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
14251
14252 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
14253 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14254 @itemx show timeout
14255 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
14256 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14257 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14258 @kindex set timeout
14259 @kindex show timeout
14260 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
14261 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
14262 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14263 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14264 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14265 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14266 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14267 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14268 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14269 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14270
14271 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14272 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14273 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14274 to run before stopping.
14275
14276 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14277 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14278 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14279 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14280 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14281 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14282
14283 @item show syn-garbage-limit
14284 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14285 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14286 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14287
14288 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14289 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14290 @cindex remote monitor prompt
14291 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14292 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14293 @table @asis
14294 @item pmon target
14295 @samp{PMON}
14296 @item ddb target
14297 @samp{NEC010}
14298 @item lsi target
14299 @samp{PMON>}
14300 @end table
14301
14302 @item show monitor-prompt
14303 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14304 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14305 remote monitor.
14306
14307 @item set monitor-warnings
14308 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14309 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14310 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14311 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14312 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14313
14314 @item show monitor-warnings
14315 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14316 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14317
14318 @item pmon @var{command}
14319 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14320 @cindex send PMON command
14321 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14322 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14323 @end table
14324
14325 @node OpenRISC 1000
14326 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
14327 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
14328
14329 @cindex or1k boards
14330 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
14331 about platform and commands.
14332
14333 @table @code
14334
14335 @kindex target jtag
14336 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
14337
14338 Connects to remote JTAG server.
14339 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
14340 connected via parallel port to the board.
14341
14342 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
14343
14344 @kindex or1ksim
14345 @item or1ksim @var{command}
14346 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
14347 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
14348
14349 @kindex info or1k spr
14350 @item info or1k spr
14351 Displays spr groups.
14352
14353 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
14354 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
14355 Displays register names in selected group.
14356
14357 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
14358 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
14359 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
14360 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
14361 Shows information about specified spr register.
14362
14363 @kindex spr
14364 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
14365 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
14366 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
14367 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
14368 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
14369 @end table
14370
14371 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
14372 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
14373 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
14374 triggers can be set using:
14375 @table @code
14376 @item $LEA/$LDATA
14377 Load effective address/data
14378 @item $SEA/$SDATA
14379 Store effective address/data
14380 @item $AEA/$ADATA
14381 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
14382 @item $FETCH
14383 Fetch data
14384 @end table
14385
14386 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
14387 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
14388
14389 @code{htrace} commands:
14390 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
14391 @table @code
14392 @kindex hwatch
14393 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
14394 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
14395 or Data. For example:
14396
14397 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14398
14399 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14400
14401 @kindex htrace
14402 @item htrace info
14403 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
14404
14405 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
14406 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
14407
14408 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
14409 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
14410
14411 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
14412 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
14413
14414 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
14415 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
14416 triggered.
14417
14418 @item htrace enable
14419 @itemx htrace disable
14420 Enables/disables the HW trace.
14421
14422 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
14423 Clears currently recorded trace data.
14424
14425 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
14426 will be written there.
14427
14428 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
14429 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
14430
14431 @item htrace mode continuous
14432 Set continuous trace mode.
14433
14434 @item htrace mode suspend
14435 Set suspend trace mode.
14436
14437 @end table
14438
14439 @node PowerPC
14440 @subsection PowerPC
14441
14442 @table @code
14443 @kindex target dink32
14444 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
14445 DINK32 ROM monitor.
14446
14447 @kindex target ppcbug
14448 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
14449 @kindex target ppcbug1
14450 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
14451 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
14452
14453 @kindex target sds
14454 @item target sds @var{dev}
14455 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
14456 @end table
14457
14458 @cindex SDS protocol
14459 The following commands specifi to the SDS protocol are supported
14460 by@value{GDBN}:
14461
14462 @table @code
14463 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
14464 @kindex set sdstimeout
14465 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
14466 default is 2 seconds.
14467
14468 @item show sdstimeout
14469 @kindex show sdstimeout
14470 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
14471
14472 @item sds @var{command}
14473 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
14474 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
14475 @end table
14476
14477
14478 @node PA
14479 @subsection HP PA Embedded
14480
14481 @table @code
14482
14483 @kindex target op50n
14484 @item target op50n @var{dev}
14485 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
14486
14487 @kindex target w89k
14488 @item target w89k @var{dev}
14489 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
14490
14491 @end table
14492
14493 @node SH
14494 @subsection Renesas SH
14495
14496 @table @code
14497
14498 @kindex target hms@r{, with Renesas SH}
14499 @item target hms @var{dev}
14500 A Renesas SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
14501 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
14502 the communications speed used.
14503
14504 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas SH}
14505 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
14506 E7000 emulator for Renesas SH.
14507
14508 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
14509 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
14510 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
14511 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
14512 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
14513
14514 @end table
14515
14516 @node Sparclet
14517 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
14518
14519 @cindex Sparclet
14520
14521 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
14522 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
14523 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14524 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
14525 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
14526
14527 @table @code
14528 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
14529 @kindex remotetimeout
14530 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
14531 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14532 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
14533 @end table
14534
14535 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
14536 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
14537 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
14538 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
14539 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
14540
14541 @smallexample
14542 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
14543 @end smallexample
14544
14545 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
14546
14547 @smallexample
14548 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
14549 @end smallexample
14550
14551 @cindex running, on Sparclet
14552 Once you have set
14553 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14554 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
14555 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
14556
14557 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14558
14559 @smallexample
14560 (gdbslet)
14561 @end smallexample
14562
14563 @menu
14564 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
14565 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
14566 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
14567 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
14568 @end menu
14569
14570 @node Sparclet File
14571 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
14572
14573 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
14574
14575 @smallexample
14576 (gdbslet) file prog
14577 @end smallexample
14578
14579 @need 1000
14580 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
14581 @value{GDBN} locates
14582 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
14583 path.
14584 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
14585 files will be searched as well.
14586 @value{GDBN} locates
14587 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
14588 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
14589 If it fails
14590 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
14591
14592 @smallexample
14593 prog: No such file or directory.
14594 @end smallexample
14595
14596 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
14597 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
14598 @code{target} command again.
14599
14600 @node Sparclet Connection
14601 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
14602
14603 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
14604 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
14605
14606 @smallexample
14607 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
14608 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
14609 main () at ../prog.c:3
14610 @end smallexample
14611
14612 @need 750
14613 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14614
14615 @smallexample
14616 Connected to ttya.
14617 @end smallexample
14618
14619 @node Sparclet Download
14620 @subsubsection Sparclet download
14621
14622 @cindex download to Sparclet
14623 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
14624 you can use the @value{GDBN}
14625 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
14626 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
14627 command.
14628 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
14629 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
14630 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
14631 of each of the file's sections.
14632 For instance, if the program
14633 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
14634 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14635
14636 @smallexample
14637 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
14638 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
14639 @end smallexample
14640
14641 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
14642 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
14643 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
14644
14645 @node Sparclet Execution
14646 @subsubsection Running and debugging
14647
14648 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
14649 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
14650 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
14651 manual for the list of commands.
14652
14653 @smallexample
14654 (gdbslet) b main
14655 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
14656 (gdbslet) run
14657 Starting program: prog
14658 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
14659 3 char *symarg = 0;
14660 (gdbslet) step
14661 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
14662 (gdbslet)
14663 @end smallexample
14664
14665 @node Sparclite
14666 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
14667
14668 @table @code
14669
14670 @kindex target sparclite
14671 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
14672 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
14673 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
14674 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
14675 remote protocol.
14676
14677 @end table
14678
14679 @node ST2000
14680 @subsection Tandem ST2000
14681
14682 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
14683 STDBUG protocol.
14684
14685 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
14686 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
14687
14688 @smallexample
14689 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
14690 @end smallexample
14691
14692 @noindent
14693 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
14694 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
14695 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
14696 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
14697 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14698
14699 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
14700 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
14701 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
14702 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
14703 available on your host computer.
14704 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
14705 @c basically hearsay.
14706
14707 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
14708 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
14709 environment:
14710
14711 @table @code
14712 @item st2000 @var{command}
14713 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
14714 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
14715 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
14716 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
14717 manual for available commands.
14718
14719 @item connect
14720 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
14721 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
14722 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
14723 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
14724 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
14725 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
14726 @end table
14727
14728 @node Z8000
14729 @subsection Zilog Z8000
14730
14731 @cindex Z8000
14732 @cindex simulator, Z8000
14733 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
14734
14735 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
14736 a Z8000 simulator.
14737
14738 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
14739 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
14740 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
14741 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
14742
14743 @table @code
14744 @item target sim @var{args}
14745 @kindex sim
14746 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
14747 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
14748 options, specify them via @var{args}.
14749 @end table
14750
14751 @noindent
14752 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
14753 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
14754 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
14755 to run your program, and so on.
14756
14757 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
14758 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
14759 additional items of information as specially named registers:
14760
14761 @table @code
14762
14763 @item cycles
14764 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
14765
14766 @item insts
14767 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
14768
14769 @item time
14770 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
14771
14772 @end table
14773
14774 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
14775 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
14776 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
14777 simulated clock ticks.
14778
14779 @node AVR
14780 @subsection Atmel AVR
14781 @cindex AVR
14782
14783 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
14784 following AVR-specific commands:
14785
14786 @table @code
14787 @item info io_registers
14788 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
14789 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
14790 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
14791 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
14792 @end table
14793
14794 @node CRIS
14795 @subsection CRIS
14796 @cindex CRIS
14797
14798 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
14799 following CRIS-specific commands:
14800
14801 @table @code
14802 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
14803 @cindex CRIS version
14804 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
14805 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
14806 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
14807
14808 @item show cris-version
14809 Show the current CRIS version.
14810
14811 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
14812 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
14813 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
14814 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
14815 @code{R59}.
14816
14817 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
14818 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
14819
14820 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
14821 @cindex CRIS mode
14822 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
14823 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
14824 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
14825
14826 @item show cris-mode
14827 Show the current CRIS mode.
14828 @end table
14829
14830 @node Super-H
14831 @subsection Renesas Super-H
14832 @cindex Super-H
14833
14834 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
14835 commands:
14836
14837 @table @code
14838 @item regs
14839 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
14840 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
14841 @end table
14842
14843 @node WinCE
14844 @subsection Windows CE
14845 @cindex Windows CE
14846
14847 The following commands are available for Windows CE:
14848
14849 @table @code
14850 @item set remotedirectory @var{dir}
14851 @kindex set remotedirectory
14852 Tell @value{GDBN} to upload files from the named directory @var{dir}.
14853 The default is @file{/gdb}, i.e.@: the root directory on the current
14854 drive.
14855
14856 @item show remotedirectory
14857 @kindex show remotedirectory
14858 Show the current value of the upload directory.
14859
14860 @item set remoteupload @var{method}
14861 @kindex set remoteupload
14862 Set the method used to upload files to remote device. Valid values
14863 for @var{method} are @samp{always}, @samp{newer}, and @samp{never}.
14864 The default is @samp{newer}.
14865
14866 @item show remoteupload
14867 @kindex show remoteupload
14868 Show the current setting of the upload method.
14869
14870 @item set remoteaddhost
14871 @kindex set remoteaddhost
14872 Tell @value{GDBN} whether to add this host to the remote stub's
14873 arguments when you debug over a network.
14874
14875 @item show remoteaddhost
14876 @kindex show remoteaddhost
14877 Show whether to add this host to remote stub's arguments when
14878 debugging over a network.
14879 @end table
14880
14881
14882 @node Architectures
14883 @section Architectures
14884
14885 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
14886 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
14887
14888 @menu
14889 * i386::
14890 * A29K::
14891 * Alpha::
14892 * MIPS::
14893 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
14894 @end menu
14895
14896 @node i386
14897 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific issues.
14898
14899 @table @code
14900 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
14901 @kindex set struct-convention
14902 @cindex struct return convention
14903 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
14904 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
14905 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
14906 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
14907 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
14908 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
14909 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
14910 be returned in a register.
14911
14912 @item show struct-convention
14913 @kindex show struct-convention
14914 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
14915 from functions.
14916 @end table
14917
14918 @node A29K
14919 @subsection A29K
14920
14921 @table @code
14922
14923 @kindex set rstack_high_address
14924 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
14925 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
14926 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
14927 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
14928 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
14929 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
14930 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
14931 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
14932 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
14933 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
14934 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
14935 hexadecimal.
14936
14937 @kindex show rstack_high_address
14938 @item show rstack_high_address
14939 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
14940 processors.
14941
14942 @end table
14943
14944 @node Alpha
14945 @subsection Alpha
14946
14947 See the following section.
14948
14949 @node MIPS
14950 @subsection MIPS
14951
14952 @cindex stack on Alpha
14953 @cindex stack on MIPS
14954 @cindex Alpha stack
14955 @cindex MIPS stack
14956 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
14957 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
14958 find the beginning of a function.
14959
14960 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
14961 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
14962 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
14963 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
14964 commands:
14965
14966 @table @code
14967 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
14968 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
14969 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
14970 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
14971 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
14972 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
14973 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
14974 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
14975
14976 @item show heuristic-fence-post
14977 Display the current limit.
14978 @end table
14979
14980 @noindent
14981 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
14982 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
14983
14984 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
14985 programs:
14986
14987 @table @code
14988 @item set mips saved-gpreg-size @var{size}
14989 @kindex set mips saved-gpreg-size
14990 @cindex MIPS GP register size on stack
14991 Set the size of MIPS general-purpose registers saved on the stack.
14992 The argument @var{size} can be one of the following:
14993
14994 @table @samp
14995 @item 32
14996 32-bit GP registers
14997 @item 64
14998 64-bit GP registers
14999 @item auto
15000 Use the target's default setting or autodetect the saved size from the
15001 information contained in the executable. This is the default
15002 @end table
15003
15004 @item show mips saved-gpreg-size
15005 @kindex show mips saved-gpreg-size
15006 Show the current size of MIPS GP registers on the stack.
15007
15008 @item set mips stack-arg-size @var{size}
15009 @kindex set mips stack-arg-size
15010 @cindex MIPS stack space for arguments
15011 Set the amount of stack space reserved for arguments to functions.
15012 The argument can be one of @code{"32"}, @code{"64"} or @code{"auto"}
15013 (the default).
15014
15015 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15016 @kindex set mips abi
15017 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15018 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15019 values of @var{arg} are:
15020
15021 @table @samp
15022 @item auto
15023 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15024 default).
15025 @item o32
15026 @item o64
15027 @item n32
15028 @item n64
15029 @item eabi32
15030 @item eabi64
15031 @item auto
15032 @end table
15033
15034 @item show mips abi
15035 @kindex show mips abi
15036 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15037
15038 @item set mipsfpu
15039 @itemx show mipsfpu
15040 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15041
15042 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15043 @kindex set mips mask-address
15044 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15045 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15046 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15047 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15048 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15049
15050 @item show mips mask-address
15051 @kindex show mips mask-address
15052 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15053 not.
15054
15055 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15056 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15057 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15058 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15059 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15060 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15061
15062 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15063 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15064 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15065
15066 @item set debug mips
15067 @kindex set debug mips
15068 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15069 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15070
15071 @item show debug mips
15072 @kindex show debug mips
15073 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15074 @end table
15075
15076
15077 @node HPPA
15078 @subsection HPPA
15079 @cindex HPPA support
15080
15081 When @value{GDBN} is debugging te HP PA architecture, it provides the
15082 following special commands:
15083
15084 @table @code
15085 @item set debug hppa
15086 @kindex set debug hppa
15087 THis command determines whether HPPA architecture specific debugging
15088 messages are to be displayed.
15089
15090 @item show debug hppa
15091 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15092
15093 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15094 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15095 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15096 given @var{address}.
15097
15098 @end table
15099
15100
15101 @node Controlling GDB
15102 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15103
15104 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15105 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15106 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
15107 described here.
15108
15109 @menu
15110 * Prompt:: Prompt
15111 * Editing:: Command editing
15112 * Command History:: Command history
15113 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15114 * Numbers:: Numbers
15115 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15116 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15117 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15118 @end menu
15119
15120 @node Prompt
15121 @section Prompt
15122
15123 @cindex prompt
15124
15125 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15126 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15127 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15128 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15129 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15130 which one you are talking to.
15131
15132 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15133 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15134 or a prompt that does not.
15135
15136 @table @code
15137 @kindex set prompt
15138 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15139 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15140
15141 @kindex show prompt
15142 @item show prompt
15143 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15144 @end table
15145
15146 @node Editing
15147 @section Command editing
15148 @cindex readline
15149 @cindex command line editing
15150
15151 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15152 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15153 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15154 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15155 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15156 debugging sessions.
15157
15158 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15159 command @code{set}.
15160
15161 @table @code
15162 @kindex set editing
15163 @cindex editing
15164 @item set editing
15165 @itemx set editing on
15166 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15167
15168 @item set editing off
15169 Disable command line editing.
15170
15171 @kindex show editing
15172 @item show editing
15173 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15174 @end table
15175
15176 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15177 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15178 encouraged to read that chapter.
15179
15180 @node Command History
15181 @section Command history
15182 @cindex command history
15183
15184 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15185 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15186 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15187 history facility.
15188
15189 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15190 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15191 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15192
15193 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15194 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
15195 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15196 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15197 pressed on a line by itself.
15198
15199 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15200 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15201 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15202 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15203
15204 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15205 history.
15206
15207 @table @code
15208 @cindex history substitution
15209 @cindex history file
15210 @kindex set history filename
15211 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15212 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15213 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15214 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15215 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15216 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15217 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15218 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15219 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15220 is not set.
15221
15222 @cindex save command history
15223 @kindex set history save
15224 @item set history save
15225 @itemx set history save on
15226 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15227 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15228
15229 @item set history save off
15230 Stop recording command history in a file.
15231
15232 @cindex history size
15233 @kindex set history size
15234 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15235 @item set history size @var{size}
15236 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15237 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15238 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15239 @end table
15240
15241 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15242 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15243
15244 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15245 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15246 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15247 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15248 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15249 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15250 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15251 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15252
15253 The commands to control history expansion are:
15254
15255 @table @code
15256 @item set history expansion on
15257 @itemx set history expansion
15258 @kindex set history expansion
15259 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15260
15261 @item set history expansion off
15262 Disable history expansion.
15263
15264 @c @group
15265 @kindex show history
15266 @item show history
15267 @itemx show history filename
15268 @itemx show history save
15269 @itemx show history size
15270 @itemx show history expansion
15271 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15272 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15273 @c @end group
15274 @end table
15275
15276 @table @code
15277 @kindex show commands
15278 @cindex show last commands
15279 @cindex display command history
15280 @item show commands
15281 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15282
15283 @item show commands @var{n}
15284 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15285
15286 @item show commands +
15287 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15288 @end table
15289
15290 @node Screen Size
15291 @section Screen size
15292 @cindex size of screen
15293 @cindex pauses in output
15294
15295 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15296 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15297 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15298 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15299 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15300 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15301 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15302 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15303
15304 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15305 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15306 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15307 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15308 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15309 width} commands:
15310
15311 @table @code
15312 @kindex set height
15313 @kindex set width
15314 @kindex show width
15315 @kindex show height
15316 @item set height @var{lpp}
15317 @itemx show height
15318 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15319 @itemx show width
15320 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15321 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15322 commands display the current settings.
15323
15324 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15325 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15326 file or to an editor buffer.
15327
15328 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15329 from wrapping its output.
15330
15331 @item set pagination on
15332 @itemx set pagination off
15333 @kindex set pagination
15334 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15335 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15336
15337 @item show pagination
15338 @kindex show pagination
15339 Show the current pagination mode.
15340 @end table
15341
15342 @node Numbers
15343 @section Numbers
15344 @cindex number representation
15345 @cindex entering numbers
15346
15347 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15348 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15349 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15350 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15351 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
15352 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15353 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15354 both input and output with the commands described below.
15355
15356 @table @code
15357 @kindex set input-radix
15358 @item set input-radix @var{base}
15359 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15360 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15361 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15362 example, any of
15363
15364 @smallexample
15365 set input-radix 012
15366 set input-radix 10.
15367 set input-radix 0xa
15368 @end smallexample
15369
15370 @noindent
15371 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15372 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15373 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15374 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15375 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15376 change the radix.
15377
15378 @kindex set output-radix
15379 @item set output-radix @var{base}
15380 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15381 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15382 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
15383
15384 @kindex show input-radix
15385 @item show input-radix
15386 Display the current default base for numeric input.
15387
15388 @kindex show output-radix
15389 @item show output-radix
15390 Display the current default base for numeric display.
15391
15392 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
15393 @itemx show radix
15394 @kindex set radix
15395 @kindex show radix
15396 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
15397 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
15398 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
15399 default value of 10.
15400
15401 @end table
15402
15403 @node ABI
15404 @section Configuring the current ABI
15405
15406 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
15407 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
15408 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
15409 current ABI.
15410
15411 @cindex OS ABI
15412 @kindex set osabi
15413 @kindex show osabi
15414
15415 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
15416 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
15417 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
15418 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
15419 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
15420 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
15421 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
15422 platform provides.
15423
15424 @table @code
15425 @item show osabi
15426 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
15427
15428 @item set osabi
15429 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
15430
15431 @item set osabi @var{abi}
15432 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
15433 @end table
15434
15435 @cindex float promotion
15436
15437 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
15438 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
15439 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
15440 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
15441 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
15442 @code{double} and then passed.
15443
15444 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
15445 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
15446 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
15447
15448 @table @code
15449 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
15450 @item set coerce-float-to-double
15451 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
15452 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
15453 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
15454
15455 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
15456 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
15457 functions.
15458
15459 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
15460 @item show coerce-float-to-double
15461 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
15462 @end table
15463
15464 @kindex set cp-abi
15465 @kindex show cp-abi
15466 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
15467 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
15468 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
15469 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
15470 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
15471 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
15472 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
15473 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
15474 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
15475 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
15476 ``auto''.
15477
15478 @table @code
15479 @item show cp-abi
15480 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
15481
15482 @item set cp-abi
15483 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
15484
15485 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
15486 @itemx set cp-abi auto
15487 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
15488 @end table
15489
15490 @node Messages/Warnings
15491 @section Optional warnings and messages
15492
15493 @cindex verbose operation
15494 @cindex optional warnings
15495 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
15496 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
15497 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
15498 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
15499
15500 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
15501 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
15502 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
15503
15504 @table @code
15505 @kindex set verbose
15506 @item set verbose on
15507 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15508
15509 @item set verbose off
15510 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15511
15512 @kindex show verbose
15513 @item show verbose
15514 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
15515 @end table
15516
15517 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
15518 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
15519 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
15520 symbol files}).
15521
15522 @table @code
15523
15524 @kindex set complaints
15525 @item set complaints @var{limit}
15526 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
15527 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
15528 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
15529 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
15530
15531 @kindex show complaints
15532 @item show complaints
15533 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
15534
15535 @end table
15536
15537 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
15538 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
15539 you try to run a program which is already running:
15540
15541 @smallexample
15542 (@value{GDBP}) run
15543 The program being debugged has been started already.
15544 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
15545 @end smallexample
15546
15547 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
15548 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
15549
15550 @table @code
15551
15552 @kindex set confirm
15553 @cindex flinching
15554 @cindex confirmation
15555 @cindex stupid questions
15556 @item set confirm off
15557 Disables confirmation requests.
15558
15559 @item set confirm on
15560 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
15561
15562 @kindex show confirm
15563 @item show confirm
15564 Displays state of confirmation requests.
15565
15566 @end table
15567
15568 @node Debugging Output
15569 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
15570 @cindex optional debugging messages
15571
15572 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
15573 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
15574 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
15575 section documents those commands.
15576
15577 @table @code
15578 @kindex set exec-done-display
15579 @item set exec-done-display
15580 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
15581 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
15582 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
15583 @kindex show exec-done-display
15584 @item show exec-done-display
15585 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
15586 notification.
15587 @kindex set debug
15588 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
15589 @cindex architecture debugging info
15590 @item set debug arch
15591 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
15592 @kindex show debug
15593 @item show debug arch
15594 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
15595 @item set debug aix-thread
15596 @cindex AIX threads
15597 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
15598 module.
15599 @item show debug aix-thread
15600 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
15601 @item set debug event
15602 @cindex event debugging info
15603 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
15604 default is off.
15605 @item show debug event
15606 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
15607 info.
15608 @item set debug expression
15609 @cindex expression debugging info
15610 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
15611 expression parsing. The default is off.
15612 @item show debug expression
15613 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
15614 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
15615 @item set debug frame
15616 @cindex frame debugging info
15617 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
15618 default is off.
15619 @item show debug frame
15620 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
15621 info.
15622 @item set debug infrun
15623 @cindex inferior debugging info
15624 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
15625 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
15626 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
15627 @item show debug infrun
15628 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
15629 @item set debug lin-lwp
15630 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
15631 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
15632 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
15633 @item show debug lin-lwp
15634 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
15635 @item set debug observer
15636 @cindex observer debugging info
15637 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
15638 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
15639 @item show debug observer
15640 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
15641 @item set debug overload
15642 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
15643 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
15644 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
15645 is off.
15646 @item show debug overload
15647 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
15648 debugging info.
15649 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
15650 @cindex serial connections, debugging
15651 @item set debug remote
15652 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
15653 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
15654 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
15655 @item show debug remote
15656 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
15657 @item set debug serial
15658 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
15659 default is off.
15660 @item show debug serial
15661 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
15662 info.
15663 @item set debug solib-frv
15664 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
15665 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
15666 @item show debug solib-frv
15667 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
15668 messages.
15669 @item set debug target
15670 @cindex target debugging info
15671 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
15672 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
15673 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
15674 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
15675 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
15676 @item show debug target
15677 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
15678 info.
15679 @item set debugvarobj
15680 @cindex variable object debugging info
15681 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
15682 info. The default is off.
15683 @item show debugvarobj
15684 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
15685 debugging info.
15686 @end table
15687
15688 @node Sequences
15689 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
15690
15691 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
15692 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
15693 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
15694 files.
15695
15696 @menu
15697 * Define:: User-defined commands
15698 * Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
15699 * Command Files:: Command files
15700 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
15701 @end menu
15702
15703 @node Define
15704 @section User-defined commands
15705
15706 @cindex user-defined command
15707 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
15708 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
15709 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
15710 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
15711 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
15712
15713 @smallexample
15714 define adder
15715 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
15716 end
15717 @end smallexample
15718
15719 @noindent
15720 To execute the command use:
15721
15722 @smallexample
15723 adder 1 2 3
15724 @end smallexample
15725
15726 @noindent
15727 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
15728 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
15729 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
15730 functions calls.
15731
15732 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
15733 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
15734
15735 @smallexample
15736 define adder
15737 if $argc == 2
15738 print $arg0 + $arg1
15739 end
15740 if $argc == 3
15741 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
15742 end
15743 end
15744 @end smallexample
15745
15746 @table @code
15747
15748 @kindex define
15749 @item define @var{commandname}
15750 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
15751 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
15752
15753 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
15754 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
15755 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
15756
15757 @kindex if
15758 @kindex else
15759 @item if
15760 @itemx else
15761 Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
15762 It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
15763 only if the expression is true (nonzero).
15764 There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
15765 by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
15766 was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
15767
15768 @kindex while
15769 @item while
15770 The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
15771 which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
15772 execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
15773 The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
15774 evaluates to true.
15775
15776 @kindex document
15777 @item document @var{commandname}
15778 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
15779 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
15780 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
15781 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
15782 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
15783 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
15784
15785 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
15786 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
15787 does not change the documentation.
15788
15789 @kindex dont-repeat
15790 @cindex don't repeat command
15791 @item dont-repeat
15792 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
15793 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
15794 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
15795
15796 @kindex help user-defined
15797 @item help user-defined
15798 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
15799 (if any) for each.
15800
15801 @kindex show user
15802 @item show user
15803 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
15804 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
15805 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
15806 definitions for all user-defined commands.
15807
15808 @cindex infinite recusrion in user-defined commands
15809 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
15810 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
15811 @item show max-user-call-depth
15812 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
15813 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
15814 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
15815 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
15816
15817 @end table
15818
15819 When user-defined commands are executed, the
15820 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
15821 stops execution of the user-defined command.
15822
15823 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
15824 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
15825 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
15826 messages when used in a user-defined command.
15827
15828 @node Hooks
15829 @section User-defined command hooks
15830 @cindex command hooks
15831 @cindex hooks, for commands
15832 @cindex hooks, pre-command
15833
15834 @kindex hook
15835 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
15836 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
15837 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
15838 before that command.
15839
15840 @cindex hooks, post-command
15841 @kindex hookpost
15842 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
15843 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
15844 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
15845 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
15846 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
15847
15848 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
15849 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
15850
15851 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
15852 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
15853
15854 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
15855 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
15856 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
15857 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
15858 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
15859
15860 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
15861 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
15862 you could define:
15863
15864 @smallexample
15865 define hook-stop
15866 handle SIGALRM nopass
15867 end
15868
15869 define hook-run
15870 handle SIGALRM pass
15871 end
15872
15873 define hook-continue
15874 handle SIGLARM pass
15875 end
15876 @end smallexample
15877
15878 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
15879 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
15880 you could define:
15881
15882 @smallexample
15883 define hook-echo
15884 echo <<<---
15885 end
15886
15887 define hookpost-echo
15888 echo --->>>\n
15889 end
15890
15891 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
15892 <<<---Hello World--->>>
15893 (@value{GDBP})
15894
15895 @end smallexample
15896
15897 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
15898 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
15899 name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
15900 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
15901 @c or not?
15902 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
15903 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
15904 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
15905
15906 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
15907 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
15908
15909 @node Command Files
15910 @section Command files
15911
15912 @cindex command files
15913 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
15914 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
15915 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
15916 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
15917 terminal.
15918
15919 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
15920 command:
15921
15922 @table @code
15923 @kindex source
15924 @item source @var{filename}
15925 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
15926 @end table
15927
15928 The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
15929 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
15930 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
15931
15932 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
15933 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
15934 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
15935 when called from command files.
15936
15937 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
15938 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
15939 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
15940 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
15941 the next command.
15942
15943 @smallexample
15944 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
15945 @end smallexample
15946
15947 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
15948 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
15949 would be directed to @file{log}.
15950
15951 @node Output
15952 @section Commands for controlled output
15953
15954 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
15955 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
15956 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
15957 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
15958 want.
15959
15960 @table @code
15961 @kindex echo
15962 @item echo @var{text}
15963 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
15964 @c because it is not in ANSI.
15965 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
15966 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
15967 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
15968 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
15969 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
15970 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
15971 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
15972 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
15973 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
15974
15975 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
15976 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
15977
15978 @smallexample
15979 echo This is some text\n\
15980 which is continued\n\
15981 onto several lines.\n
15982 @end smallexample
15983
15984 produces the same output as
15985
15986 @smallexample
15987 echo This is some text\n
15988 echo which is continued\n
15989 echo onto several lines.\n
15990 @end smallexample
15991
15992 @kindex output
15993 @item output @var{expression}
15994 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
15995 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
15996 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
15997 on expressions.
15998
15999 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16000 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16001 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16002 formats}, for more information.
16003
16004 @kindex printf
16005 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16006 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
16007 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
16008 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
16009 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
16010 subroutine
16011 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
16012 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
16013 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
16014 @c supported.
16015
16016 @smallexample
16017 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16018 @end smallexample
16019
16020 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16021
16022 @smallexample
16023 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16024 @end smallexample
16025
16026 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
16027 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
16028 letter.
16029 @end table
16030
16031 @node Interpreters
16032 @chapter Command Interpreters
16033 @cindex command interpreters
16034
16035 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16036 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16037 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16038
16039 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16040 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16041 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16042 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16043
16044 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16045 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16046 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16047 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16048
16049 @table @code
16050 @item console
16051 @cindex console interpreter
16052 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16053 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16054 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16055
16056 @item mi
16057 @cindex mi interpreter
16058 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16059 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16060 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16061 Interface}.
16062
16063 @item mi2
16064 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16065 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16066
16067 @item mi1
16068 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16069 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16070
16071 @end table
16072
16073 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16074 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16075 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16076 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16077 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16078 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16079 the IDE inoperable!
16080
16081 @kindex interpreter-exec
16082 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16083 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16084 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16085 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16086
16087 @smallexample
16088 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16089 @end smallexample
16090
16091 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16092 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16093
16094 @node TUI
16095 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16096 @cindex TUI
16097 @cindex Text User Interface
16098
16099 @menu
16100 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16101 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16102 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16103 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
16104 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16105 @end menu
16106
16107 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short, is a terminal
16108 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16109 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16110 commands in separate text windows.
16111
16112 The TUI is enabled by invoking @value{GDBN} using either
16113 @pindex gdbtui
16114 @samp{gdbtui} or @samp{gdb -tui}.
16115
16116 @node TUI Overview
16117 @section TUI overview
16118
16119 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
16120 @value{GDBN} runs:
16121
16122 @itemize @bullet
16123 @item
16124 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
16125 windows on the terminal.
16126
16127 @item
16128 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
16129 the TUI.
16130 @end itemize
16131
16132 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
16133 on the terminal:
16134
16135 @table @emph
16136 @item command
16137 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16138 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16139 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
16140 window is always visible.
16141
16142 @item source
16143 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16144 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16145
16146 @item assembly
16147 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16148
16149 @item register
16150 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
16151 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
16152 changed are highlighted.
16153
16154 @end table
16155
16156 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16157 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
16158 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
16159 indicates the breakpoint type:
16160
16161 @table @code
16162 @item B
16163 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16164
16165 @item b
16166 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16167
16168 @item H
16169 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16170
16171 @item h
16172 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16173
16174 @end table
16175
16176 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16177
16178 @table @code
16179 @item +
16180 Breakpoint is enabled.
16181
16182 @item -
16183 Breakpoint is disabled.
16184
16185 @end table
16186
16187 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
16188 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
16189 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
16190 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
16191 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
16192 The following layouts are available:
16193
16194 @itemize @bullet
16195 @item
16196 source
16197
16198 @item
16199 assembly
16200
16201 @item
16202 source and assembly
16203
16204 @item
16205 source and registers
16206
16207 @item
16208 assembly and registers
16209
16210 @end itemize
16211
16212 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
16213 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
16214 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
16215 are displayed:
16216
16217 @table @emph
16218 @item target
16219 Indicates the current gdb target
16220 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16221
16222 @item process
16223 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
16224 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16225
16226 @item function
16227 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16228 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16229 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
16230 the string @code{??} is displayed.
16231
16232 @item line
16233 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16234 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
16235
16236 @item pc
16237 Indicates the current program counter address.
16238
16239 @end table
16240
16241 @node TUI Keys
16242 @section TUI Key Bindings
16243 @cindex TUI key bindings
16244
16245 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16246 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
16247 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
16248 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
16249 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
16250 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
16251 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16252
16253 @table @kbd
16254 @kindex C-x C-a
16255 @item C-x C-a
16256 @kindex C-x a
16257 @itemx C-x a
16258 @kindex C-x A
16259 @itemx C-x A
16260 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
16261 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
16262 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
16263 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
16264 The screen is then refreshed.
16265
16266 @kindex C-x 1
16267 @item C-x 1
16268 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16269 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16270 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16271
16272 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16273
16274 @kindex C-x 2
16275 @item C-x 2
16276 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16277 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
16278 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16279 previous layout and the new one.
16280
16281 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16282
16283 @kindex C-x o
16284 @item C-x o
16285 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
16286 (like scrolling and arrow keys) to the active window. This command
16287 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
16288
16289 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
16290
16291 @kindex C-x s
16292 @item C-x s
16293 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
16294 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
16295
16296 @end table
16297
16298 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
16299
16300 @table @key
16301 @kindex PgUp
16302 @item PgUp
16303 Scroll the active window one page up.
16304
16305 @kindex PgDn
16306 @item PgDn
16307 Scroll the active window one page down.
16308
16309 @kindex Up
16310 @item Up
16311 Scroll the active window one line up.
16312
16313 @kindex Down
16314 @item Down
16315 Scroll the active window one line down.
16316
16317 @kindex Left
16318 @item Left
16319 Scroll the active window one column left.
16320
16321 @kindex Right
16322 @item Right
16323 Scroll the active window one column right.
16324
16325 @kindex C-L
16326 @item C-L
16327 Refresh the screen.
16328
16329 @end table
16330
16331 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
16332 for scrolling. This means they are available for readline when the
16333 active window is the command window. When the command window
16334 does not have the focus, it is necessary to use other readline
16335 key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n}, @key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
16336
16337 @node TUI Single Key Mode
16338 @section TUI Single Key Mode
16339 @cindex TUI single key mode
16340
16341 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
16342 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
16343 some gdb commands.
16344
16345 @table @kbd
16346 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16347 @item c
16348 continue
16349
16350 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16351 @item d
16352 down
16353
16354 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16355 @item f
16356 finish
16357
16358 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16359 @item n
16360 next
16361
16362 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16363 @item q
16364 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
16365
16366 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16367 @item r
16368 run
16369
16370 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16371 @item s
16372 step
16373
16374 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16375 @item u
16376 up
16377
16378 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16379 @item v
16380 info locals
16381
16382 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16383 @item w
16384 where
16385
16386 @end table
16387
16388 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
16389 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
16390 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
16391 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
16392 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
16393 this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
16394
16395
16396 @node TUI Commands
16397 @section TUI specific commands
16398 @cindex TUI commands
16399
16400 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
16401 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
16402 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
16403 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
16404 in the TUI mode.
16405
16406 @table @code
16407 @item info win
16408 @kindex info win
16409 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
16410
16411 @item layout next
16412 @kindex layout
16413 Display the next layout.
16414
16415 @item layout prev
16416 Display the previous layout.
16417
16418 @item layout src
16419 Display the source window only.
16420
16421 @item layout asm
16422 Display the assembly window only.
16423
16424 @item layout split
16425 Display the source and assembly window.
16426
16427 @item layout regs
16428 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
16429
16430 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
16431 @kindex focus
16432 Set the focus to the named window.
16433 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
16434 can be affected to another window.
16435
16436 @item refresh
16437 @kindex refresh
16438 Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
16439
16440 @item tui reg float
16441 @kindex tui reg
16442 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
16443
16444 @item tui reg general
16445 Show the general registers in the register window.
16446
16447 @item tui reg next
16448 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
16449 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
16450 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
16451 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
16452
16453 @item tui reg system
16454 Show the system registers in the register window.
16455
16456 @item update
16457 @kindex update
16458 Update the source window and the current execution point.
16459
16460 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
16461 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
16462 @kindex winheight
16463 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
16464 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
16465 decrease it.
16466
16467 @item tabset
16468 @kindex tabset @var{nchars}
16469 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
16470
16471 @end table
16472
16473 @node TUI Configuration
16474 @section TUI configuration variables
16475 @cindex TUI configuration variables
16476
16477 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
16478 appearance of windows on the terminal.
16479
16480 @table @code
16481 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
16482 @kindex set tui border-kind
16483 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
16484 The possible values are the following:
16485 @table @code
16486 @item space
16487 Use a space character to draw the border.
16488
16489 @item ascii
16490 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
16491
16492 @item acs
16493 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
16494 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
16495
16496 @end table
16497
16498 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
16499 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
16500 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
16501 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
16502 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
16503
16504 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
16505 @kindex set tui border-mode
16506 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
16507 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
16508 @table @code
16509 @item normal
16510 Use normal attributes to display the border.
16511
16512 @item standout
16513 Use standout mode.
16514
16515 @item reverse
16516 Use reverse video mode.
16517
16518 @item half
16519 Use half bright mode.
16520
16521 @item half-standout
16522 Use half bright and standout mode.
16523
16524 @item bold
16525 Use extra bright or bold mode.
16526
16527 @item bold-standout
16528 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
16529
16530 @end table
16531
16532 @end table
16533
16534 @node Emacs
16535 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
16536
16537 @cindex Emacs
16538 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
16539 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
16540 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
16541 @value{GDBN}.
16542
16543 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
16544 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
16545 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
16546 created Emacs buffer.
16547 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
16548
16549 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
16550 things:
16551
16552 @itemize @bullet
16553 @item
16554 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
16555 @end itemize
16556
16557 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
16558 and output done by the program you are debugging.
16559
16560 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
16561 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
16562 in this way.
16563
16564 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
16565 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
16566 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
16567 stop.
16568
16569 @itemize @bullet
16570 @item
16571 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
16572 @end itemize
16573
16574 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
16575 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
16576 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
16577 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
16578 and the source.
16579
16580 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
16581 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
16582
16583 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
16584 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
16585 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
16586 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
16587 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
16588 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
16589 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
16590 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
16591 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
16592
16593 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
16594 line of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer and this serves as a default for
16595 the commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate
16596 on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
16597
16598 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
16599 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
16600 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
16601 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
16602 one you want.
16603
16604 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
16605 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
16606
16607 @table @kbd
16608 @item C-h m
16609 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
16610
16611 @item C-c C-s
16612 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
16613 update the display window to show the current file and location.
16614
16615 @item C-c C-n
16616 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
16617 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
16618 to show the current file and location.
16619
16620 @item C-c C-i
16621 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
16622 display window accordingly.
16623
16624 @item C-c C-f
16625 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
16626 @code{finish} command.
16627
16628 @item C-c C-r
16629 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
16630 command.
16631
16632 @item C-c <
16633 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
16634 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
16635 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
16636
16637 @item C-c >
16638 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
16639 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
16640 @end table
16641
16642 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gud-break})
16643 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
16644
16645 If you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, then Emacs displays a separate frame which
16646 shows a backtrace when the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer is current. Move
16647 point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it become the
16648 current frame and display the associated source in the source buffer.
16649 Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the selected frame become the
16650 current one.
16651
16652 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
16653 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
16654 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
16655 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
16656 frame.
16657
16658 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
16659 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
16660 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
16661 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
16662 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
16663 to correspond properly with the code.
16664
16665 The description given here is for GNU Emacs version 21.3 and a more
16666 detailed description of its interaction with @value{GDBN} is given in
16667 the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}).
16668
16669 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
16670 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
16671 @ignore
16672 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
16673 @kindex Epoch
16674 @kindex inspect
16675
16676 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
16677 called the @code{epoch}
16678 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
16679 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
16680 each value is printed in its own window.
16681 @end ignore
16682
16683
16684 @node GDB/MI
16685 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
16686
16687 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
16688
16689 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
16690 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
16691 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
16692 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
16693 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
16694 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
16695
16696 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
16697 in the form of a reference manual.
16698
16699 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
16700 features described below are incomplete and subject to change.
16701
16702 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
16703
16704 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
16705 This chapter uses the following notation:
16706
16707 @itemize @bullet
16708 @item
16709 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
16710
16711 @item
16712 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
16713 it may or may not be given.
16714
16715 @item
16716 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
16717 may repeat zero or more times.
16718
16719 @item
16720 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
16721 may repeat one or more times.
16722
16723 @item
16724 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
16725 @end itemize
16726
16727 @ignore
16728 @heading Dependencies
16729 @end ignore
16730
16731 @heading Acknowledgments
16732
16733 In alphabetic order: Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, Stan Shebs and
16734 Elena Zannoni.
16735
16736 @menu
16737 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
16738 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
16739 * GDB/MI Output Records::
16740 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
16741 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands::
16742 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
16743 * GDB/MI Program Control::
16744 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
16745 @ignore
16746 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
16747 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
16748 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
16749 @end ignore
16750 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
16751 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
16752 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
16753 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
16754 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
16755 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
16756 @end menu
16757
16758 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16759 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
16760 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
16761
16762 @menu
16763 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
16764 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
16765 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
16766 @end menu
16767
16768 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
16769 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
16770
16771 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
16772 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
16773 @table @code
16774 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
16775 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
16776
16777 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
16778 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
16779 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
16780
16781 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
16782 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
16783 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
16784
16785 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
16786 "any sequence of digits"
16787
16788 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
16789 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
16790
16791 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
16792 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
16793
16794 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
16795 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
16796
16797 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
16798 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
16799 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
16800
16801 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
16802 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
16803
16804 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
16805 @code{CR | CR-LF}
16806 @end table
16807
16808 @noindent
16809 Notes:
16810
16811 @itemize @bullet
16812 @item
16813 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
16814 output is described below.
16815
16816 @item
16817 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
16818 finishes.
16819
16820 @item
16821 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
16822 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
16823 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
16824 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
16825 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
16826 @end itemize
16827
16828 Pragmatics:
16829
16830 @itemize @bullet
16831 @item
16832 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
16833
16834 @item
16835 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
16836 @end itemize
16837
16838 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
16839 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
16840
16841 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
16842 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
16843 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
16844 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
16845 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
16846 terminated by @samp{(@value{GDBP})}.
16847
16848 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
16849 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
16850 @var{token}.
16851
16852 @table @code
16853 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
16854 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(@value{GDBP})" @var{nl}}
16855
16856 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
16857 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
16858
16859 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
16860 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
16861
16862 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
16863 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
16864
16865 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
16866 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
16867
16868 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
16869 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
16870
16871 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
16872 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
16873
16874 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
16875 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
16876
16877 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
16878 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
16879
16880 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
16881 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
16882 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
16883
16884 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
16885 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
16886
16887 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
16888 @code{ @var{string} }
16889
16890 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
16891 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
16892
16893 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
16894 @code{@var{c-string}}
16895
16896 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
16897 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
16898
16899 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
16900 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
16901 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
16902
16903 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
16904 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
16905
16906 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
16907 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
16908
16909 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
16910 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
16911
16912 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
16913 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
16914
16915 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
16916 @code{CR | CR-LF}
16917
16918 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
16919 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
16920 @end table
16921
16922 @noindent
16923 Notes:
16924
16925 @itemize @bullet
16926 @item
16927 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
16928
16929 @item
16930 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
16931 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
16932 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
16933 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
16934
16935 @item
16936 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
16937 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
16938 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
16939 prefixed by @samp{+}.
16940
16941 @item
16942 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
16943 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
16944 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
16945 @samp{*}.
16946
16947 @item
16948 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
16949 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
16950 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
16951 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
16952
16953 @item
16954 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
16955 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
16956 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
16957 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
16958
16959 @item
16960 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
16961 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
16962 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
16963
16964 @item
16965 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
16966 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
16967 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
16968 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
16969
16970 @item
16971 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
16972 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
16973 @var{values}.
16974
16975
16976 @end itemize
16977
16978 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
16979 details about the various output records.
16980
16981 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
16982 @subsection Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
16983 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
16984
16985 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
16986 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
16987 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
16988 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
16989
16990 @subsubheading Target Stop
16991 @c Ummm... There is no "-stop" command. This assumes async, no?
16992 Here's an example of stopping the inferior process:
16993
16994 @smallexample
16995 -> -stop
16996 <- (@value{GDBP})
16997 @end smallexample
16998
16999 @noindent
17000 and later:
17001
17002 @smallexample
17003 <- *stop,reason="stop",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
17004 <- (@value{GDBP})
17005 @end smallexample
17006
17007 @subsubheading Simple CLI Command
17008
17009 Here's an example of a simple CLI command being passed through
17010 @sc{gdb/mi} and on to the CLI.
17011
17012 @smallexample
17013 -> print 1+2
17014 <- &"print 1+2\n"
17015 <- ~"$1 = 3\n"
17016 <- ^done
17017 <- (@value{GDBP})
17018 @end smallexample
17019
17020 @subsubheading Command With Side Effects
17021
17022 @smallexample
17023 -> -symbol-file xyz.exe
17024 <- *breakpoint,nr="3",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
17025 <- (@value{GDBP})
17026 @end smallexample
17027
17028 @subsubheading A Bad Command
17029
17030 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17031
17032 @smallexample
17033 -> -rubbish
17034 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17035 <- (@value{GDBP})
17036 @end smallexample
17037
17038 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17039 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17040 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17041
17042 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17043 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17044 To help users familiar with @value{GDBN}'s existing CLI interface, @sc{gdb/mi}
17045 accepts existing CLI commands. As specified by the syntax, such
17046 commands can be directly entered into the @sc{gdb/mi} interface and @value{GDBN} will
17047 respond.
17048
17049 This mechanism is provided as an aid to developers of @sc{gdb/mi}
17050 clients and not as a reliable interface into the CLI. Since the command
17051 is being interpreteted in an environment that assumes @sc{gdb/mi}
17052 behaviour, the exact output of such commands is likely to end up being
17053 an un-supported hybrid of @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI output.
17054
17055 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17056 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17057 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17058
17059 @menu
17060 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17061 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17062 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17063 @end menu
17064
17065 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17066 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17067
17068 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17069 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17070 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17071 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17072
17073 @table @code
17074 @findex ^done
17075 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17076 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17077 values.
17078
17079 @item "^running"
17080 @findex ^running
17081 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17082 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17083 running.
17084
17085 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17086 @findex ^error
17087 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17088 error message.
17089 @end table
17090
17091 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17092 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17093
17094 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17095 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17096 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17097 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17098 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17099
17100 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17101 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17102 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17103 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17104 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17105
17106 @table @code
17107 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17108 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17109 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17110
17111 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17112 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17113 target.
17114
17115 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17116 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17117 internals.
17118 @end table
17119
17120 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17121 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17122
17123 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17124 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17125 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17126 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17127 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17128 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17129
17130 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17131 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17132
17133 @table @code
17134 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17135 @end table
17136
17137 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17138
17139 @table @code
17140 @item breakpoint-hit
17141 A breakpoint was reached.
17142 @item watchpoint-trigger
17143 A watchpoint was triggered.
17144 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17145 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17146 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17147 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17148 @item function-finished
17149 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17150 @item location-reached
17151 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17152 @item watchpoint-scope
17153 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17154 @item end-stepping-range
17155 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17156 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17157 @item exited-signalled
17158 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17159 @item exited
17160 The inferior exited.
17161 @item exited-normally
17162 The inferior exited normally.
17163 @item signal-received
17164 A signal was received by the inferior.
17165 @end table
17166
17167
17168 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17169 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17170 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17171
17172 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17173 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17174
17175 Note the the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17176 readability. They don't appear in the real output.
17177 Also note that the commands with a non-available example (N.A.@:) are
17178 not yet implemented.
17179
17180 @subheading Motivation
17181
17182 The motivation for this collection of commands.
17183
17184 @subheading Introduction
17185
17186 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17187
17188 @subheading Commands
17189
17190 For each command in the block, the following is described:
17191
17192 @subsubheading Synopsis
17193
17194 @smallexample
17195 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17196 @end smallexample
17197
17198 @subsubheading Result
17199
17200 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17201
17202 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17203
17204 @subsubheading Example
17205
17206 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17207 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands
17208 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint table commands
17209
17210 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
17211 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
17212 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
17213 breakpoints.
17214
17215 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
17216 @findex -break-after
17217
17218 @subsubheading Synopsis
17219
17220 @smallexample
17221 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
17222 @end smallexample
17223
17224 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
17225 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
17226 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
17227 @samp{-break-list} command below.
17228
17229 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17230
17231 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
17232
17233 @subsubheading Example
17234
17235 @smallexample
17236 (@value{GDBP})
17237 -break-insert main
17238 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",line="5"@}
17239 (@value{GDBP})
17240 -break-after 1 3
17241 ~
17242 ^done
17243 (@value{GDBP})
17244 -break-list
17245 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17246 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17247 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17248 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17249 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17250 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17251 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17252 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17253 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0",
17254 ignore="3"@}]@}
17255 (@value{GDBP})
17256 @end smallexample
17257
17258 @ignore
17259 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
17260 @findex -break-catch
17261
17262 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
17263 @findex -break-commands
17264 @end ignore
17265
17266
17267 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
17268 @findex -break-condition
17269
17270 @subsubheading Synopsis
17271
17272 @smallexample
17273 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
17274 @end smallexample
17275
17276 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
17277 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
17278 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
17279 command below).
17280
17281 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17282
17283 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
17284
17285 @subsubheading Example
17286
17287 @smallexample
17288 (@value{GDBP})
17289 -break-condition 1 1
17290 ^done
17291 (@value{GDBP})
17292 -break-list
17293 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17294 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17295 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17296 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17297 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17298 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17299 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17300 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17301 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",cond="1",
17302 times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17303 (@value{GDBP})
17304 @end smallexample
17305
17306 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
17307 @findex -break-delete
17308
17309 @subsubheading Synopsis
17310
17311 @smallexample
17312 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17313 @end smallexample
17314
17315 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
17316 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
17317
17318 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17319
17320 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
17321
17322 @subsubheading Example
17323
17324 @smallexample
17325 (@value{GDBP})
17326 -break-delete 1
17327 ^done
17328 (@value{GDBP})
17329 -break-list
17330 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
17331 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17332 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17333 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17334 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17335 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17336 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17337 body=[]@}
17338 (@value{GDBP})
17339 @end smallexample
17340
17341 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
17342 @findex -break-disable
17343
17344 @subsubheading Synopsis
17345
17346 @smallexample
17347 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17348 @end smallexample
17349
17350 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
17351 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
17352
17353 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17354
17355 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
17356
17357 @subsubheading Example
17358
17359 @smallexample
17360 (@value{GDBP})
17361 -break-disable 2
17362 ^done
17363 (@value{GDBP})
17364 -break-list
17365 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17366 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17367 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17368 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17369 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17370 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17371 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17372 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
17373 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
17374 (@value{GDBP})
17375 @end smallexample
17376
17377 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
17378 @findex -break-enable
17379
17380 @subsubheading Synopsis
17381
17382 @smallexample
17383 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17384 @end smallexample
17385
17386 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
17387
17388 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17389
17390 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
17391
17392 @subsubheading Example
17393
17394 @smallexample
17395 (@value{GDBP})
17396 -break-enable 2
17397 ^done
17398 (@value{GDBP})
17399 -break-list
17400 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17401 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17402 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17403 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17404 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17405 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17406 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17407 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17408 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
17409 (@value{GDBP})
17410 @end smallexample
17411
17412 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
17413 @findex -break-info
17414
17415 @subsubheading Synopsis
17416
17417 @smallexample
17418 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
17419 @end smallexample
17420
17421 @c REDUNDANT???
17422 Get information about a single breakpoint.
17423
17424 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17425
17426 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
17427
17428 @subsubheading Example
17429 N.A.
17430
17431 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
17432 @findex -break-insert
17433
17434 @subsubheading Synopsis
17435
17436 @smallexample
17437 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
17438 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
17439 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
17440 @end smallexample
17441
17442 @noindent
17443 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
17444
17445 @itemize @bullet
17446 @item function
17447 @c @item +offset
17448 @c @item -offset
17449 @c @item linenum
17450 @item filename:linenum
17451 @item filename:function
17452 @item *address
17453 @end itemize
17454
17455 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
17456
17457 @table @samp
17458 @item -t
17459 Insert a tempoary breakpoint.
17460 @item -h
17461 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
17462 @item -c @var{condition}
17463 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
17464 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
17465 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
17466 @item -r
17467 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
17468 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
17469 expresson.
17470 @end table
17471
17472 @subsubheading Result
17473
17474 The result is in the form:
17475
17476 @smallexample
17477 ^done,bkptno="@var{number}",func="@var{funcname}",
17478 file="@var{filename}",line="@var{lineno}"
17479 @end smallexample
17480
17481 @noindent
17482 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint, @var{funcname}
17483 is the name of the function where the breakpoint was inserted,
17484 @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains this
17485 function, and @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file.
17486
17487 Note: this format is open to change.
17488 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
17489
17490 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17491
17492 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
17493 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
17494
17495 @subsubheading Example
17496
17497 @smallexample
17498 (@value{GDBP})
17499 -break-insert main
17500 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
17501 (@value{GDBP})
17502 -break-insert -t foo
17503 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
17504 (@value{GDBP})
17505 -break-list
17506 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
17507 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17508 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17509 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17510 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17511 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17512 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17513 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17514 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",line="4",times="0"@},
17515 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
17516 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
17517 (@value{GDBP})
17518 -break-insert -r foo.*
17519 ~int foo(int, int);
17520 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
17521 (@value{GDBP})
17522 @end smallexample
17523
17524 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
17525 @findex -break-list
17526
17527 @subsubheading Synopsis
17528
17529 @smallexample
17530 -break-list
17531 @end smallexample
17532
17533 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
17534
17535 @table @samp
17536 @item Number
17537 number of the breakpoint
17538 @item Type
17539 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
17540 @item Disposition
17541 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
17542 or @samp{nokeep}
17543 @item Enabled
17544 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
17545 @item Address
17546 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
17547 @item What
17548 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
17549 name, line number
17550 @item Times
17551 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
17552 @end table
17553
17554 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
17555 @code{body} field is an empty list.
17556
17557 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17558
17559 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
17560
17561 @subsubheading Example
17562
17563 @smallexample
17564 (@value{GDBP})
17565 -break-list
17566 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
17567 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17568 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17569 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17570 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17571 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17572 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17573 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17574 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
17575 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17576 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",line="13",times="0"@}]@}
17577 (@value{GDBP})
17578 @end smallexample
17579
17580 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
17581
17582 @smallexample
17583 (@value{GDBP})
17584 -break-list
17585 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
17586 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17587 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17588 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17589 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17590 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17591 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17592 body=[]@}
17593 (@value{GDBP})
17594 @end smallexample
17595
17596 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
17597 @findex -break-watch
17598
17599 @subsubheading Synopsis
17600
17601 @smallexample
17602 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
17603 @end smallexample
17604
17605 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
17606 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e. a watchpoint that triggers either on a
17607 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
17608 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e. it will
17609 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
17610 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
17611 i.e. it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
17612 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting watchpoints}.
17613
17614 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
17615 breakpoints inserted.
17616
17617 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17618
17619 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
17620 @samp{rwatch}.
17621
17622 @subsubheading Example
17623
17624 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
17625
17626 @smallexample
17627 (@value{GDBP})
17628 -break-watch x
17629 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
17630 (@value{GDBP})
17631 -exec-continue
17632 ^running
17633 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
17634 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
17635 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
17636 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
17637 (@value{GDBP})
17638 @end smallexample
17639
17640 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
17641 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
17642 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
17643
17644 @smallexample
17645 (@value{GDBP})
17646 -break-watch C
17647 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
17648 (@value{GDBP})
17649 -exec-continue
17650 ^running
17651 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
17652 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
17653 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
17654 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
17655 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
17656 (@value{GDBP})
17657 -exec-continue
17658 ^running
17659 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
17660 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
17661 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
17662 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
17663 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
17664 (@value{GDBP})
17665 @end smallexample
17666
17667 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
17668 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
17669 deleted.
17670
17671 @smallexample
17672 (@value{GDBP})
17673 -break-watch C
17674 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
17675 (@value{GDBP})
17676 -break-list
17677 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
17678 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17679 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17680 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17681 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17682 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17683 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17684 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17685 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
17686 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
17687 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
17688 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
17689 (@value{GDBP})
17690 -exec-continue
17691 ^running
17692 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
17693 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
17694 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
17695 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
17696 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
17697 (@value{GDBP})
17698 -break-list
17699 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
17700 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17701 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17702 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17703 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17704 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17705 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17706 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17707 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
17708 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
17709 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
17710 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
17711 (@value{GDBP})
17712 -exec-continue
17713 ^running
17714 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
17715 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
17716 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
17717 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
17718 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
17719 (@value{GDBP})
17720 -break-list
17721 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17722 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17723 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17724 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17725 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17726 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17727 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17728 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17729 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
17730 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@}]@}
17731 (@value{GDBP})
17732 @end smallexample
17733
17734 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17735 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
17736 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
17737
17738 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
17739 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
17740 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
17741 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
17742
17743 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
17744 @c @subheading -data-assign
17745 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
17746 @c @subsubheading GDB command
17747 @c set variable
17748 @c @subsubheading Example
17749 @c N.A.
17750
17751 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
17752 @findex -data-disassemble
17753
17754 @subsubheading Synopsis
17755
17756 @smallexample
17757 -data-disassemble
17758 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
17759 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
17760 -- @var{mode}
17761 @end smallexample
17762
17763 @noindent
17764 Where:
17765
17766 @table @samp
17767 @item @var{start-addr}
17768 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
17769 @item @var{end-addr}
17770 is the end address
17771 @item @var{filename}
17772 is the name of the file to disassemble
17773 @item @var{linenum}
17774 is the line number to disassemble around
17775 @item @var{lines}
17776 is the the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
17777 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
17778 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
17779 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
17780 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
17781 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
17782 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
17783 are displayed.
17784 @item @var{mode}
17785 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
17786 disassembly).
17787 @end table
17788
17789 @subsubheading Result
17790
17791 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
17792
17793 @itemize @bullet
17794 @item Address
17795 @item Func-name
17796 @item Offset
17797 @item Instruction
17798 @end itemize
17799
17800 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
17801 directely by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e. it is not possible to adjust its format.
17802
17803 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17804
17805 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
17806
17807 @subsubheading Example
17808
17809 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
17810
17811 @smallexample
17812 (@value{GDBP})
17813 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
17814 ^done,
17815 asm_insns=[
17816 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
17817 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
17818 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
17819 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
17820 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
17821 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
17822 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
17823 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
17824 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
17825 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
17826 (@value{GDBP})
17827 @end smallexample
17828
17829 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
17830 @code{main}.
17831
17832 @smallexample
17833 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
17834 ^done,asm_insns=[
17835 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
17836 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
17837 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
17838 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
17839 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
17840 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
17841 [@dots{}]
17842 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
17843 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
17844 (@value{GDBP})
17845 @end smallexample
17846
17847 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
17848
17849 @smallexample
17850 (@value{GDBP})
17851 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
17852 ^done,asm_insns=[
17853 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
17854 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
17855 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
17856 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
17857 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
17858 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
17859 (@value{GDBP})
17860 @end smallexample
17861
17862 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
17863
17864 @smallexample
17865 (@value{GDBP})
17866 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
17867 ^done,asm_insns=[
17868 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
17869 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
17870 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
17871 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
17872 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
17873 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
17874 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
17875 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
17876 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
17877 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
17878 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
17879 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
17880 (@value{GDBP})
17881 @end smallexample
17882
17883
17884 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
17885 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
17886
17887 @subsubheading Synopsis
17888
17889 @smallexample
17890 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
17891 @end smallexample
17892
17893 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
17894 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
17895 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
17896
17897 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17898
17899 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
17900 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
17901 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
17902
17903 @subsubheading Example
17904
17905 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
17906 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
17907 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
17908 output.
17909
17910 @smallexample
17911 211-data-evaluate-expression A
17912 211^done,value="1"
17913 (@value{GDBP})
17914 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
17915 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
17916 (@value{GDBP})
17917 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
17918 411^done,value="4"
17919 (@value{GDBP})
17920 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
17921 511^done,value="4"
17922 (@value{GDBP})
17923 @end smallexample
17924
17925
17926 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
17927 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
17928
17929 @subsubheading Synopsis
17930
17931 @smallexample
17932 -data-list-changed-registers
17933 @end smallexample
17934
17935 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
17936
17937 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17938
17939 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
17940 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
17941
17942 @subsubheading Example
17943
17944 On a PPC MBX board:
17945
17946 @smallexample
17947 (@value{GDBP})
17948 -exec-continue
17949 ^running
17950
17951 (@value{GDBP})
17952 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
17953 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/try.c",line="5"@}
17954 (@value{GDBP})
17955 -data-list-changed-registers
17956 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
17957 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
17958 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
17959 (@value{GDBP})
17960 @end smallexample
17961
17962
17963 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
17964 @findex -data-list-register-names
17965
17966 @subsubheading Synopsis
17967
17968 @smallexample
17969 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
17970 @end smallexample
17971
17972 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
17973 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
17974 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
17975 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
17976 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
17977 include empty register names.
17978
17979 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17980
17981 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
17982 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
17983 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
17984
17985 @subsubheading Example
17986
17987 For the PPC MBX board:
17988 @smallexample
17989 (@value{GDBP})
17990 -data-list-register-names
17991 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
17992 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
17993 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
17994 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
17995 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
17996 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
17997 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
17998 (@value{GDBP})
17999 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
18000 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
18001 (@value{GDBP})
18002 @end smallexample
18003
18004 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
18005 @findex -data-list-register-values
18006
18007 @subsubheading Synopsis
18008
18009 @smallexample
18010 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
18011 @end smallexample
18012
18013 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
18014 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
18015 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
18016 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
18017
18018 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
18019
18020 @table @code
18021 @item x
18022 Hexadecimal
18023 @item o
18024 Octal
18025 @item t
18026 Binary
18027 @item d
18028 Decimal
18029 @item r
18030 Raw
18031 @item N
18032 Natural
18033 @end table
18034
18035 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18036
18037 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
18038 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
18039
18040 @subsubheading Example
18041
18042 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
18043 don't appear in the actual output):
18044
18045 @smallexample
18046 (@value{GDBP})
18047 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
18048 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
18049 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
18050 (@value{GDBP})
18051 -data-list-register-values x
18052 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
18053 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
18054 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
18055 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
18056 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
18057 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
18058 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
18059 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
18060 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
18061 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
18062 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
18063 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
18064 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
18065 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
18066 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
18067 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
18068 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
18069 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
18070 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
18071 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
18072 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
18073 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
18074 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
18075 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
18076 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
18077 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
18078 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
18079 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
18080 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
18081 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
18082 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
18083 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
18084 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
18085 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
18086 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
18087 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
18088 (@value{GDBP})
18089 @end smallexample
18090
18091
18092 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
18093 @findex -data-read-memory
18094
18095 @subsubheading Synopsis
18096
18097 @smallexample
18098 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
18099 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
18100 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
18101 @end smallexample
18102
18103 @noindent
18104 where:
18105
18106 @table @samp
18107 @item @var{address}
18108 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
18109 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
18110 quoted using the C convention.
18111
18112 @item @var{word-format}
18113 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
18114 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
18115 ,Output formats}).
18116
18117 @item @var{word-size}
18118 The size of each memory word in bytes.
18119
18120 @item @var{nr-rows}
18121 The number of rows in the output table.
18122
18123 @item @var{nr-cols}
18124 The number of columns in the output table.
18125
18126 @item @var{aschar}
18127 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
18128 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
18129 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
18130 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
18131
18132 @item @var{byte-offset}
18133 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
18134 @end table
18135
18136 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
18137 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
18138 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
18139 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
18140 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
18141 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
18142 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
18143 @samp{addr}.
18144
18145 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
18146 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
18147 @samp{prev-page}.
18148
18149 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18150
18151 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
18152 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
18153
18154 @subsubheading Example
18155
18156 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
18157 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
18158 word. Display each word in hex.
18159
18160 @smallexample
18161 (@value{GDBP})
18162 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
18163 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
18164 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
18165 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
18166 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
18167 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
18168 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
18169 (@value{GDBP})
18170 @end smallexample
18171
18172 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
18173 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
18174
18175 @smallexample
18176 (@value{GDBP})
18177 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
18178 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
18179 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
18180 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
18181 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
18182 (@value{GDBP})
18183 @end smallexample
18184
18185 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
18186 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
18187 used as the non-printable character.
18188
18189 @smallexample
18190 (@value{GDBP})
18191 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
18192 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
18193 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
18194 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
18195 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
18196 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
18197 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
18198 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
18199 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
18200 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
18201 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
18202 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
18203 (@value{GDBP})
18204 @end smallexample
18205
18206 @subheading The @code{-display-delete} Command
18207 @findex -display-delete
18208
18209 @subsubheading Synopsis
18210
18211 @smallexample
18212 -display-delete @var{number}
18213 @end smallexample
18214
18215 Delete the display @var{number}.
18216
18217 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18218
18219 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete display}.
18220
18221 @subsubheading Example
18222 N.A.
18223
18224
18225 @subheading The @code{-display-disable} Command
18226 @findex -display-disable
18227
18228 @subsubheading Synopsis
18229
18230 @smallexample
18231 -display-disable @var{number}
18232 @end smallexample
18233
18234 Disable display @var{number}.
18235
18236 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18237
18238 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable display}.
18239
18240 @subsubheading Example
18241 N.A.
18242
18243
18244 @subheading The @code{-display-enable} Command
18245 @findex -display-enable
18246
18247 @subsubheading Synopsis
18248
18249 @smallexample
18250 -display-enable @var{number}
18251 @end smallexample
18252
18253 Enable display @var{number}.
18254
18255 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18256
18257 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable display}.
18258
18259 @subsubheading Example
18260 N.A.
18261
18262
18263 @subheading The @code{-display-insert} Command
18264 @findex -display-insert
18265
18266 @subsubheading Synopsis
18267
18268 @smallexample
18269 -display-insert @var{expression}
18270 @end smallexample
18271
18272 Display @var{expression} every time the program stops.
18273
18274 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18275
18276 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{display}.
18277
18278 @subsubheading Example
18279 N.A.
18280
18281
18282 @subheading The @code{-display-list} Command
18283 @findex -display-list
18284
18285 @subsubheading Synopsis
18286
18287 @smallexample
18288 -display-list
18289 @end smallexample
18290
18291 List the displays. Do not show the current values.
18292
18293 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18294
18295 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info display}.
18296
18297 @subsubheading Example
18298 N.A.
18299
18300
18301 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18302 @findex -environment-cd
18303
18304 @subsubheading Synopsis
18305
18306 @smallexample
18307 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18308 @end smallexample
18309
18310 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18311
18312 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18313
18314 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18315
18316 @subsubheading Example
18317
18318 @smallexample
18319 (@value{GDBP})
18320 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18321 ^done
18322 (@value{GDBP})
18323 @end smallexample
18324
18325
18326 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18327 @findex -environment-directory
18328
18329 @subsubheading Synopsis
18330
18331 @smallexample
18332 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18333 @end smallexample
18334
18335 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18336 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18337 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18338 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18339 occurs as normal.
18340 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18341 multiple directories in a single command
18342 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18343 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18344 If blanks are needed as
18345 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18346 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18347 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18348 character must not be used
18349 in any directory name.
18350 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18351
18352 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18353
18354 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18355
18356 @subsubheading Example
18357
18358 @smallexample
18359 (@value{GDBP})
18360 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18361 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18362 (@value{GDBP})
18363 -environment-directory ""
18364 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18365 (@value{GDBP})
18366 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18367 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18368 (@value{GDBP})
18369 -environment-directory -r
18370 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18371 (@value{GDBP})
18372 @end smallexample
18373
18374
18375 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18376 @findex -environment-path
18377
18378 @subsubheading Synopsis
18379
18380 @smallexample
18381 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18382 @end smallexample
18383
18384 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18385 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18386 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18387 supplied in addition to the
18388 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18389 occurs as normal.
18390 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18391 multiple directories in a single command
18392 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18393 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18394 If blanks are needed as
18395 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18396 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18397 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18398 character must not be used
18399 in any directory name.
18400 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18401
18402
18403 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18404
18405 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18406
18407 @subsubheading Example
18408
18409 @smallexample
18410 (@value{GDBP})
18411 -environment-path
18412 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18413 (@value{GDBP})
18414 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18415 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18416 (@value{GDBP})
18417 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18418 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18419 (@value{GDBP})
18420 @end smallexample
18421
18422
18423 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18424 @findex -environment-pwd
18425
18426 @subsubheading Synopsis
18427
18428 @smallexample
18429 -environment-pwd
18430 @end smallexample
18431
18432 Show the current working directory.
18433
18434 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18435
18436 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18437
18438 @subsubheading Example
18439
18440 @smallexample
18441 (@value{GDBP})
18442 -environment-pwd
18443 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18444 (@value{GDBP})
18445 @end smallexample
18446
18447 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18448 @node GDB/MI Program Control
18449 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program control
18450
18451 @subsubheading Program termination
18452
18453 As a result of execution, the inferior program can run to completion, if
18454 it doesn't encounter any breakpoints. In this case the output will
18455 include an exit code, if the program has exited exceptionally.
18456
18457 @subsubheading Examples
18458
18459 @noindent
18460 Program exited normally:
18461
18462 @smallexample
18463 (@value{GDBP})
18464 -exec-run
18465 ^running
18466 (@value{GDBP})
18467 x = 55
18468 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18469 (@value{GDBP})
18470 @end smallexample
18471
18472 @noindent
18473 Program exited exceptionally:
18474
18475 @smallexample
18476 (@value{GDBP})
18477 -exec-run
18478 ^running
18479 (@value{GDBP})
18480 x = 55
18481 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
18482 (@value{GDBP})
18483 @end smallexample
18484
18485 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
18486 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
18487
18488 @smallexample
18489 (@value{GDBP})
18490 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
18491 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
18492 @end smallexample
18493
18494
18495 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
18496 @findex -exec-abort
18497
18498 @subsubheading Synopsis
18499
18500 @smallexample
18501 -exec-abort
18502 @end smallexample
18503
18504 Kill the inferior running program.
18505
18506 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18507
18508 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
18509
18510 @subsubheading Example
18511 N.A.
18512
18513
18514 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18515 @findex -exec-arguments
18516
18517 @subsubheading Synopsis
18518
18519 @smallexample
18520 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18521 @end smallexample
18522
18523 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18524 @samp{-exec-run}.
18525
18526 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18527
18528 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18529
18530 @subsubheading Example
18531
18532 @c FIXME!
18533 Don't have one around.
18534
18535
18536 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18537 @findex -exec-continue
18538
18539 @subsubheading Synopsis
18540
18541 @smallexample
18542 -exec-continue
18543 @end smallexample
18544
18545 Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
18546 until a breakpoint is encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18547
18548 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18549
18550 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18551
18552 @subsubheading Example
18553
18554 @smallexample
18555 -exec-continue
18556 ^running
18557 (@value{GDBP})
18558 @@Hello world
18559 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18560 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/hello.c",line="13"@}
18561 (@value{GDBP})
18562 @end smallexample
18563
18564
18565 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18566 @findex -exec-finish
18567
18568 @subsubheading Synopsis
18569
18570 @smallexample
18571 -exec-finish
18572 @end smallexample
18573
18574 Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
18575 until the current function is exited. Displays the results returned by
18576 the function.
18577
18578 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18579
18580 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18581
18582 @subsubheading Example
18583
18584 Function returning @code{void}.
18585
18586 @smallexample
18587 -exec-finish
18588 ^running
18589 (@value{GDBP})
18590 @@hello from foo
18591 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18592 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/hello.c",line="7"@}
18593 (@value{GDBP})
18594 @end smallexample
18595
18596 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18597 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18598 value itself.
18599
18600 @smallexample
18601 -exec-finish
18602 ^running
18603 (@value{GDBP})
18604 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18605 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18606 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18607 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18608 (@value{GDBP})
18609 @end smallexample
18610
18611
18612 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18613 @findex -exec-interrupt
18614
18615 @subsubheading Synopsis
18616
18617 @smallexample
18618 -exec-interrupt
18619 @end smallexample
18620
18621 Asynchronous command. Interrupts the background execution of the target.
18622 Note how the token associated with the stop message is the one for the
18623 execution command that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt
18624 itself only appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18625 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18626
18627 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18628
18629 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18630
18631 @subsubheading Example
18632
18633 @smallexample
18634 (@value{GDBP})
18635 111-exec-continue
18636 111^running
18637
18638 (@value{GDBP})
18639 222-exec-interrupt
18640 222^done
18641 (@value{GDBP})
18642 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18643 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18644 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/try.c",line="13"@}
18645 (@value{GDBP})
18646
18647 (@value{GDBP})
18648 -exec-interrupt
18649 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18650 (@value{GDBP})
18651 @end smallexample
18652
18653
18654 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18655 @findex -exec-next
18656
18657 @subsubheading Synopsis
18658
18659 @smallexample
18660 -exec-next
18661 @end smallexample
18662
18663 Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
18664 when the beginning of the next source line is reached.
18665
18666 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18667
18668 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
18669
18670 @subsubheading Example
18671
18672 @smallexample
18673 -exec-next
18674 ^running
18675 (@value{GDBP})
18676 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
18677 (@value{GDBP})
18678 @end smallexample
18679
18680
18681 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
18682 @findex -exec-next-instruction
18683
18684 @subsubheading Synopsis
18685
18686 @smallexample
18687 -exec-next-instruction
18688 @end smallexample
18689
18690 Asynchronous command. Executes one machine instruction. If the
18691 instruction is a function call continues until the function returns. If
18692 the program stops at an instruction in the middle of a source line, the
18693 address will be printed as well.
18694
18695 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18696
18697 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
18698
18699 @subsubheading Example
18700
18701 @smallexample
18702 (@value{GDBP})
18703 -exec-next-instruction
18704 ^running
18705
18706 (@value{GDBP})
18707 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18708 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
18709 (@value{GDBP})
18710 @end smallexample
18711
18712
18713 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
18714 @findex -exec-return
18715
18716 @subsubheading Synopsis
18717
18718 @smallexample
18719 -exec-return
18720 @end smallexample
18721
18722 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
18723 Displays the new current frame.
18724
18725 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18726
18727 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
18728
18729 @subsubheading Example
18730
18731 @smallexample
18732 (@value{GDBP})
18733 200-break-insert callee4
18734 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
18735 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18736 (@value{GDBP})
18737 000-exec-run
18738 000^running
18739 (@value{GDBP})
18740 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18741 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18742 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18743 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18744 (@value{GDBP})
18745 205-break-delete
18746 205^done
18747 (@value{GDBP})
18748 111-exec-return
18749 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
18750 args=[@{name="strarg",
18751 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18752 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18753 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18754 (@value{GDBP})
18755 @end smallexample
18756
18757
18758 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
18759 @findex -exec-run
18760
18761 @subsubheading Synopsis
18762
18763 @smallexample
18764 -exec-run
18765 @end smallexample
18766
18767 Asynchronous command. Starts execution of the inferior from the
18768 beginning. The inferior executes until either a breakpoint is
18769 encountered or the program exits.
18770
18771 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18772
18773 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
18774
18775 @subsubheading Example
18776
18777 @smallexample
18778 (@value{GDBP})
18779 -break-insert main
18780 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18781 (@value{GDBP})
18782 -exec-run
18783 ^running
18784 (@value{GDBP})
18785 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18786 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18787 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18788 (@value{GDBP})
18789 @end smallexample
18790
18791
18792 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18793 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18794
18795 @subsubheading Synopsis
18796
18797 @smallexample
18798 -exec-show-arguments
18799 @end smallexample
18800
18801 Print the arguments of the program.
18802
18803 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18804
18805 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18806
18807 @subsubheading Example
18808 N.A.
18809
18810 @c @subheading -exec-signal
18811
18812 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
18813 @findex -exec-step
18814
18815 @subsubheading Synopsis
18816
18817 @smallexample
18818 -exec-step
18819 @end smallexample
18820
18821 Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
18822 when the beginning of the next source line is reached, if the next
18823 source line is not a function call. If it is, stop at the first
18824 instruction of the called function.
18825
18826 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18827
18828 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
18829
18830 @subsubheading Example
18831
18832 Stepping into a function:
18833
18834 @smallexample
18835 -exec-step
18836 ^running
18837 (@value{GDBP})
18838 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18839 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
18840 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
18841 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
18842 (@value{GDBP})
18843 @end smallexample
18844
18845 Regular stepping:
18846
18847 @smallexample
18848 -exec-step
18849 ^running
18850 (@value{GDBP})
18851 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
18852 (@value{GDBP})
18853 @end smallexample
18854
18855
18856 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
18857 @findex -exec-step-instruction
18858
18859 @subsubheading Synopsis
18860
18861 @smallexample
18862 -exec-step-instruction
18863 @end smallexample
18864
18865 Asynchronous command. Resumes the inferior which executes one machine
18866 instruction. The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
18867 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
18868 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
18869 well.
18870
18871 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18872
18873 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
18874
18875 @subsubheading Example
18876
18877 @smallexample
18878 (@value{GDBP})
18879 -exec-step-instruction
18880 ^running
18881
18882 (@value{GDBP})
18883 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18884 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18885 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/try.c",line="10"@}
18886 (@value{GDBP})
18887 -exec-step-instruction
18888 ^running
18889
18890 (@value{GDBP})
18891 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18892 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18893 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/try.c",line="10"@}
18894 (@value{GDBP})
18895 @end smallexample
18896
18897
18898 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
18899 @findex -exec-until
18900
18901 @subsubheading Synopsis
18902
18903 @smallexample
18904 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
18905 @end smallexample
18906
18907 Asynchronous command. Executes the inferior until the @var{location}
18908 specified in the argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior
18909 executes until a source line greater than the current one is reached.
18910 The reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
18911
18912 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18913
18914 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
18915
18916 @subsubheading Example
18917
18918 @smallexample
18919 (@value{GDBP})
18920 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
18921 ^running
18922 (@value{GDBP})
18923 x = 55
18924 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18925 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
18926 (@value{GDBP})
18927 @end smallexample
18928
18929 @ignore
18930 @subheading -file-clear
18931 Is this going away????
18932 @end ignore
18933
18934
18935 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
18936 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
18937
18938 @subsubheading Synopsis
18939
18940 @smallexample
18941 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
18942 @end smallexample
18943
18944 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
18945 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
18946 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
18947 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
18948 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
18949 notification.
18950
18951 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18952
18953 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
18954
18955 @subsubheading Example
18956
18957 @smallexample
18958 (@value{GDBP})
18959 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
18960 ^done
18961 (@value{GDBP})
18962 @end smallexample
18963
18964
18965 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
18966 @findex -file-exec-file
18967
18968 @subsubheading Synopsis
18969
18970 @smallexample
18971 -file-exec-file @var{file}
18972 @end smallexample
18973
18974 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
18975 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
18976 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
18977 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
18978 notification.
18979
18980 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18981
18982 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
18983
18984 @subsubheading Example
18985
18986 @smallexample
18987 (@value{GDBP})
18988 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
18989 ^done
18990 (@value{GDBP})
18991 @end smallexample
18992
18993
18994 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
18995 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
18996
18997 @subsubheading Synopsis
18998
18999 @smallexample
19000 -file-list-exec-sections
19001 @end smallexample
19002
19003 List the sections of the current executable file.
19004
19005 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19006
19007 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
19008 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
19009 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
19010
19011 @subsubheading Example
19012 N.A.
19013
19014
19015 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
19016 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
19017
19018 @subsubheading Synopsis
19019
19020 @smallexample
19021 -file-list-exec-source-file
19022 @end smallexample
19023
19024 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
19025 to the current source file for the current executable.
19026
19027 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19028
19029 There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
19030
19031 @subsubheading Example
19032
19033 @smallexample
19034 (@value{GDBP})
19035 123-file-list-exec-source-file
19036 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
19037 (@value{GDBP})
19038 @end smallexample
19039
19040
19041 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
19042 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
19043
19044 @subsubheading Synopsis
19045
19046 @smallexample
19047 -file-list-exec-source-files
19048 @end smallexample
19049
19050 List the source files for the current executable.
19051
19052 It will always output the filename, but only when GDB can find the absolute
19053 file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
19054
19055 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19056
19057 There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
19058 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
19059
19060 @subsubheading Example
19061 @smallexample
19062 (@value{GDBP})
19063 -file-list-exec-source-files
19064 ^done,files=[
19065 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
19066 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
19067 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
19068 (@value{GDBP})
19069 @end smallexample
19070
19071 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
19072 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
19073
19074 @subsubheading Synopsis
19075
19076 @smallexample
19077 -file-list-shared-libraries
19078 @end smallexample
19079
19080 List the shared libraries in the program.
19081
19082 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19083
19084 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
19085
19086 @subsubheading Example
19087 N.A.
19088
19089
19090 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
19091 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
19092
19093 @subsubheading Synopsis
19094
19095 @smallexample
19096 -file-list-symbol-files
19097 @end smallexample
19098
19099 List symbol files.
19100
19101 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19102
19103 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
19104
19105 @subsubheading Example
19106 N.A.
19107
19108
19109 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
19110 @findex -file-symbol-file
19111
19112 @subsubheading Synopsis
19113
19114 @smallexample
19115 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
19116 @end smallexample
19117
19118 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
19119 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
19120 produced, except for a completion notification.
19121
19122 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19123
19124 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
19125
19126 @subsubheading Example
19127
19128 @smallexample
19129 (@value{GDBP})
19130 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
19131 ^done
19132 (@value{GDBP})
19133 @end smallexample
19134
19135 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19136 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
19137 @section Miscellaneous @value{GDBN} commands in @sc{gdb/mi}
19138
19139 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
19140
19141 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
19142 @findex -gdb-exit
19143
19144 @subsubheading Synopsis
19145
19146 @smallexample
19147 -gdb-exit
19148 @end smallexample
19149
19150 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
19151
19152 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19153
19154 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
19155
19156 @subsubheading Example
19157
19158 @smallexample
19159 (@value{GDBP})
19160 -gdb-exit
19161 @end smallexample
19162
19163 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
19164 @findex -gdb-set
19165
19166 @subsubheading Synopsis
19167
19168 @smallexample
19169 -gdb-set
19170 @end smallexample
19171
19172 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
19173 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
19174
19175 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19176
19177 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
19178
19179 @subsubheading Example
19180
19181 @smallexample
19182 (@value{GDBP})
19183 -gdb-set $foo=3
19184 ^done
19185 (@value{GDBP})
19186 @end smallexample
19187
19188
19189 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
19190 @findex -gdb-show
19191
19192 @subsubheading Synopsis
19193
19194 @smallexample
19195 -gdb-show
19196 @end smallexample
19197
19198 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
19199
19200 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
19201
19202 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
19203
19204 @subsubheading Example
19205
19206 @smallexample
19207 (@value{GDBP})
19208 -gdb-show annotate
19209 ^done,value="0"
19210 (@value{GDBP})
19211 @end smallexample
19212
19213 @c @subheading -gdb-source
19214
19215
19216 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
19217 @findex -gdb-version
19218
19219 @subsubheading Synopsis
19220
19221 @smallexample
19222 -gdb-version
19223 @end smallexample
19224
19225 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
19226
19227 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19228
19229 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @value{GDBN} by default shows this
19230 information when you start an interactive session.
19231
19232 @subsubheading Example
19233
19234 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
19235 @c box in TeX.
19236 @smallexample
19237 (@value{GDBP})
19238 -gdb-version
19239 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
19240 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
19241 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
19242 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
19243 ~ certain conditions.
19244 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
19245 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
19246 ~ details.
19247 ~This GDB was configured as
19248 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
19249 ^done
19250 (@value{GDBP})
19251 @end smallexample
19252
19253 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
19254 @findex -interpreter-exec
19255
19256 @subheading Synopsis
19257
19258 @smallexample
19259 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
19260 @end smallexample
19261
19262 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
19263
19264 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
19265
19266 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
19267
19268 @subheading Example
19269
19270 @smallexample
19271 (@value{GDBP})
19272 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
19273 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
19274 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
19275 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
19276 ^done
19277 (@value{GDBP})
19278 @end smallexample
19279
19280 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
19281 @findex -inferior-tty-set
19282
19283 @subheading Synopsis
19284
19285 @smallexample
19286 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
19287 @end smallexample
19288
19289 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
19290
19291 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
19292
19293 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty /dev/pts/1}.
19294
19295 @subheading Example
19296
19297 @smallexample
19298 (@value{GDBP})
19299 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
19300 ^done
19301 (@value{GDBP})
19302 @end smallexample
19303
19304 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
19305 @findex -inferior-tty-show
19306
19307 @subheading Synopsis
19308
19309 @smallexample
19310 -inferior-tty-show
19311 @end smallexample
19312
19313 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
19314
19315 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
19316
19317 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
19318
19319 @subheading Example
19320
19321 @smallexample
19322 (@value{GDBP})
19323 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
19324 ^done
19325 (@value{GDBP})
19326 -inferior-tty-show
19327 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
19328 (@value{GDBP})
19329 @end smallexample
19330
19331 @ignore
19332 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19333 @node GDB/MI Kod Commands
19334 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Kod Commands
19335
19336 The Kod commands are not implemented.
19337
19338 @c @subheading -kod-info
19339
19340 @c @subheading -kod-list
19341
19342 @c @subheading -kod-list-object-types
19343
19344 @c @subheading -kod-show
19345
19346 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19347 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
19348 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
19349
19350 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
19351
19352 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
19353
19354 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
19355
19356 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
19357
19358 @c @subheading -overlay-map
19359
19360 @c @subheading -overlay-off
19361
19362 @c @subheading -overlay-on
19363
19364 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
19365
19366 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19367 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
19368 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
19369
19370 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
19371
19372 @c @subheading -signal-handle
19373
19374 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
19375
19376 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
19377 @end ignore
19378
19379
19380 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19381 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19382 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19383
19384
19385 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19386 @findex -stack-info-frame
19387
19388 @subsubheading Synopsis
19389
19390 @smallexample
19391 -stack-info-frame
19392 @end smallexample
19393
19394 Get info on the selected frame.
19395
19396 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19397
19398 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19399 (without arguments).
19400
19401 @subsubheading Example
19402
19403 @smallexample
19404 (@value{GDBP})
19405 -stack-info-frame
19406 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19407 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19408 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19409 (@value{GDBP})
19410 @end smallexample
19411
19412 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19413 @findex -stack-info-depth
19414
19415 @subsubheading Synopsis
19416
19417 @smallexample
19418 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19419 @end smallexample
19420
19421 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19422 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19423
19424 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19425
19426 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19427
19428 @subsubheading Example
19429
19430 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19431
19432 @smallexample
19433 (@value{GDBP})
19434 -stack-info-depth
19435 ^done,depth="12"
19436 (@value{GDBP})
19437 -stack-info-depth 4
19438 ^done,depth="4"
19439 (@value{GDBP})
19440 -stack-info-depth 12
19441 ^done,depth="12"
19442 (@value{GDBP})
19443 -stack-info-depth 11
19444 ^done,depth="11"
19445 (@value{GDBP})
19446 -stack-info-depth 13
19447 ^done,depth="12"
19448 (@value{GDBP})
19449 @end smallexample
19450
19451 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19452 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19453
19454 @subsubheading Synopsis
19455
19456 @smallexample
19457 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19458 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19459 @end smallexample
19460
19461 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19462 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19463 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole call
19464 stack.
19465
19466 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19467 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19468 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19469
19470 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19471
19472 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19473 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19474 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19475
19476 @subsubheading Example
19477
19478 @smallexample
19479 (@value{GDBP})
19480 -stack-list-frames
19481 ^done,
19482 stack=[
19483 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19484 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19485 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19486 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19487 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19488 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19489 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19490 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19491 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19492 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19493 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19494 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19495 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19496 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19497 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19498 (@value{GDBP})
19499 -stack-list-arguments 0
19500 ^done,
19501 stack-args=[
19502 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19503 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19504 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19505 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19506 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19507 (@value{GDBP})
19508 -stack-list-arguments 1
19509 ^done,
19510 stack-args=[
19511 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19512 frame=@{level="1",
19513 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19514 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19515 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19516 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19517 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19518 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19519 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19520 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19521 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19522 (@value{GDBP})
19523 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19524 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19525 (@value{GDBP})
19526 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19527 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19528 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19529 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19530 (@value{GDBP})
19531 @end smallexample
19532
19533 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19534
19535
19536 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19537 @findex -stack-list-frames
19538
19539 @subsubheading Synopsis
19540
19541 @smallexample
19542 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19543 @end smallexample
19544
19545 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19546 following info:
19547
19548 @table @samp
19549 @item @var{level}
19550 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e. the innermost function.
19551 @item @var{addr}
19552 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19553 @item @var{func}
19554 Function name.
19555 @item @var{file}
19556 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19557 @item @var{line}
19558 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19559 @end table
19560
19561 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19562 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19563 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19564 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level.
19565
19566 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19567
19568 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19569
19570 @subsubheading Example
19571
19572 Full stack backtrace:
19573
19574 @smallexample
19575 (@value{GDBP})
19576 -stack-list-frames
19577 ^done,stack=
19578 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19579 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19580 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19581 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19582 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19583 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19584 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19585 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19586 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19587 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19588 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19589 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19590 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19591 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19592 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19593 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19594 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19595 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19596 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19597 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19598 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19599 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19600 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19601 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19602 (@value{GDBP})
19603 @end smallexample
19604
19605 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19606
19607 @smallexample
19608 (@value{GDBP})
19609 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19610 ^done,stack=
19611 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19612 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19613 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19614 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19615 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19616 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19617 (@value{GDBP})
19618 @end smallexample
19619
19620 Show a single frame:
19621
19622 @smallexample
19623 (@value{GDBP})
19624 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19625 ^done,stack=
19626 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19627 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19628 (@value{GDBP})
19629 @end smallexample
19630
19631
19632 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19633 @findex -stack-list-locals
19634
19635 @subsubheading Synopsis
19636
19637 @smallexample
19638 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19639 @end smallexample
19640
19641 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19642 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19643 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19644 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19645 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19646 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19647 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19648 other data types when the the user wishes to explore their values in
19649 more detail.
19650
19651 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19652
19653 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19654
19655 @subsubheading Example
19656
19657 @smallexample
19658 (@value{GDBP})
19659 -stack-list-locals 0
19660 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19661 (@value{GDBP})
19662 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19663 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19664 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19665 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19666 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19667 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19668 (@value{GDBP})
19669 @end smallexample
19670
19671
19672 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19673 @findex -stack-select-frame
19674
19675 @subsubheading Synopsis
19676
19677 @smallexample
19678 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19679 @end smallexample
19680
19681 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19682 the stack.
19683
19684 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19685
19686 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19687 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19688
19689 @subsubheading Example
19690
19691 @smallexample
19692 (@value{GDBP})
19693 -stack-select-frame 2
19694 ^done
19695 (@value{GDBP})
19696 @end smallexample
19697
19698 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19699 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
19700 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
19701
19702
19703 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
19704 @findex -symbol-info-address
19705
19706 @subsubheading Synopsis
19707
19708 @smallexample
19709 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
19710 @end smallexample
19711
19712 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
19713
19714 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19715
19716 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
19717
19718 @subsubheading Example
19719 N.A.
19720
19721
19722 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
19723 @findex -symbol-info-file
19724
19725 @subsubheading Synopsis
19726
19727 @smallexample
19728 -symbol-info-file
19729 @end smallexample
19730
19731 Show the file for the symbol.
19732
19733 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19734
19735 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
19736 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
19737
19738 @subsubheading Example
19739 N.A.
19740
19741
19742 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
19743 @findex -symbol-info-function
19744
19745 @subsubheading Synopsis
19746
19747 @smallexample
19748 -symbol-info-function
19749 @end smallexample
19750
19751 Show which function the symbol lives in.
19752
19753 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19754
19755 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
19756
19757 @subsubheading Example
19758 N.A.
19759
19760
19761 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
19762 @findex -symbol-info-line
19763
19764 @subsubheading Synopsis
19765
19766 @smallexample
19767 -symbol-info-line
19768 @end smallexample
19769
19770 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
19771
19772 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19773
19774 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
19775 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
19776
19777 @subsubheading Example
19778 N.A.
19779
19780
19781 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
19782 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
19783
19784 @subsubheading Synopsis
19785
19786 @smallexample
19787 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
19788 @end smallexample
19789
19790 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
19791
19792 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19793
19794 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
19795
19796 @subsubheading Example
19797 N.A.
19798
19799
19800 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
19801 @findex -symbol-list-functions
19802
19803 @subsubheading Synopsis
19804
19805 @smallexample
19806 -symbol-list-functions
19807 @end smallexample
19808
19809 List the functions in the executable.
19810
19811 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19812
19813 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
19814 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
19815
19816 @subsubheading Example
19817 N.A.
19818
19819
19820 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
19821 @findex -symbol-list-lines
19822
19823 @subsubheading Synopsis
19824
19825 @smallexample
19826 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
19827 @end smallexample
19828
19829 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
19830 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
19831 ascending PC order.
19832
19833 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19834
19835 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
19836
19837 @subsubheading Example
19838 @smallexample
19839 (@value{GDBP})
19840 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
19841 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
19842 (@value{GDBP})
19843 @end smallexample
19844
19845
19846 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
19847 @findex -symbol-list-types
19848
19849 @subsubheading Synopsis
19850
19851 @smallexample
19852 -symbol-list-types
19853 @end smallexample
19854
19855 List all the type names.
19856
19857 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19858
19859 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
19860 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
19861
19862 @subsubheading Example
19863 N.A.
19864
19865
19866 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
19867 @findex -symbol-list-variables
19868
19869 @subsubheading Synopsis
19870
19871 @smallexample
19872 -symbol-list-variables
19873 @end smallexample
19874
19875 List all the global and static variable names.
19876
19877 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19878
19879 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
19880
19881 @subsubheading Example
19882 N.A.
19883
19884
19885 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
19886 @findex -symbol-locate
19887
19888 @subsubheading Synopsis
19889
19890 @smallexample
19891 -symbol-locate
19892 @end smallexample
19893
19894 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19895
19896 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
19897
19898 @subsubheading Example
19899 N.A.
19900
19901
19902 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
19903 @findex -symbol-type
19904
19905 @subsubheading Synopsis
19906
19907 @smallexample
19908 -symbol-type @var{variable}
19909 @end smallexample
19910
19911 Show type of @var{variable}.
19912
19913 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19914
19915 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
19916 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
19917
19918 @subsubheading Example
19919 N.A.
19920
19921
19922 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19923 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
19924 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
19925
19926
19927 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
19928 @findex -target-attach
19929
19930 @subsubheading Synopsis
19931
19932 @smallexample
19933 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
19934 @end smallexample
19935
19936 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
19937
19938 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
19939
19940 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
19941
19942 @subsubheading Example
19943 N.A.
19944
19945
19946 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
19947 @findex -target-compare-sections
19948
19949 @subsubheading Synopsis
19950
19951 @smallexample
19952 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
19953 @end smallexample
19954
19955 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
19956 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
19957
19958 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19959
19960 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
19961
19962 @subsubheading Example
19963 N.A.
19964
19965
19966 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
19967 @findex -target-detach
19968
19969 @subsubheading Synopsis
19970
19971 @smallexample
19972 -target-detach
19973 @end smallexample
19974
19975 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output.
19976
19977 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
19978
19979 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
19980
19981 @subsubheading Example
19982
19983 @smallexample
19984 (@value{GDBP})
19985 -target-detach
19986 ^done
19987 (@value{GDBP})
19988 @end smallexample
19989
19990
19991 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
19992 @findex -target-disconnect
19993
19994 @subsubheading Synopsis
19995
19996 @example
19997 -target-disconnect
19998 @end example
19999
20000 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output.
20001
20002 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20003
20004 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
20005
20006 @subsubheading Example
20007
20008 @smallexample
20009 (@value{GDBP})
20010 -target-disconnect
20011 ^done
20012 (@value{GDBP})
20013 @end smallexample
20014
20015
20016 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
20017 @findex -target-download
20018
20019 @subsubheading Synopsis
20020
20021 @smallexample
20022 -target-download
20023 @end smallexample
20024
20025 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
20026 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
20027
20028 @table @samp
20029 @item section
20030 The name of the section.
20031 @item section-sent
20032 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
20033 @item section-size
20034 The size of the section.
20035 @item total-sent
20036 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
20037 @item total-size
20038 The size of the overall executable to download.
20039 @end table
20040
20041 @noindent
20042 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
20043 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
20044
20045 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
20046 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
20047
20048 @table @samp
20049 @item section
20050 The name of the section.
20051 @item section-size
20052 The size of the section.
20053 @item total-size
20054 The size of the overall executable to download.
20055 @end table
20056
20057 @noindent
20058 At the end, a summary is printed.
20059
20060 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20061
20062 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
20063
20064 @subsubheading Example
20065
20066 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
20067 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
20068
20069 @smallexample
20070 (@value{GDBP})
20071 -target-download
20072 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
20073 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
20074 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
20075 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
20076 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
20077 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
20078 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
20079 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
20080 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
20081 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
20082 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
20083 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
20084 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
20085 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
20086 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
20087 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
20088 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
20089 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
20090 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
20091 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
20092 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
20093 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
20094 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
20095 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
20096 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
20097 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
20098 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
20099 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
20100 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
20101 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
20102 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
20103 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
20104 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
20105 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
20106 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
20107 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
20108 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
20109 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
20110 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
20111 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
20112 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
20113 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
20114 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
20115 write-rate="429"
20116 (@value{GDBP})
20117 @end smallexample
20118
20119
20120 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
20121 @findex -target-exec-status
20122
20123 @subsubheading Synopsis
20124
20125 @smallexample
20126 -target-exec-status
20127 @end smallexample
20128
20129 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
20130 not, for instance).
20131
20132 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20133
20134 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
20135
20136 @subsubheading Example
20137 N.A.
20138
20139
20140 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
20141 @findex -target-list-available-targets
20142
20143 @subsubheading Synopsis
20144
20145 @smallexample
20146 -target-list-available-targets
20147 @end smallexample
20148
20149 List the possible targets to connect to.
20150
20151 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20152
20153 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
20154
20155 @subsubheading Example
20156 N.A.
20157
20158
20159 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
20160 @findex -target-list-current-targets
20161
20162 @subsubheading Synopsis
20163
20164 @smallexample
20165 -target-list-current-targets
20166 @end smallexample
20167
20168 Describe the current target.
20169
20170 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20171
20172 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
20173 other things).
20174
20175 @subsubheading Example
20176 N.A.
20177
20178
20179 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
20180 @findex -target-list-parameters
20181
20182 @subsubheading Synopsis
20183
20184 @smallexample
20185 -target-list-parameters
20186 @end smallexample
20187
20188 @c ????
20189
20190 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20191
20192 No equivalent.
20193
20194 @subsubheading Example
20195 N.A.
20196
20197
20198 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
20199 @findex -target-select
20200
20201 @subsubheading Synopsis
20202
20203 @smallexample
20204 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
20205 @end smallexample
20206
20207 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
20208
20209 @table @samp
20210 @item @var{type}
20211 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
20212 @item @var{parameters}
20213 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
20214 Commands for managing targets}, for more details.
20215 @end table
20216
20217 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
20218 which the target program is, in the following form:
20219
20220 @smallexample
20221 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
20222 args=[@var{arg list}]
20223 @end smallexample
20224
20225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20226
20227 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
20228
20229 @subsubheading Example
20230
20231 @smallexample
20232 (@value{GDBP})
20233 -target-select async /dev/ttya
20234 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
20235 (@value{GDBP})
20236 @end smallexample
20237
20238 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20239 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
20240 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
20241
20242
20243 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
20244 @findex -thread-info
20245
20246 @subsubheading Synopsis
20247
20248 @smallexample
20249 -thread-info
20250 @end smallexample
20251
20252 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20253
20254 No equivalent.
20255
20256 @subsubheading Example
20257 N.A.
20258
20259
20260 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
20261 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
20262
20263 @subsubheading Synopsis
20264
20265 @smallexample
20266 -thread-list-all-threads
20267 @end smallexample
20268
20269 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20270
20271 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
20272
20273 @subsubheading Example
20274 N.A.
20275
20276
20277 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
20278 @findex -thread-list-ids
20279
20280 @subsubheading Synopsis
20281
20282 @smallexample
20283 -thread-list-ids
20284 @end smallexample
20285
20286 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
20287 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
20288
20289 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20290
20291 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
20292
20293 @subsubheading Example
20294
20295 No threads present, besides the main process:
20296
20297 @smallexample
20298 (@value{GDBP})
20299 -thread-list-ids
20300 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
20301 (@value{GDBP})
20302 @end smallexample
20303
20304
20305 Several threads:
20306
20307 @smallexample
20308 (@value{GDBP})
20309 -thread-list-ids
20310 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
20311 number-of-threads="3"
20312 (@value{GDBP})
20313 @end smallexample
20314
20315
20316 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
20317 @findex -thread-select
20318
20319 @subsubheading Synopsis
20320
20321 @smallexample
20322 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
20323 @end smallexample
20324
20325 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
20326 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
20327
20328 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20329
20330 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
20331
20332 @subsubheading Example
20333
20334 @smallexample
20335 (@value{GDBP})
20336 -exec-next
20337 ^running
20338 (@value{GDBP})
20339 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
20340 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
20341 (@value{GDBP})
20342 -thread-list-ids
20343 ^done,
20344 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
20345 number-of-threads="3"
20346 (@value{GDBP})
20347 -thread-select 3
20348 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
20349 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
20350 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
20351 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
20352 (@value{GDBP})
20353 @end smallexample
20354
20355 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20356 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20357 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20358
20359 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20360
20361 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20362
20363 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20364
20365 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20366
20367 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20368
20369 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20370
20371 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20372
20373 @c @subheading -trace-find
20374
20375 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20376
20377 @c @subheading -trace-info
20378
20379 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20380
20381 @c @subheading -trace-list
20382
20383 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20384
20385 @c @subheading -trace-save
20386
20387 @c @subheading -trace-start
20388
20389 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20390
20391
20392 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20393 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
20394 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
20395
20396
20397 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20398
20399 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
20400 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
20401 used by @code{Insight}.
20402
20403 The two main reasons for that are:
20404
20405 @enumerate 1
20406 @item
20407 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
20408
20409 @item
20410 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
20411 now).
20412 @end enumerate
20413
20414 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
20415 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
20416 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
20417 hints about their use.
20418
20419 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
20420 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
20421 least, the following operations:
20422
20423 @itemize @bullet
20424 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
20425 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
20426 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
20427 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
20428 @end itemize
20429
20430 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20431
20432 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20433 The basic idea behind variable objects is the creation of a named object
20434 to represent a variable, an expression, a memory location or even a CPU
20435 register. For each object created, a set of operations is available for
20436 examining or changing its properties.
20437
20438 Furthermore, complex data types, such as C structures, are represented
20439 in a tree format. For instance, the @code{struct} type variable is the
20440 root and the children will represent the struct members. If a child
20441 is itself of a complex type, it will also have children of its own.
20442 Appropriate language differences are handled for C, C@t{++} and Java.
20443
20444 When returning the actual values of the objects, this facility allows
20445 for the individual selection of the display format used in the result
20446 creation. It can be chosen among: binary, decimal, hexadecimal, octal
20447 and natural. Natural refers to a default format automatically
20448 chosen based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
20449 for pointers, etc.).
20450
20451 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
20452 access this functionality:
20453
20454 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
20455 @item @strong{Operation}
20456 @tab @strong{Description}
20457
20458 @item @code{-var-create}
20459 @tab create a variable object
20460 @item @code{-var-delete}
20461 @tab delete the variable object and its children
20462 @item @code{-var-set-format}
20463 @tab set the display format of this variable
20464 @item @code{-var-show-format}
20465 @tab show the display format of this variable
20466 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
20467 @tab tells how many children this object has
20468 @item @code{-var-list-children}
20469 @tab return a list of the object's children
20470 @item @code{-var-info-type}
20471 @tab show the type of this variable object
20472 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
20473 @tab print what this variable object represents
20474 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
20475 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
20476 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
20477 @tab get the value of this variable
20478 @item @code{-var-assign}
20479 @tab set the value of this variable
20480 @item @code{-var-update}
20481 @tab update the variable and its children
20482 @end multitable
20483
20484 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
20485 how it can be used.
20486
20487 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
20488
20489 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
20490 @findex -var-create
20491
20492 @subsubheading Synopsis
20493
20494 @smallexample
20495 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
20496 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
20497 @end smallexample
20498
20499 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
20500 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
20501 register.
20502
20503 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
20504 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
20505 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
20506 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
20507 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
20508
20509 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
20510 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
20511 frame should be used.
20512
20513 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
20514 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
20515
20516 @itemize @bullet
20517 @item
20518 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
20519
20520 @item
20521 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
20522
20523 @item
20524 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
20525 @end itemize
20526
20527 @subsubheading Result
20528
20529 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
20530 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
20531 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
20532
20533 @smallexample
20534 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
20535 @end smallexample
20536
20537
20538 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
20539 @findex -var-delete
20540
20541 @subsubheading Synopsis
20542
20543 @smallexample
20544 -var-delete @var{name}
20545 @end smallexample
20546
20547 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
20548
20549 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
20550
20551
20552 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
20553 @findex -var-set-format
20554
20555 @subsubheading Synopsis
20556
20557 @smallexample
20558 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
20559 @end smallexample
20560
20561 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
20562 @var{format-spec}.
20563
20564 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
20565
20566 @smallexample
20567 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
20568 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
20569 @end smallexample
20570
20571
20572 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
20573 @findex -var-show-format
20574
20575 @subsubheading Synopsis
20576
20577 @smallexample
20578 -var-show-format @var{name}
20579 @end smallexample
20580
20581 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
20582
20583 @smallexample
20584 @var{format} @expansion{}
20585 @var{format-spec}
20586 @end smallexample
20587
20588
20589 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
20590 @findex -var-info-num-children
20591
20592 @subsubheading Synopsis
20593
20594 @smallexample
20595 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
20596 @end smallexample
20597
20598 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
20599
20600 @smallexample
20601 numchild=@var{n}
20602 @end smallexample
20603
20604
20605 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
20606 @findex -var-list-children
20607
20608 @subsubheading Synopsis
20609
20610 @smallexample
20611 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
20612 @end smallexample
20613 @anchor{-var-list-children}
20614
20615 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
20616 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
20617 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
20618 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
20619 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
20620 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
20621 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
20622 and unions.
20623
20624 @subsubheading Example
20625
20626 @smallexample
20627 (@value{GDBP})
20628 -var-list-children n
20629 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20630 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20631 (@value{GDBP})
20632 -var-list-children --all-values n
20633 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20634 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20635 @end smallexample
20636
20637
20638 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
20639 @findex -var-info-type
20640
20641 @subsubheading Synopsis
20642
20643 @smallexample
20644 -var-info-type @var{name}
20645 @end smallexample
20646
20647 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
20648 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
20649 @value{GDBN} CLI:
20650
20651 @smallexample
20652 type=@var{typename}
20653 @end smallexample
20654
20655
20656 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
20657 @findex -var-info-expression
20658
20659 @subsubheading Synopsis
20660
20661 @smallexample
20662 -var-info-expression @var{name}
20663 @end smallexample
20664
20665 Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
20666
20667 @smallexample
20668 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
20669 @end smallexample
20670
20671 @noindent
20672 where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
20673
20674 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
20675 @findex -var-show-attributes
20676
20677 @subsubheading Synopsis
20678
20679 @smallexample
20680 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
20681 @end smallexample
20682
20683 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
20684
20685 @smallexample
20686 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
20687 @end smallexample
20688
20689 @noindent
20690 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
20691
20692 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
20693 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
20694
20695 @subsubheading Synopsis
20696
20697 @smallexample
20698 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
20699 @end smallexample
20700
20701 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
20702 object and returns its value as a string in the current format specified
20703 for the object:
20704
20705 @smallexample
20706 value=@var{value}
20707 @end smallexample
20708
20709 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
20710 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
20711
20712 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
20713 @findex -var-assign
20714
20715 @subsubheading Synopsis
20716
20717 @smallexample
20718 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
20719 @end smallexample
20720
20721 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
20722 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
20723 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
20724 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
20725
20726 @subsubheading Example
20727
20728 @smallexample
20729 (@value{GDBP})
20730 -var-assign var1 3
20731 ^done,value="3"
20732 (@value{GDBP})
20733 -var-update *
20734 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
20735 (@value{GDBP})
20736 @end smallexample
20737
20738 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
20739 @findex -var-update
20740
20741 @subsubheading Synopsis
20742
20743 @smallexample
20744 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
20745 @end smallexample
20746
20747 Update the value of the variable object @var{name} by evaluating its
20748 expression after fetching all the new values from memory or registers.
20749 A @samp{*} causes all existing variable objects to be updated. The
20750 option @var{print-values} determines whether names both and values, or
20751 just names are printed in the manner described for
20752 @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}).
20753
20754 @subsubheading Example
20755
20756 @smallexample
20757 (@value{GDBP})
20758 -var-assign var1 3
20759 ^done,value="3"
20760 (@value{GDBP})
20761 -var-update --all-values var1
20762 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
20763 type_changed="false"@}]
20764 (@value{GDBP})
20765 @end smallexample
20766
20767 @node Annotations
20768 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
20769
20770 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
20771 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
20772 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
20773 relatively high level.
20774
20775 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseeded by @sc{gdb/mi}
20776 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
20777
20778 @ignore
20779 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
20780 @end ignore
20781
20782 @menu
20783 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
20784 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
20785 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
20786 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
20787 * Annotations for Running::
20788 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
20789 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
20790 @end menu
20791
20792 @node Annotations Overview
20793 @section What is an Annotation?
20794 @cindex annotations
20795
20796 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
20797 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
20798 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
20799 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
20800 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
20801 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
20802 cannot contain newline characters.
20803
20804 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
20805 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
20806 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
20807 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
20808 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
20809 means those three characters as output.
20810
20811 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
20812 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
20813 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
20814 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
20815 is for no anntations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
20816 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
20817 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
20818 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
20819 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
20820
20821 @table @code
20822 @kindex set annotate
20823 @item set annotate @var{level}
20824 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
20825 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
20826
20827 @item show annotate
20828 @kindex show annotate
20829 Show the current annotation level.
20830 @end table
20831
20832 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
20833
20834 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
20835
20836 @smallexample
20837 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
20838 GNU gdb 6.0
20839 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
20840 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
20841 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
20842 under certain conditions.
20843 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
20844 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
20845 for details.
20846 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
20847
20848 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
20849 (@value{GDBP})
20850 ^Z^Zprompt
20851 @kbd{quit}
20852
20853 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
20854 $
20855 @end smallexample
20856
20857 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
20858 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
20859 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
20860 output from @value{GDBN}.
20861
20862 @node Prompting
20863 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
20864
20865 @cindex annotations for prompts
20866 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
20867 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
20868 over, etc.
20869
20870 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
20871 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
20872 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
20873 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
20874 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
20875 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
20876 features the following annotations:
20877
20878 @smallexample
20879 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
20880 ^Z^Zprompt
20881 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
20882 @end smallexample
20883
20884 The input types are
20885
20886 @table @code
20887 @findex pre-prompt
20888 @findex prompt
20889 @findex post-prompt
20890 @item prompt
20891 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
20892
20893 @findex pre-commands
20894 @findex commands
20895 @findex post-commands
20896 @item commands
20897 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
20898 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
20899
20900 @findex pre-overload-choice
20901 @findex overload-choice
20902 @findex post-overload-choice
20903 @item overload-choice
20904 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
20905
20906 @findex pre-query
20907 @findex query
20908 @findex post-query
20909 @item query
20910 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
20911
20912 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue
20913 @findex prompt-for-continue
20914 @findex post-prompt-for-continue
20915 @item prompt-for-continue
20916 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
20917 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
20918 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
20919 presence of annotations.
20920 @end table
20921
20922 @node Errors
20923 @section Errors
20924 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
20925
20926 @findex quit
20927 @smallexample
20928 ^Z^Zquit
20929 @end smallexample
20930
20931 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
20932
20933 @findex error
20934 @smallexample
20935 ^Z^Zerror
20936 @end smallexample
20937
20938 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
20939
20940 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
20941 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
20942 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
20943 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
20944 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
20945 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
20946 to the top level.
20947
20948 @findex error-begin
20949 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
20950
20951 @smallexample
20952 ^Z^Zerror-begin
20953 @end smallexample
20954
20955 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
20956 message.
20957
20958 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
20959 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
20960 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
20961
20962 @node Invalidation
20963 @section Invalidation Notices
20964
20965 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
20966 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
20967 changed.
20968
20969 @table @code
20970 @findex frames-invalid
20971 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
20972
20973 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
20974 have changed.
20975
20976 @findex breakpoints-invalid
20977 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
20978
20979 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
20980 deleted a breakpoint.
20981 @end table
20982
20983 @node Annotations for Running
20984 @section Running the Program
20985 @cindex annotations for running programs
20986
20987 @findex starting
20988 @findex stopping
20989 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
20990 @code{step} or @code{continue},
20991
20992 @smallexample
20993 ^Z^Zstarting
20994 @end smallexample
20995
20996 is output. When the program stops,
20997
20998 @smallexample
20999 ^Z^Zstopped
21000 @end smallexample
21001
21002 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
21003 annotations describe how the program stopped.
21004
21005 @table @code
21006 @findex exited
21007 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
21008 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
21009 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
21010
21011 @findex signalled
21012 @findex signal-name
21013 @findex signal-name-end
21014 @findex signal-string
21015 @findex signal-string-end
21016 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
21017 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
21018 annotation continues:
21019
21020 @smallexample
21021 @var{intro-text}
21022 ^Z^Zsignal-name
21023 @var{name}
21024 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
21025 @var{middle-text}
21026 ^Z^Zsignal-string
21027 @var{string}
21028 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
21029 @var{end-text}
21030 @end smallexample
21031
21032 @noindent
21033 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
21034 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
21035 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
21036 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
21037 user's benefit and have no particular format.
21038
21039 @findex signal
21040 @item ^Z^Zsignal
21041 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
21042 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
21043 terminated with it.
21044
21045 @findex breakpoint
21046 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
21047 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
21048
21049 @findex watchpoint
21050 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
21051 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
21052 @end table
21053
21054 @node Source Annotations
21055 @section Displaying Source
21056 @cindex annotations for source display
21057
21058 @findex source
21059 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
21060
21061 @smallexample
21062 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
21063 @end smallexample
21064
21065 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
21066 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
21067 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
21068 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
21069 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
21070 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
21071 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
21072 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
21073 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
21074 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
21075 depend on the language).
21076
21077 @node GDB Bugs
21078 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
21079 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
21080 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
21081
21082 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
21083
21084 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
21085 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
21086 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
21087 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
21088
21089 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
21090 information that enables us to fix the bug.
21091
21092 @menu
21093 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
21094 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
21095 @end menu
21096
21097 @node Bug Criteria
21098 @section Have you found a bug?
21099 @cindex bug criteria
21100
21101 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
21102
21103 @itemize @bullet
21104 @cindex fatal signal
21105 @cindex debugger crash
21106 @cindex crash of debugger
21107 @item
21108 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
21109 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
21110
21111 @cindex error on valid input
21112 @item
21113 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
21114 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
21115 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
21116
21117 @cindex invalid input
21118 @item
21119 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
21120 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
21121 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
21122 for traditional practice''.
21123
21124 @item
21125 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
21126 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
21127 @end itemize
21128
21129 @node Bug Reporting
21130 @section How to report bugs
21131 @cindex bug reports
21132 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
21133
21134 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
21135 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
21136 contact that organization first.
21137
21138 You can find contact information for many support companies and
21139 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
21140 distribution.
21141 @c should add a web page ref...
21142
21143 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
21144 @value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
21145 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
21146 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
21147 be used.
21148
21149 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
21150 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
21151 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
21152 @samp{bug-gdb}.
21153
21154 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
21155 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
21156 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
21157 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
21158 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
21159 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
21160 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
21161 bug reports to the mailing list.
21162
21163 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
21164 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
21165 fact or leave it out, state it!
21166
21167 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
21168 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
21169 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
21170 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
21171 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
21172 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
21173 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
21174 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
21175 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
21176
21177 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
21178 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
21179 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
21180 self-contained.
21181
21182 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
21183 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
21184 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
21185 bugs properly.
21186
21187 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
21188
21189 @itemize @bullet
21190 @item
21191 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
21192 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
21193 version}.
21194
21195 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
21196 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
21197
21198 @item
21199 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
21200 version number.
21201
21202 @item
21203 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
21204 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
21205
21206 @item
21207 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
21208 debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
21209 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
21210 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
21211 compilers.
21212
21213 @item
21214 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
21215 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
21216 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
21217 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
21218
21219 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
21220 and then we might not encounter the bug.
21221
21222 @item
21223 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
21224 reproduce the bug.
21225
21226 @item
21227 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
21228 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
21229
21230 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
21231 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
21232 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
21233 a chance to make a mistake.
21234
21235 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
21236 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
21237 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
21238 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
21239 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
21240 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
21241 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
21242 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
21243
21244 @pindex script
21245 @cindex recording a session script
21246 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
21247 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
21248 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
21249 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
21250
21251 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
21252 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
21253
21254 @item
21255 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
21256 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
21257 it by context, not by line number.
21258
21259 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
21260 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
21261
21262 @end itemize
21263
21264 Here are some things that are not necessary:
21265
21266 @itemize @bullet
21267 @item
21268 A description of the envelope of the bug.
21269
21270 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
21271 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
21272 changes will not affect it.
21273
21274 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
21275 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
21276 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
21277 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
21278
21279 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
21280 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
21281 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
21282 less time, and so on.
21283
21284 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
21285 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
21286
21287 @item
21288 A patch for the bug.
21289
21290 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
21291 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
21292 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
21293 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
21294
21295 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
21296 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
21297 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
21298 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
21299
21300 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
21301 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
21302 help us to understand.
21303
21304 @item
21305 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
21306
21307 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
21308 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
21309 @end itemize
21310
21311 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
21312 @c and consists of the two following files:
21313 @c rluser.texinfo
21314 @c inc-hist.texinfo
21315 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
21316 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
21317 @include rluser.texinfo
21318 @include inc-hist.texinfo
21319
21320
21321 @node Formatting Documentation
21322 @appendix Formatting Documentation
21323
21324 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
21325 @cindex reference card
21326 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
21327 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
21328 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
21329 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
21330 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
21331 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
21332
21333 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
21334 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
21335
21336 @smallexample
21337 make refcard.dvi
21338 @end smallexample
21339
21340 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
21341 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
21342 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
21343 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
21344 your @sc{dvi} output program.
21345
21346 @cindex documentation
21347
21348 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
21349 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
21350 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
21351 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
21352 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
21353 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
21354
21355 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
21356 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
21357 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
21358 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
21359 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
21360 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
21361 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
21362 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
21363
21364 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
21365 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
21366 @code{makeinfo}.
21367
21368 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
21369 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
21370 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
21371
21372 @smallexample
21373 cd gdb
21374 make gdb.info
21375 @end smallexample
21376
21377 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
21378 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
21379 Texinfo definitions file.
21380
21381 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
21382 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
21383 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
21384 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
21385 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
21386 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
21387 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
21388
21389 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
21390 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
21391 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
21392 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
21393 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
21394 directory.
21395
21396 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
21397 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
21398 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
21399 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
21400
21401 @smallexample
21402 make gdb.dvi
21403 @end smallexample
21404
21405 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
21406
21407 @node Installing GDB
21408 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
21409 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
21410 @cindex installation
21411 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}, and source tree subdirectories
21412
21413 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
21414 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
21415 build the @code{gdb} program.
21416 @iftex
21417 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
21418 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
21419 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
21420 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
21421 @end iftex
21422
21423 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
21424 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
21425 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
21426
21427 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
21428 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
21429
21430 @table @code
21431 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
21432 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
21433
21434 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
21435 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
21436
21437 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
21438 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
21439
21440 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
21441 @sc{gnu} include files
21442
21443 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
21444 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
21445
21446 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
21447 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
21448
21449 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
21450 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
21451
21452 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
21453 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
21454
21455 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
21456 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
21457 @end table
21458
21459 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
21460 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
21461 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
21462
21463 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
21464 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
21465 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
21466 argument.
21467
21468 For example:
21469
21470 @smallexample
21471 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
21472 ./configure @var{host}
21473 make
21474 @end smallexample
21475
21476 @noindent
21477 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
21478 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
21479 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
21480 correct value by examining your system.)
21481
21482 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
21483 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
21484 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
21485 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
21486
21487 @need 750
21488 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
21489 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
21490 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
21491
21492 @smallexample
21493 sh configure @var{host}
21494 @end smallexample
21495
21496 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
21497 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
21498 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
21499 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
21500 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
21501
21502 You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
21503 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
21504 @code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
21505 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
21506 if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
21507 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
21508 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
21509 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
21510 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
21511
21512 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
21513 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
21514 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
21515 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
21516 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
21517
21518 @menu
21519 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
21520 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
21521 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
21522 @end menu
21523
21524 @node Separate Objdir
21525 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
21526
21527 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
21528 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
21529 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
21530 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
21531 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
21532 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
21533 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
21534 program specified there.
21535
21536 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
21537 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
21538 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
21539 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
21540 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
21541 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
21542
21543 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
21544 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
21545
21546 @smallexample
21547 @group
21548 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
21549 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
21550 cd ../gdb-sun4
21551 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
21552 make
21553 @end group
21554 @end smallexample
21555
21556 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
21557 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
21558 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
21559 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
21560 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
21561 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
21562
21563 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
21564 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
21565 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
21566 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
21567 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
21568
21569 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
21570 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
21571 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
21572 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
21573 You specify a cross-debugging target by
21574 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
21575
21576 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
21577 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
21578 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
21579
21580 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
21581 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
21582 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
21583 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
21584 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
21585
21586 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
21587 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
21588 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
21589 with each other.
21590
21591 @node Config Names
21592 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
21593
21594 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
21595 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
21596 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
21597 of information in the following pattern:
21598
21599 @smallexample
21600 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
21601 @end smallexample
21602
21603 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
21604 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
21605 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
21606
21607 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
21608 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
21609 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
21610 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
21611 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
21612 abbreviations---for example:
21613
21614 @smallexample
21615 % sh config.sub i386-linux
21616 i386-pc-linux-gnu
21617 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
21618 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
21619 % sh config.sub hp9k700
21620 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
21621 % sh config.sub sun4
21622 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
21623 % sh config.sub sun3
21624 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
21625 % sh config.sub i986v
21626 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
21627 @end smallexample
21628
21629 @noindent
21630 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
21631 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
21632
21633 @node Configure Options
21634 @section @code{configure} options
21635
21636 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
21637 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
21638 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
21639 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
21640
21641 @smallexample
21642 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
21643 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
21644 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
21645 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
21646 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
21647 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
21648 @var{host}
21649 @end smallexample
21650
21651 @noindent
21652 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
21653 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
21654 @samp{--}.
21655
21656 @table @code
21657 @item --help
21658 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
21659
21660 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
21661 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
21662 @file{@var{dir}}.
21663
21664 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
21665 Configure the source to install programs under directory
21666 @file{@var{dir}}.
21667
21668 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
21669 @need 2000
21670 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
21671 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
21672 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
21673 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
21674 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
21675 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
21676 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
21677 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
21678 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
21679 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
21680 @var{dirname}.
21681
21682 @item --norecursion
21683 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
21684 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
21685
21686 @item --target=@var{target}
21687 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
21688 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
21689 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
21690
21691 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
21692
21693 @item @var{host} @dots{}
21694 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
21695
21696 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
21697 @end table
21698
21699 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
21700 needed for special purposes only.
21701
21702 @node Maintenance Commands
21703 @appendix Maintenance Commands
21704 @cindex maintenance commands
21705 @cindex internal commands
21706
21707 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
21708 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
21709 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
21710 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
21711 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
21712
21713 @table @code
21714 @kindex maint agent
21715 @item maint agent @var{expression}
21716 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
21717 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
21718 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
21719
21720 @kindex maint info breakpoints
21721 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
21722 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
21723 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
21724 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
21725 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
21726 is shown:
21727
21728 @table @code
21729 @item breakpoint
21730 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
21731
21732 @item watchpoint
21733 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
21734
21735 @item longjmp
21736 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
21737 @code{longjmp} calls.
21738
21739 @item longjmp resume
21740 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
21741
21742 @item until
21743 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
21744
21745 @item finish
21746 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
21747
21748 @item shlib events
21749 Shared library events.
21750
21751 @end table
21752
21753 @kindex maint check-symtabs
21754 @item maint check-symtabs
21755 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
21756
21757 @kindex maint cplus first_component
21758 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
21759 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
21760
21761 @kindex maint cplus namespace
21762 @item maint cplus namespace
21763 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
21764
21765 @kindex maint demangle
21766 @item maint demangle @var{name}
21767 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C manled @var{name}.
21768
21769 @kindex maint deprecate
21770 @kindex maint undeprecate
21771 @cindex deprecated commands
21772 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
21773 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
21774 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
21775 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
21776 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
21777 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
21778 the replacement as part of the warning.
21779
21780 @kindex maint dump-me
21781 @item maint dump-me
21782 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
21783 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
21784 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
21785 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
21786
21787 @kindex maint internal-error
21788 @kindex maint internal-warning
21789 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
21790 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
21791 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
21792 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
21793 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
21794 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
21795 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
21796 @value{GDBN} session.
21797
21798 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
21799 used as the text of the error or warning message.
21800
21801 Here's an example of using @code{indernal-error}:
21802
21803 @smallexample
21804 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
21805 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
21806 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
21807 debugging may prove unreliable.
21808 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
21809 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
21810 (@value{GDBP})
21811 @end smallexample
21812
21813 @kindex maint packet
21814 @item maint packet @var{text}
21815 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
21816 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
21817 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
21818 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
21819 checksum.
21820
21821 @kindex maint print architecture
21822 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21823 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
21824 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
21825
21826 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
21827 @item maint print dummy-frames
21828 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
21829
21830 @smallexample
21831 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
21832 @dots{}
21833 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
21834 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
21835 58 return (a + b);
21836 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
21837 @dots{}
21838 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
21839 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
21840 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
21841 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
21842 (@value{GDBP})
21843 @end smallexample
21844
21845 Takes an optional file parameter.
21846
21847 @kindex maint print registers
21848 @kindex maint print raw-registers
21849 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
21850 @kindex maint print register-groups
21851 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21852 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21853 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21854 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21855 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
21856
21857 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
21858 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
21859 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
21860 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
21861 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
21862 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
21863
21864 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
21865 write the information.
21866
21867 @kindex maint print reggroups
21868 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21869 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
21870 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
21871 information.
21872
21873 The register groups info looks like this:
21874
21875 @smallexample
21876 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
21877 Group Type
21878 general user
21879 float user
21880 all user
21881 vector user
21882 system user
21883 save internal
21884 restore internal
21885 @end smallexample
21886
21887 @kindex flushregs
21888 @item flushregs
21889 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
21890
21891 @kindex maint print objfiles
21892 @cindex info for known object files
21893 @item maint print objfiles
21894 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
21895 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
21896 and symtabs.
21897
21898 @kindex maint print statistics
21899 @cindex bcache statistics
21900 @item maint print statistics
21901 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
21902 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
21903 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
21904 of minimal, partical, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
21905 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
21906 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
21907 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
21908 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
21909 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
21910 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
21911 lengths.
21912
21913 @kindex maint print type
21914 @cindex type chain of a data type
21915 @item maint print type @var{expr}
21916 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
21917 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
21918 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
21919 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
21920 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
21921
21922 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
21923 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
21924 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
21925 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
21926 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
21927
21928 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
21929 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
21930 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
21931 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
21932 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
21933 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
21934 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
21935 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
21936 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
21937
21938 @kindex maint set profile
21939 @kindex maint show profile
21940 @cindex profiling GDB
21941 @item maint set profile
21942 @itemx maint show profile
21943 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
21944
21945 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
21946 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
21947 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
21948 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
21949 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
21950 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
21951 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
21952
21953 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
21954 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
21955
21956 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
21957 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
21958 @item maint show-debug-regs
21959 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
21960 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
21961 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when GDB inserts or
21962 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
21963 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
21964
21965 @kindex maint space
21966 @cindex memory used by commands
21967 @item maint space
21968 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
21969 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
21970 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
21971 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
21972 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
21973
21974 @kindex maint time
21975 @cindex time of command execution
21976 @item maint time
21977 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
21978 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
21979 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
21980 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
21981 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
21982
21983 @kindex maint translate-address
21984 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
21985 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
21986 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
21987 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
21988 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
21989 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
21990 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
21991
21992 @end table
21993
21994 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
21995 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
21996
21997 @table @code
21998 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
21999 @kindex set watchdog
22000 @cindex watchdog timer
22001 @cindex timeout for commands
22002 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
22003 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
22004 reports and error and the command is aborted.
22005
22006 @item show watchdog
22007 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
22008 @end table
22009
22010 @node Remote Protocol
22011 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
22012
22013 @menu
22014 * Overview::
22015 * Packets::
22016 * Stop Reply Packets::
22017 * General Query Packets::
22018 * Register Packet Format::
22019 * Examples::
22020 * File-I/O remote protocol extension::
22021 @end menu
22022
22023 @node Overview
22024 @section Overview
22025
22026 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
22027 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
22028 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
22029 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
22030
22031 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
22032 transmitted and received data respectfully.
22033
22034 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
22035 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
22036 @cindex remote serial protocol
22037 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
22038 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
22039 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
22040 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
22041
22042 @smallexample
22043 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22044 @end smallexample
22045 @noindent
22046
22047 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
22048 @noindent
22049 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
22050 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
22051 eight bit unsigned checksum).
22052
22053 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
22054 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
22055
22056 @smallexample
22057 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22058 @end smallexample
22059
22060 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
22061 @noindent
22062 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
22063 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
22064 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
22065
22066 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
22067 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
22068 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
22069 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
22070 retransmission):
22071
22072 @smallexample
22073 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22074 <- @code{+}
22075 @end smallexample
22076 @noindent
22077
22078 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
22079 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
22080 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
22081 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
22082
22083 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
22084 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
22085 exceptions).
22086
22087 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
22088 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
22089 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
22090 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
22091
22092 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
22093 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
22094 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
22095
22096 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
22097 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
22098 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
22099 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
22100 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
22101 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
22102 value greater than 126 should not be used.
22103
22104 So:
22105 @smallexample
22106 "@code{0* }"
22107 @end smallexample
22108 @noindent
22109 means the same as "0000".
22110
22111 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
22112 error number. That number is not well defined.
22113
22114 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
22115 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
22116 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
22117 on that response.
22118
22119 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
22120 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
22121 optional.
22122
22123 @node Packets
22124 @section Packets
22125
22126 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
22127 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
22128 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for details about the File
22129 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
22130
22131 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
22132 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
22133 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
22134 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
22135 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
22136 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
22137 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
22138 @var{baz}. GDB does not transmit a space character between the
22139 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
22140 @var{baz}.
22141
22142 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
22143 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
22144
22145 Here are the packet descriptions.
22146
22147 @table @samp
22148
22149 @item !
22150 @cindex @samp{!} packet
22151 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
22152 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
22153 debugged.
22154
22155 Reply:
22156 @table @samp
22157 @item OK
22158 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
22159 @end table
22160
22161 @item ?
22162 @cindex @samp{?} packet
22163 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
22164 step and continue.
22165
22166 Reply:
22167 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22168
22169 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
22170 @cindex @samp{A} packet
22171 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
22172 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
22173 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
22174
22175 Reply:
22176 @table @samp
22177 @item OK
22178 The arguments were set.
22179 @item E @var{NN}
22180 An error occurred.
22181 @end table
22182
22183 @item b @var{baud}
22184 @cindex @samp{b} packet
22185 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
22186 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
22187
22188 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
22189 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
22190 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
22191
22192 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
22193 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
22194 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
22195 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
22196 of view, nothing actually happened.}
22197
22198 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
22199 @cindex @samp{B} packet
22200 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
22201 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
22202
22203 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
22204 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
22205
22206 @item c @var{addr}
22207 @cindex @samp{c} packet
22208 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
22209 resume at current address.
22210
22211 Reply:
22212 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22213
22214 @item C @var{sig};@var{addr}
22215 @cindex @samp{C} packet
22216 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
22217 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
22218
22219 Reply:
22220 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22221
22222 @item d
22223 @cindex @samp{d} packet
22224 Toggle debug flag.
22225
22226 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
22227 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
22228
22229 @item D
22230 @cindex @samp{D} packet
22231 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
22232 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
22233
22234 Reply:
22235 @table @samp
22236 @item OK
22237 for success
22238 @item E @var{NN}
22239 for an error
22240 @end table
22241
22242 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
22243 @cindex @samp{F} packet
22244 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
22245 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
22246 remote protocol extension}, for the specification.
22247
22248 @item g
22249 @anchor{read registers packet}
22250 @cindex @samp{g} packet
22251 Read general registers.
22252
22253 Reply:
22254 @table @samp
22255 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22256 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
22257 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
22258 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
22259 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros
22260 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The
22261 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
22262 @item E @var{NN}
22263 for an error.
22264 @end table
22265
22266 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
22267 @cindex @samp{G} packet
22268 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
22269 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
22270
22271 Reply:
22272 @table @samp
22273 @item OK
22274 for success
22275 @item E @var{NN}
22276 for an error
22277 @end table
22278
22279 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
22280 @cindex @samp{H} packet
22281 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
22282 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
22283 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
22284 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
22285 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
22286
22287 Reply:
22288 @table @samp
22289 @item OK
22290 for success
22291 @item E @var{NN}
22292 for an error
22293 @end table
22294
22295 @c FIXME: JTC:
22296 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
22297 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
22298 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
22299 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
22300 @c described. For example:
22301 @c
22302 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22303 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
22304 @c otherwise returns current registers.
22305 @c
22306 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22307 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
22308 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
22309
22310 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
22311 @anchor{cycle step packet}
22312 @cindex @samp{i} packet
22313 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
22314 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
22315 step starting at that address.
22316
22317 @item I
22318 @cindex @samp{I} packet
22319 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
22320 step packet}.
22321
22322 @item k
22323 @cindex @samp{k} packet
22324 Kill request.
22325
22326 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
22327 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
22328 thread?)}.
22329
22330 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
22331 @cindex @samp{m} packet
22332 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
22333 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
22334
22335 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
22336 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
22337 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
22338 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
22339 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
22340 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
22341 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
22342 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
22343
22344 Reply:
22345 @table @samp
22346 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22347 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexidecimal
22348 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
22349 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
22350 @item E @var{NN}
22351 @var{NN} is errno
22352 @end table
22353
22354 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
22355 @cindex @samp{M} packet
22356 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
22357 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
22358 hexidecimal number.
22359
22360 Reply:
22361 @table @samp
22362 @item OK
22363 for success
22364 @item E @var{NN}
22365 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
22366 written).
22367 @end table
22368
22369 @item p @var{n}
22370 @cindex @samp{p} packet
22371 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
22372 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
22373 register value is encoded.
22374
22375 Reply:
22376 @table @samp
22377 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22378 the register's value
22379 @item E @var{NN}
22380 for an error
22381 @item
22382 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
22383 @end table
22384
22385 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
22386 @anchor{write register packet}
22387 @cindex @samp{P} packet
22388 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
22389 number @var{n} is in hexidecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
22390 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
22391
22392 Reply:
22393 @table @samp
22394 @item OK
22395 for success
22396 @item E @var{NN}
22397 for an error
22398 @end table
22399
22400 @item q @var{query}
22401 @anchor{general query packet}
22402 @cindex @samp{q} packet
22403 General query. Request info about @var{query}. In general
22404 @value{GDBN} queries have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor
22405 queries should use a company prefix (in lower case) ex:
22406 @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally be followed by a @samp{,}
22407 or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure that they match the
22408 full @var{query} name.
22409
22410 Reply:
22411 @table @samp
22412 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22413 Hex encoded data from query. The reply must not be empty.
22414 @item E @var{NN}
22415 error reply
22416 @item
22417 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
22418 @end table
22419
22420 @item Q @var{var}=@var{val}
22421 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
22422 General set. Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
22423 @xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
22424
22425 @item r
22426 @cindex @samp{r} packet
22427 Reset the entire system.
22428
22429 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
22430
22431 @item R @var{XX}
22432 @cindex @samp{R} packet
22433 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
22434 This packet is only available in extended mode.
22435
22436 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
22437
22438 @item s @var{addr}
22439 @cindex @samp{s} packet
22440 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
22441 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
22442
22443 Reply:
22444 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22445
22446 @item S @var{sig};@var{addr}
22447 @anchor{step with signal packet}
22448 @cindex @samp{S} packet
22449 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
22450 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
22451
22452 Reply:
22453 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22454
22455 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
22456 @cindex @samp{t} packet
22457 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
22458 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
22459 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
22460
22461 @item T @var{XX}
22462 @cindex @samp{T} packet
22463 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
22464
22465 Reply:
22466 @table @samp
22467 @item OK
22468 thread is still alive
22469 @item E @var{NN}
22470 thread is dead
22471 @end table
22472
22473 @item v
22474 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
22475 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
22476
22477 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
22478 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
22479 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
22480 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
22481 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
22482 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
22483 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
22484 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
22485
22486 @table @samp
22487 @item c
22488 Continue.
22489 @item C @var{sig}
22490 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
22491 @item s
22492 Step.
22493 @item S @var{sig}
22494 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
22495 @end table
22496
22497 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
22498 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
22499
22500 Reply:
22501 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22502
22503 @item vCont?
22504 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
22505 Request a list of actions supporetd by the @samp{vCont} packet.
22506
22507 Reply:
22508 @table @samp
22509 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
22510 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
22511 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
22512 @item
22513 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
22514 @end table
22515
22516 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
22517 @cindex @samp{X} packet
22518 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
22519 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
22520 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data. The bytes @code{0x23}
22521 (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}), @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and
22522 @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}}) are escaped using @code{0x7d}
22523 (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}}), and then XORed with @code{0x20}. For example,
22524 the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two bytes @code{0x7d
22525 0x5d}.
22526
22527 Reply:
22528 @table @samp
22529 @item OK
22530 for success
22531 @item E @var{NN}
22532 for an error
22533 @end table
22534
22535 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
22536 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
22537 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
22538 @cindex @samp{z} packet
22539 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
22540 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
22541 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
22542 @var{length} bytes.
22543
22544 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
22545 separately.
22546
22547 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
22548 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
22549 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
22550 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
22551 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
22552 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
22553
22554 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
22555 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
22556 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
22557 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
22558 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
22559 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
22560
22561 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
22562 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
22563 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
22564 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
22565 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
22566
22567 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
22568 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
22569 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
22570 target, is not defined.}
22571
22572 Reply:
22573 @table @samp
22574 @item OK
22575 success
22576 @item
22577 not supported
22578 @item E @var{NN}
22579 for an error
22580 @end table
22581
22582 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
22583 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
22584 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
22585 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
22586 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
22587 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
22588
22589 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
22590 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
22591
22592 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
22593 movement.}
22594
22595 Reply:
22596 @table @samp
22597 @item OK
22598 success
22599 @item
22600 not supported
22601 @item E @var{NN}
22602 for an error
22603 @end table
22604
22605 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
22606 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
22607 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
22608 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
22609 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
22610
22611 Reply:
22612 @table @samp
22613 @item OK
22614 success
22615 @item
22616 not supported
22617 @item E @var{NN}
22618 for an error
22619 @end table
22620
22621 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
22622 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
22623 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
22624 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
22625 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
22626
22627 Reply:
22628 @table @samp
22629 @item OK
22630 success
22631 @item
22632 not supported
22633 @item E @var{NN}
22634 for an error
22635 @end table
22636
22637 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
22638 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
22639 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
22640 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
22641 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
22642
22643 Reply:
22644 @table @samp
22645 @item OK
22646 success
22647 @item
22648 not supported
22649 @item E @var{NN}
22650 for an error
22651 @end table
22652
22653 @end table
22654
22655 @node Stop Reply Packets
22656 @section Stop Reply Packets
22657 @cindex stop reply packets
22658
22659 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
22660 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
22661 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
22662 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
22663 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal
22664 numbering conventions is used.
22665
22666 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
22667 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
22668 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
22669 components.
22670
22671 @table @samp
22672
22673 @item S @var{AA}
22674 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexidecimal
22675 number).
22676
22677 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
22678 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
22679 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexidecimal
22680 number). Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported this way. The
22681 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs give the values of important registers or
22682 other information:
22683 @enumerate
22684 @item
22685 If @var{n} is a hexidecimal number, it is a register number, and the
22686 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
22687 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
22688 two-digit hex number.
22689 @item
22690 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
22691 hex.
22692 @item
22693 If @var{n} is @samp{watch}, @samp{rwatch}, or @samp{awatch}, then the
22694 packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
22695 hex.
22696 @item
22697 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
22698 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
22699 future.
22700 @end enumerate
22701
22702 @item W @var{AA}
22703 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
22704 applicable to certain targets.
22705
22706 @item X @var{AA}
22707 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
22708
22709 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
22710 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
22711 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
22712 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
22713 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
22714
22715 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
22716 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
22717 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
22718 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
22719 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for a list of implemented
22720 system calls.
22721
22722 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
22723 this very system call.
22724
22725 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
22726 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
22727 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
22728 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
22729 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O remote
22730 protocol extension}, for more details.
22731
22732 @end table
22733
22734 @node General Query Packets
22735 @section General Query Packets
22736 @cindex remote query requests
22737
22738 The following set and query packets have already been defined.
22739
22740 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
22741 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
22742 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
22743 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
22744 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
22745
22746 @table @samp
22747
22748 @item qC
22749 @cindex current thread, remote request
22750 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
22751 Return the current thread id.
22752
22753 Reply:
22754 @table @samp
22755 @item QC @var{pid}
22756 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexidecimal process id.
22757 @item @r{(anything else)}
22758 Any other reply implies the old pid.
22759 @end table
22760
22761 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
22762 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
22763 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
22764 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
22765 Reply:
22766 @table @samp
22767 @item E @var{NN}
22768 An error (such as memory fault)
22769 @item C @var{crc32}
22770 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
22771 @end table
22772
22773 @item qfThreadInfo
22774 @itemx qsThreadInfo
22775 @cindex list active threads, remote request
22776 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
22777 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
22778 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
22779 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
22780 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
22781 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
22782 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
22783 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
22784
22785 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
22786
22787 Reply:
22788 @table @samp
22789 @item m @var{id}
22790 A single thread id
22791 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
22792 a comma-separated list of thread ids
22793 @item l
22794 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
22795 @end table
22796
22797 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
22798 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
22799 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
22800 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
22801 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
22802
22803 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
22804 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
22805 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
22806 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
22807 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
22808
22809 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
22810 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
22811
22812 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
22813 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
22814 information associated with the variable.)
22815
22816 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI specific encoding of the
22817 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
22818 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
22819 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
22820 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
22821 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
22822
22823 Reply:
22824 @table @samp
22825 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
22826 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
22827 local storage requested.
22828
22829 @item E @var{nn}
22830 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
22831
22832 @item
22833 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
22834 @end table
22835
22836 Use of this request packet is controlled by the @code{set remote
22837 get-thread-local-storage-address} command (@pxref{Remote
22838 configuration, set remote get-thread-local-storage-address}).
22839
22840 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
22841 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
22842 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
22843 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
22844 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
22845 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
22846 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
22847
22848 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
22849
22850 Reply:
22851 @table @samp
22852 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
22853 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
22854 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
22855 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
22856 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
22857 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
22858 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
22859 @end table
22860
22861 @item qOffsets
22862 @cindex section offsets, remote request
22863 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
22864 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
22865 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
22866 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
22867 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
22868
22869 Reply:
22870 @table @samp
22871 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy};Bss=@var{zzz}
22872 @end table
22873
22874 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
22875 @cindex thread information, remote request
22876 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
22877 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
22878 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
22879
22880 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
22881
22882 @item qPart:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
22883 @cindex read special object, remote request
22884 @cindex @samp{qPart} packet
22885 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
22886 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
22887 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
22888 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to the object; it can supply
22889 additional details about what data to access.
22890
22891 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
22892 @samp{qPart:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
22893 formats, listed below.
22894
22895 @table @samp
22896 @item qPart:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
22897 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
22898 auxiliary vector}, and see @ref{Remote configuration,
22899 read-aux-vector-packet}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
22900 @end table
22901
22902 Reply:
22903 @table @samp
22904 @item OK
22905 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
22906 There is no more data to be read.
22907
22908 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
22909 Hex encoded data bytes read.
22910 This may be fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
22911
22912 @item E00
22913 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
22914
22915 @item E @var{nn}
22916 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
22917 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
22918
22919 @item
22920 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} or @var{annex} string was not
22921 recognized by the stub.
22922 @end table
22923
22924 @item qPart:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
22925 @cindex write data into object, remote request
22926 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
22927 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
22928 into the data. @samp{@var{data}@dots{}} is the hex-encoded data to be
22929 written. The content and encoding of @var{annex} is specific to the
22930 object; it can supply additional details about what data to access.
22931
22932 No requests of this form are presently in use. This specification
22933 serves as a placeholder to document the common format that new
22934 specific request specifications ought to use.
22935
22936 Reply:
22937 @table @samp
22938 @item @var{nn}
22939 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
22940 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
22941
22942 @item E00
22943 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
22944
22945 @item E @var{nn}
22946 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
22947 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
22948
22949 @item
22950 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} or @var{annex} string was not
22951 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
22952 @end table
22953
22954 @item qPart:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
22955 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
22956 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
22957 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
22958 must respond with an empty packet.
22959
22960 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
22961 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
22962 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
22963 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
22964 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
22965 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
22966 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
22967 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
22968 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
22969
22970 Reply:
22971 @table @samp
22972 @item OK
22973 A command response with no output.
22974 @item @var{OUTPUT}
22975 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
22976 @item E @var{NN}
22977 Indicate a badly formed request.
22978 @item
22979 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
22980 @end table
22981
22982 @item qSymbol::
22983 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
22984 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
22985 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
22986 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
22987
22988 Reply:
22989 @table @samp
22990 @item OK
22991 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
22992 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
22993 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
22994 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
22995 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
22996 below.
22997 @end table
22998
22999 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
23000 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
23001
23002 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
23003 target has previously requested.
23004
23005 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
23006 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
23007 will be empty.
23008
23009 Reply:
23010 @table @samp
23011 @item OK
23012 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23013 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23014 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
23015 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
23016 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
23017 @end table
23018
23019 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
23020 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
23021 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
23022 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
23023 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
23024 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
23025 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
23026 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
23027 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
23028 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
23029
23030 Reply:
23031 @table @samp
23032 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23033 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
23034 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
23035 the thread's attributes.
23036 @end table
23037
23038 @end table
23039
23040 @node Register Packet Format
23041 @section Register Packet Format
23042
23043 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
23044 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
23045 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
23046 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
23047 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
23048 most-significant - least-significant.
23049
23050 @table @r
23051
23052 @item MIPS32
23053
23054 All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
23055 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
23056 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
23057
23058 @item MIPS64
23059
23060 All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
23061 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
23062 as @code{MIPS32}.
23063
23064 @end table
23065
23066 @node Examples
23067 @section Examples
23068
23069 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
23070 does not get any direct output:
23071
23072 @smallexample
23073 -> @code{R00}
23074 <- @code{+}
23075 @emph{target restarts}
23076 -> @code{?}
23077 <- @code{+}
23078 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
23079 -> @code{+}
23080 @end smallexample
23081
23082 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
23083
23084 @smallexample
23085 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
23086 <- @code{+}
23087 -> @code{s}
23088 <- @code{+}
23089 @emph{time passes}
23090 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
23091 -> @code{+}
23092 -> @code{g}
23093 <- @code{+}
23094 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
23095 -> @code{+}
23096 @end smallexample
23097
23098 @node File-I/O remote protocol extension
23099 @section File-I/O remote protocol extension
23100 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
23101
23102 @menu
23103 * File-I/O Overview::
23104 * Protocol basics::
23105 * The F request packet::
23106 * The F reply packet::
23107 * Memory transfer::
23108 * The Ctrl-C message::
23109 * Console I/O::
23110 * The isatty call::
23111 * The system call::
23112 * List of supported calls::
23113 * Protocol specific representation of datatypes::
23114 * Constants::
23115 * File-I/O Examples::
23116 @end menu
23117
23118 @node File-I/O Overview
23119 @subsection File-I/O Overview
23120 @cindex file-i/o overview
23121
23122 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
23123 target to use the host's file system and console I/O when calling various
23124 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
23125 remote protocol packet to the host system which then performs the needed
23126 actions and returns with an adequate response packet to the target system.
23127 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
23128
23129 The protocol is defined host- and target-system independent. It uses
23130 its own independent representation of datatypes and values. Both,
23131 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
23132 translating the system dependent values into the unified protocol values
23133 when data is transmitted.
23134
23135 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only
23136 when GDB is waiting for the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s}
23137 packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
23138 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
23139 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interuptible by target signals. It
23140 is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt (Ctrl-C), though.
23141
23142 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
23143 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
23144 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
23145 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
23146 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
23147
23148 @smallexample
23149 (@value{GDBP}) continue
23150 <- target requests 'system call X'
23151 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
23152 -> GDB returns result
23153 ... target continues, GDB returns to wait for the target
23154 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
23155 @end smallexample
23156
23157 The protocol is only used for files on the host file system and
23158 for I/O on the console. Character or block special devices, pipes,
23159 named pipes or sockets or any other communication method on the host
23160 system are not supported by this protocol.
23161
23162 @node Protocol basics
23163 @subsection Protocol basics
23164 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
23165
23166 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet, as request as well
23167 as as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
23168 @value{GDBN} is waiting for the continuing or stepping target, the
23169 File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
23170 of a former @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
23171 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
23172 to call the appropriate host system call:
23173
23174 @itemize @bullet
23175 @item
23176 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
23177
23178 @item
23179 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
23180 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
23181 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
23182 Numerical control values are given in a protocol specific representation.
23183
23184 @end itemize
23185
23186 At that point @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
23187
23188 @itemize @bullet
23189 @item
23190 If parameter pointer values are given, which point to data needed as input
23191 to a system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
23192 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
23193 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
23194 packet.
23195
23196 @item
23197 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
23198 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
23199
23200 @item
23201 @value{GDBN} calls the system call
23202
23203 @item
23204 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
23205
23206 @item
23207 If pointer parameters in the request packet point to buffer space in which
23208 a system call is expected to copy data to, the data is transmitted to the
23209 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
23210 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
23211 packet.
23212
23213 @end itemize
23214
23215 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
23216 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
23217
23218 @itemize @bullet
23219 @item
23220 Return value.
23221
23222 @item
23223 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
23224
23225 @item
23226 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
23227
23228 @end itemize
23229
23230 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
23231 the latest continue or step action.
23232
23233 @node The F request packet
23234 @subsection The @code{F} request packet
23235 @cindex file-i/o request packet
23236 @cindex @code{F} request packet
23237
23238 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
23239
23240 @table @samp
23241
23242 @smallexample
23243 @code{F}@var{call-id}@code{,}@var{parameter@dots{}}
23244 @end smallexample
23245
23246 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
23247 This is just the name of the function.
23248
23249 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
23250
23251 @end table
23252
23253 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the real values in case
23254 of scalar datatypes, as pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
23255 datatypes and unspecified memory areas or as pointer/length pairs in case
23256 of string parameters. These are appended to the call-id, each separated
23257 from its predecessor by a comma. All values are transmitted in ASCII
23258 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
23259
23260 @node The F reply packet
23261 @subsection The @code{F} reply packet
23262 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
23263 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
23264
23265 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
23266
23267 @table @samp
23268
23269 @smallexample
23270 @code{F}@var{retcode}@code{,}@var{errno}@code{,}@var{Ctrl-C flag}@code{;}@var{call specific attachment}
23271 @end smallexample
23272
23273 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
23274
23275 @var{errno} is the errno set by the call, in protocol specific representation.
23276 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
23277
23278 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only send if the user requested a break. In this
23279 case, @var{errno} must be send as well, even if the call was successful.
23280 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character 'C':
23281
23282 @smallexample
23283 F0,0,C
23284 @end smallexample
23285
23286 @noindent
23287 or, if the call was interupted before the host call has been performed:
23288
23289 @smallexample
23290 F-1,4,C
23291 @end smallexample
23292
23293 @noindent
23294 assuming 4 is the protocol specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
23295
23296 @end table
23297
23298 @node Memory transfer
23299 @subsection Memory transfer
23300 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
23301
23302 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write as e.g.@:
23303 a @code{struct stat} is expected to be in a protocol specific format with
23304 all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. This should be done by
23305 the target before the @code{F} packet is sent resp.@: by @value{GDBN} before
23306 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
23307 data should point to the already coerced data at any time.
23308
23309 @node The Ctrl-C message
23310 @subsection The Ctrl-C message
23311 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
23312
23313 A special case is, if the @var{Ctrl-C flag} is set in the @value{GDBN}
23314 reply packet. In this case the target should behave, as if it had
23315 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
23316 interupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
23317 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
23318 packet. In this case, it's important for the target to know, in which
23319 state the system call was interrupted. Since this action is by design
23320 not an atomic operation, we have to differ between two cases:
23321
23322 @itemize @bullet
23323 @item
23324 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
23325
23326 @item
23327 The system call on the host has been finished.
23328
23329 @end itemize
23330
23331 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
23332 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
23333 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
23334 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
23335 system call has been finished --- successful or not --- and should behave
23336 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
23337
23338 @value{GDBN} must behave reliable. If the system call has not been called
23339 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
23340 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
23341 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finshed by
23342 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as they fit.
23343 The @code{F} packet may only be send when either nothing has happened
23344 or the full action has been completed.
23345
23346 @node Console I/O
23347 @subsection Console I/O
23348 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
23349
23350 By default and if not explicitely closed by the target system, the file
23351 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
23352 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
23353 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
23354 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
23355 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
23356 conditions is met:
23357
23358 @itemize @bullet
23359 @item
23360 The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-C}. The behaviour is as explained above, the
23361 @code{read}
23362 system call is treated as finished.
23363
23364 @item
23365 The user presses @kbd{Enter}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
23366 line feed.
23367
23368 @item
23369 The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-D}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
23370 character, especially no Ctrl-D is appended to the input.
23371
23372 @end itemize
23373
23374 If the user has typed more characters as fit in the buffer given to
23375 the read call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
23376 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target or debugging
23377 is stopped on users request.
23378
23379 @node The isatty call
23380 @subsection The @samp{isatty} function call
23381 @cindex isatty call, file-i/o protocol
23382
23383 A special case in this protocol is the library call @code{isatty} which
23384 is implemented as its own call inside of this protocol. It returns
23385 1 to the target if the file descriptor given as parameter is attached
23386 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
23387 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
23388 needed.
23389
23390 @node The system call
23391 @subsection The @samp{system} function call
23392 @cindex system call, file-i/o protocol
23393
23394 The other special case in this protocol is the @code{system} call which
23395 is implemented as its own call, too. @value{GDBN} is taking over the full
23396 task of calling the necessary host calls to perform the @code{system}
23397 call. The return value of @code{system} is simplified before it's returned
23398 to the target. Basically, the only signal transmitted back is @code{EINTR}
23399 in case the user pressed @kbd{Ctrl-C}. Otherwise the return value consists
23400 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
23401
23402 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
23403 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
23404 @kbd{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
23405
23406 @table @code
23407 @item set remote system-call-allowed
23408 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
23409 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
23410 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
23411
23412 @item show remote system-call-allowed
23413 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
23414 Show the current setting of system calls for the remote File I/O
23415 protocol.
23416 @end table
23417
23418 @node List of supported calls
23419 @subsection List of supported calls
23420 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
23421
23422 @menu
23423 * open::
23424 * close::
23425 * read::
23426 * write::
23427 * lseek::
23428 * rename::
23429 * unlink::
23430 * stat/fstat::
23431 * gettimeofday::
23432 * isatty::
23433 * system::
23434 @end menu
23435
23436 @node open
23437 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
23438 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
23439
23440 @smallexample
23441 @exdent Synopsis:
23442 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
23443 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
23444
23445 @exdent Request:
23446 Fopen,pathptr/len,flags,mode
23447 @end smallexample
23448
23449 @noindent
23450 @code{flags} is the bitwise or of the following values:
23451
23452 @table @code
23453 @item O_CREAT
23454 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
23455 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
23456 are concerned.
23457
23458 @item O_EXCL
23459 When used with O_CREAT, if the file already exists it is
23460 an error and open() fails.
23461
23462 @item O_TRUNC
23463 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
23464 writing (O_RDWR or O_WRONLY is given) it will be
23465 truncated to length 0.
23466
23467 @item O_APPEND
23468 The file is opened in append mode.
23469
23470 @item O_RDONLY
23471 The file is opened for reading only.
23472
23473 @item O_WRONLY
23474 The file is opened for writing only.
23475
23476 @item O_RDWR
23477 The file is opened for reading and writing.
23478
23479 @noindent
23480 Each other bit is silently ignored.
23481
23482 @end table
23483
23484 @noindent
23485 @code{mode} is the bitwise or of the following values:
23486
23487 @table @code
23488 @item S_IRUSR
23489 User has read permission.
23490
23491 @item S_IWUSR
23492 User has write permission.
23493
23494 @item S_IRGRP
23495 Group has read permission.
23496
23497 @item S_IWGRP
23498 Group has write permission.
23499
23500 @item S_IROTH
23501 Others have read permission.
23502
23503 @item S_IWOTH
23504 Others have write permission.
23505
23506 @noindent
23507 Each other bit is silently ignored.
23508
23509 @end table
23510
23511 @smallexample
23512 @exdent Return value:
23513 open returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
23514 occured.
23515
23516 @exdent Errors:
23517 @end smallexample
23518
23519 @table @code
23520 @item EEXIST
23521 pathname already exists and O_CREAT and O_EXCL were used.
23522
23523 @item EISDIR
23524 pathname refers to a directory.
23525
23526 @item EACCES
23527 The requested access is not allowed.
23528
23529 @item ENAMETOOLONG
23530 pathname was too long.
23531
23532 @item ENOENT
23533 A directory component in pathname does not exist.
23534
23535 @item ENODEV
23536 pathname refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
23537
23538 @item EROFS
23539 pathname refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
23540 write access was requested.
23541
23542 @item EFAULT
23543 pathname is an invalid pointer value.
23544
23545 @item ENOSPC
23546 No space on device to create the file.
23547
23548 @item EMFILE
23549 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
23550
23551 @item ENFILE
23552 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
23553 has been reached.
23554
23555 @item EINTR
23556 The call was interrupted by the user.
23557 @end table
23558
23559 @node close
23560 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
23561 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
23562
23563 @smallexample
23564 @exdent Synopsis:
23565 int close(int fd);
23566
23567 @exdent Request:
23568 Fclose,fd
23569
23570 @exdent Return value:
23571 close returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
23572
23573 @exdent Errors:
23574 @end smallexample
23575
23576 @table @code
23577 @item EBADF
23578 fd isn't a valid open file descriptor.
23579
23580 @item EINTR
23581 The call was interrupted by the user.
23582 @end table
23583
23584 @node read
23585 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
23586 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
23587
23588 @smallexample
23589 @exdent Synopsis:
23590 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
23591
23592 @exdent Request:
23593 Fread,fd,bufptr,count
23594
23595 @exdent Return value:
23596 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
23597 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
23598 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
23599
23600 @exdent Errors:
23601 @end smallexample
23602
23603 @table @code
23604 @item EBADF
23605 fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
23606 reading.
23607
23608 @item EFAULT
23609 buf is an invalid pointer value.
23610
23611 @item EINTR
23612 The call was interrupted by the user.
23613 @end table
23614
23615 @node write
23616 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
23617 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
23618
23619 @smallexample
23620 @exdent Synopsis:
23621 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
23622
23623 @exdent Request:
23624 Fwrite,fd,bufptr,count
23625
23626 @exdent Return value:
23627 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
23628 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
23629 is returned.
23630
23631 @exdent Errors:
23632 @end smallexample
23633
23634 @table @code
23635 @item EBADF
23636 fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
23637 writing.
23638
23639 @item EFAULT
23640 buf is an invalid pointer value.
23641
23642 @item EFBIG
23643 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
23644 host specific maximum file size allowed.
23645
23646 @item ENOSPC
23647 No space on device to write the data.
23648
23649 @item EINTR
23650 The call was interrupted by the user.
23651 @end table
23652
23653 @node lseek
23654 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
23655 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
23656
23657 @smallexample
23658 @exdent Synopsis:
23659 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
23660
23661 @exdent Request:
23662 Flseek,fd,offset,flag
23663 @end smallexample
23664
23665 @code{flag} is one of:
23666
23667 @table @code
23668 @item SEEK_SET
23669 The offset is set to offset bytes.
23670
23671 @item SEEK_CUR
23672 The offset is set to its current location plus offset
23673 bytes.
23674
23675 @item SEEK_END
23676 The offset is set to the size of the file plus offset
23677 bytes.
23678 @end table
23679
23680 @smallexample
23681 @exdent Return value:
23682 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
23683 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
23684 value of -1 is returned.
23685
23686 @exdent Errors:
23687 @end smallexample
23688
23689 @table @code
23690 @item EBADF
23691 fd is not a valid open file descriptor.
23692
23693 @item ESPIPE
23694 fd is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
23695
23696 @item EINVAL
23697 flag is not a proper value.
23698
23699 @item EINTR
23700 The call was interrupted by the user.
23701 @end table
23702
23703 @node rename
23704 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
23705 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
23706
23707 @smallexample
23708 @exdent Synopsis:
23709 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
23710
23711 @exdent Request:
23712 Frename,oldpathptr/len,newpathptr/len
23713
23714 @exdent Return value:
23715 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
23716
23717 @exdent Errors:
23718 @end smallexample
23719
23720 @table @code
23721 @item EISDIR
23722 newpath is an existing directory, but oldpath is not a
23723 directory.
23724
23725 @item EEXIST
23726 newpath is a non-empty directory.
23727
23728 @item EBUSY
23729 oldpath or newpath is a directory that is in use by some
23730 process.
23731
23732 @item EINVAL
23733 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
23734 of itself.
23735
23736 @item ENOTDIR
23737 A component used as a directory in oldpath or new
23738 path is not a directory. Or oldpath is a directory
23739 and newpath exists but is not a directory.
23740
23741 @item EFAULT
23742 oldpathptr or newpathptr are invalid pointer values.
23743
23744 @item EACCES
23745 No access to the file or the path of the file.
23746
23747 @item ENAMETOOLONG
23748
23749 oldpath or newpath was too long.
23750
23751 @item ENOENT
23752 A directory component in oldpath or newpath does not exist.
23753
23754 @item EROFS
23755 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
23756
23757 @item ENOSPC
23758 The device containing the file has no room for the new
23759 directory entry.
23760
23761 @item EINTR
23762 The call was interrupted by the user.
23763 @end table
23764
23765 @node unlink
23766 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
23767 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
23768
23769 @smallexample
23770 @exdent Synopsis:
23771 int unlink(const char *pathname);
23772
23773 @exdent Request:
23774 Funlink,pathnameptr/len
23775
23776 @exdent Return value:
23777 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
23778
23779 @exdent Errors:
23780 @end smallexample
23781
23782 @table @code
23783 @item EACCES
23784 No access to the file or the path of the file.
23785
23786 @item EPERM
23787 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
23788
23789 @item EBUSY
23790 The file pathname cannot be unlinked because it's
23791 being used by another process.
23792
23793 @item EFAULT
23794 pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
23795
23796 @item ENAMETOOLONG
23797 pathname was too long.
23798
23799 @item ENOENT
23800 A directory component in pathname does not exist.
23801
23802 @item ENOTDIR
23803 A component of the path is not a directory.
23804
23805 @item EROFS
23806 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
23807
23808 @item EINTR
23809 The call was interrupted by the user.
23810 @end table
23811
23812 @node stat/fstat
23813 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
23814 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
23815 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
23816
23817 @smallexample
23818 @exdent Synopsis:
23819 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
23820 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
23821
23822 @exdent Request:
23823 Fstat,pathnameptr/len,bufptr
23824 Ffstat,fd,bufptr
23825
23826 @exdent Return value:
23827 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
23828
23829 @exdent Errors:
23830 @end smallexample
23831
23832 @table @code
23833 @item EBADF
23834 fd is not a valid open file.
23835
23836 @item ENOENT
23837 A directory component in pathname does not exist or the
23838 path is an empty string.
23839
23840 @item ENOTDIR
23841 A component of the path is not a directory.
23842
23843 @item EFAULT
23844 pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
23845
23846 @item EACCES
23847 No access to the file or the path of the file.
23848
23849 @item ENAMETOOLONG
23850 pathname was too long.
23851
23852 @item EINTR
23853 The call was interrupted by the user.
23854 @end table
23855
23856 @node gettimeofday
23857 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
23858 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
23859
23860 @smallexample
23861 @exdent Synopsis:
23862 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
23863
23864 @exdent Request:
23865 Fgettimeofday,tvptr,tzptr
23866
23867 @exdent Return value:
23868 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
23869
23870 @exdent Errors:
23871 @end smallexample
23872
23873 @table @code
23874 @item EINVAL
23875 tz is a non-NULL pointer.
23876
23877 @item EFAULT
23878 tvptr and/or tzptr is an invalid pointer value.
23879 @end table
23880
23881 @node isatty
23882 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
23883 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
23884
23885 @smallexample
23886 @exdent Synopsis:
23887 int isatty(int fd);
23888
23889 @exdent Request:
23890 Fisatty,fd
23891
23892 @exdent Return value:
23893 Returns 1 if fd refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
23894
23895 @exdent Errors:
23896 @end smallexample
23897
23898 @table @code
23899 @item EINTR
23900 The call was interrupted by the user.
23901 @end table
23902
23903 @node system
23904 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
23905 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
23906
23907 @smallexample
23908 @exdent Synopsis:
23909 int system(const char *command);
23910
23911 @exdent Request:
23912 Fsystem,commandptr/len
23913
23914 @exdent Return value:
23915 The value returned is -1 on error and the return status
23916 of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
23917 command is returned, which is extracted from the hosts
23918 system return value by calling WEXITSTATUS(retval).
23919 In case /bin/sh could not be executed, 127 is returned.
23920
23921 @exdent Errors:
23922 @end smallexample
23923
23924 @table @code
23925 @item EINTR
23926 The call was interrupted by the user.
23927 @end table
23928
23929 @node Protocol specific representation of datatypes
23930 @subsection Protocol specific representation of datatypes
23931 @cindex protocol specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
23932
23933 @menu
23934 * Integral datatypes::
23935 * Pointer values::
23936 * struct stat::
23937 * struct timeval::
23938 @end menu
23939
23940 @node Integral datatypes
23941 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral datatypes
23942 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
23943
23944 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are
23945
23946 @smallexample
23947 int@r{,} unsigned int@r{,} long@r{,} unsigned long@r{,} mode_t @r{and} time_t
23948 @end smallexample
23949
23950 @code{Int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
23951 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
23952
23953 @code{Long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
23954
23955 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
23956 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
23957
23958 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
23959
23960 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
23961 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
23962 byte order.
23963
23964 @node Pointer values
23965 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer values
23966 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
23967
23968 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
23969 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
23970 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
23971 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
23972
23973 @smallexample
23974 @code{1aaf/12}
23975 @end smallexample
23976
23977 @noindent
23978 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
23979 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
23980 the trailing null byte. Example:
23981
23982 @smallexample
23983 ``hello, world'' at address 0x123456
23984 @end smallexample
23985
23986 @noindent
23987 is transmitted as
23988
23989 @smallexample
23990 @code{123456/d}
23991 @end smallexample
23992
23993 @node struct stat
23994 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
23995 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
23996
23997 The buffer of type struct stat used by the target and @value{GDBN} is defined
23998 as follows:
23999
24000 @smallexample
24001 struct stat @{
24002 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
24003 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
24004 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
24005 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
24006 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
24007 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
24008 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
24009 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
24010 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
24011 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
24012 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
24013 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
24014 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
24015 @};
24016 @end smallexample
24017
24018 The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
24019 approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
24020 structure is of size 64 bytes.
24021
24022 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
24023 range of values.
24024
24025 @smallexample
24026 st_dev: 0 file
24027 1 console
24028
24029 st_ino: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
24030
24031 st_mode: Valid mode bits are described in Appendix C. Any other
24032 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
24033
24034 st_uid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
24035
24036 st_gid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
24037
24038 st_rdev: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
24039
24040 st_atime, st_mtime, st_ctime:
24041 These values have a host and file system dependent
24042 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts the file systems
24043 don't support exact timing values.
24044 @end smallexample
24045
24046 The target gets a struct stat of the above representation and is
24047 responsible to coerce it to the target representation before
24048 continuing.
24049
24050 Note that due to size differences between the host and target
24051 representation of stat members, these members could eventually
24052 get truncated on the target.
24053
24054 @node struct timeval
24055 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
24056 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
24057
24058 The buffer of type struct timeval used by the target and @value{GDBN}
24059 is defined as follows:
24060
24061 @smallexample
24062 struct timeval @{
24063 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
24064 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
24065 @};
24066 @end smallexample
24067
24068 The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
24069 approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
24070 structure is of size 8 bytes.
24071
24072 @node Constants
24073 @subsection Constants
24074 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
24075
24076 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
24077 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are resposible to translate these
24078 values before and after the call as needed.
24079
24080 @menu
24081 * Open flags::
24082 * mode_t values::
24083 * Errno values::
24084 * Lseek flags::
24085 * Limits::
24086 @end menu
24087
24088 @node Open flags
24089 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open flags
24090 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
24091
24092 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
24093
24094 @smallexample
24095 O_RDONLY 0x0
24096 O_WRONLY 0x1
24097 O_RDWR 0x2
24098 O_APPEND 0x8
24099 O_CREAT 0x200
24100 O_TRUNC 0x400
24101 O_EXCL 0x800
24102 @end smallexample
24103
24104 @node mode_t values
24105 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t values
24106 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
24107
24108 All values are given in octal representation.
24109
24110 @smallexample
24111 S_IFREG 0100000
24112 S_IFDIR 040000
24113 S_IRUSR 0400
24114 S_IWUSR 0200
24115 S_IXUSR 0100
24116 S_IRGRP 040
24117 S_IWGRP 020
24118 S_IXGRP 010
24119 S_IROTH 04
24120 S_IWOTH 02
24121 S_IXOTH 01
24122 @end smallexample
24123
24124 @node Errno values
24125 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno values
24126 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
24127
24128 All values are given in decimal representation.
24129
24130 @smallexample
24131 EPERM 1
24132 ENOENT 2
24133 EINTR 4
24134 EBADF 9
24135 EACCES 13
24136 EFAULT 14
24137 EBUSY 16
24138 EEXIST 17
24139 ENODEV 19
24140 ENOTDIR 20
24141 EISDIR 21
24142 EINVAL 22
24143 ENFILE 23
24144 EMFILE 24
24145 EFBIG 27
24146 ENOSPC 28
24147 ESPIPE 29
24148 EROFS 30
24149 ENAMETOOLONG 91
24150 EUNKNOWN 9999
24151 @end smallexample
24152
24153 EUNKNOWN is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
24154 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
24155
24156 @node Lseek flags
24157 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek flags
24158 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
24159
24160 @smallexample
24161 SEEK_SET 0
24162 SEEK_CUR 1
24163 SEEK_END 2
24164 @end smallexample
24165
24166 @node Limits
24167 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
24168 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
24169
24170 All values are given in decimal representation.
24171
24172 @smallexample
24173 INT_MIN -2147483648
24174 INT_MAX 2147483647
24175 UINT_MAX 4294967295
24176 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
24177 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
24178 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
24179 @end smallexample
24180
24181 @node File-I/O Examples
24182 @subsection File-I/O Examples
24183 @cindex file-i/o examples
24184
24185 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
24186 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
24187
24188 @smallexample
24189 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
24190 @emph{request memory read from target}
24191 -> @code{m1234,6}
24192 <- XXXXXX
24193 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
24194 -> @code{F6}
24195 @end smallexample
24196
24197 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
24198 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
24199
24200 @smallexample
24201 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
24202 @emph{request memory write to target}
24203 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
24204 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
24205 -> @code{F6}
24206 @end smallexample
24207
24208 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
24209 file descriptor (EBADF):
24210
24211 @smallexample
24212 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
24213 -> @code{F-1,9}
24214 @end smallexample
24215
24216 Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C before syscall on
24217 host is called:
24218
24219 @smallexample
24220 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
24221 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
24222 <- @code{T02}
24223 @end smallexample
24224
24225 Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C after syscall on
24226 host is called:
24227
24228 @smallexample
24229 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
24230 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
24231 <- @code{T02}
24232 @end smallexample
24233
24234 @include agentexpr.texi
24235
24236 @include gpl.texi
24237
24238 @raisesections
24239 @include fdl.texi
24240 @lowersections
24241
24242 @node Index
24243 @unnumbered Index
24244
24245 @printindex cp
24246
24247 @tex
24248 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
24249 % meantime:
24250 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
24251 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
24252 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
24253 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
24254 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
24255 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
24256 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
24257 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
24258 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
24259 \page\colophon
24260 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
24261 @end tex
24262
24263 @bye